QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document
As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 3, 2002
Registration No. 333-86906
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
AMENDMENT NO. 2
TO
FORM S-1
REGISTRATION STATEMENT
UNDER
THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
PLATINUM UNDERWRITERS HOLDINGS, LTD.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Bermuda | 6719 | Not Applicable |
(State or Other Jurisdiction of | (Primary Standard Industrial | (I.R.S. Employer Identification Number) |
Incorporation or Organization) | Classification Code Number) |
Clarendon House
2 Church Street
Hamilton HM 11
Bermuda
(441) 295-5950
(Address, including Zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of registrant's principal executive offices)
CT Corporation System
1633 Broadway, 30th Fl.
New York, New York 10019
(800) 624-0909
(Name, address, including Zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of agent for service)
Copies to:
Andrew S. Rowen, Esq. Donald R. Crawshaw, Esq. Sullivan & Cromwell 125 Broad Street New York, New York 10004 (212) 558-4000 | Lois Herzeca, Esq. Fried, Frank, Harris, Shriver & Jacobson One New York Plaza New York, New York 10004 (212) 859-8000 |
Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public:
As soon as practicable after the effective date of this Registration Statement.
If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 of the Securities Act of 1933, check the following box./ /
If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. / /
If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering./ /
If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering./ /
If the delivery of the prospectus is expected to be made pursuant to Rule 434 under the Securities Act, check the following box./ /
CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE
Title of Each Class of Securities to Be Registered | Proposed Maximum Offering Price per Share | Proposed Maximum Aggregate Offering Price(1)(2) | Amount of Registration Fee | |||
Common Shares ($0.01 par value per share) | $27 | $1,242,000,000 | $114,264(3) | |||
- (1)
- Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating the registration fee in accordance with Rule 457(o) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.
- (2)
- A portion of the shares to be registered represents shares that are to be offered outside of the United States but that may be resold from time to time in the United States. Such shares are not being registered for the purpose of sales outside the United States.
- (3)
- Previously paid.
The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this Registration Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933, or until the Registration Statement shall become effective on such date as the Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.
Subject to Completion. Dated June 3, 2002.
The information in this preliminary prospectus is not complete and may be changed. These securities may not be sold until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This preliminary prospectus is not an offer to sell nor does it seek an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.
40,000,000 Shares
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd.
Common Shares
This is an initial public offering of 40,000,000 Common Shares of Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. All of the Common Shares are being sold by Platinum Holdings.
Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for Platinum Holdings' Common Shares. It is currently estimated that the initial public offering price per Common Share will be between $23 and $26. The Common Shares have been approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol "PTP" subject to notice of issuance.
See "Risk Factors" beginning on page 15 to read about certain factors you should consider before buying Common Shares.
Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any other regulatory body has approved or disapproved of these securities or passed upon the accuracy or adequacy of this prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.
| Per Share | Total | ||
---|---|---|---|---|
Initial public offering price | $ | $ | ||
Underwriting discount | $ | $ | ||
Proceeds, before expenses, to Platinum Holdings | $ | $ |
To the extent that the underwriters sell more than 40,000,000 Common Shares, the underwriters have the option to purchase up to an additional 6,000,000 Common Shares from Platinum Holdings at the initial public offering price less the underwriting discount.
The underwriters expect to deliver the Common Shares against payment in New York, New York, on , 2002.
Goldman, Sachs & Co. Merrill Lynch & Co. Salomon Smith Barney
Banc of America Securities LLC
Credit Suisse First Boston
JPMorgan
Prospectus dated , 2002.
| Page | |
---|---|---|
Prospectus Summary | 1 | |
Risk Factors | 15 | |
Dilution | 33 | |
Use of Proceeds | 34 | |
Dividend Policy | 34 | |
Capitalization | 35 | |
Pro Forma Financial Information | 36 | |
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Pro Forma Financial Condition and Underwriting Results | 41 | |
Business | 66 | |
Management | 99 | |
St. Paul Investment and Principal Shareholders | 108 | |
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions | 110 | |
Description of our Common Shares | 121 | |
Shares Eligible for Future Sale | 127 | |
Certain Tax Considerations | 127 | |
Underwriting | 139 | |
Validity of Common Shares | 141 | |
Experts | 141 | |
Available Information | 143 | |
Enforceability of Civil Liabilities Under United States Federal Securities Laws and Other Matters | 143 | |
The Predecessor Business | 144 | |
Index to Consolidated Financial Statements and Financial Information | F-1 |
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. is a newly formed company that will conduct its business through three operating subsidiaries, Platinum Underwriters Reinsurance Inc. ("Platinum US"), Platinum Re (UK) Limited ("Platinum UK") and Platinum Underwriters Bermuda, Ltd. ("Platinum Bermuda"). Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda are newly formed companies, while Platinum US has been in existence since 1995 and is an inactive, wholly owned subsidiary of The St. Paul Companies. Platinum UK is, and upon completion of the Public Offering, Platinum US will be, owned through Platinum Regency Holdings ("Platinum Ireland"), a newly formed and wholly owned intermediate Irish holding subsidiary of Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd.
The "Company", "Platinum", "we", "us" and "our" refer to Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd.'s consolidated operations, including Platinum US, unless the context otherwise indicates. "Platinum Holdings" refers solely to Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. Concurrent with the completion of this initial public offering, The St. Paul Companies, Inc. and its subsidiaries will contribute to Platinum substantially all of their continuing reinsurance business and related assets, including all of the outstanding capital stock of Platinum US, referred to herein as the "Transferred Business". "St. Paul" refers to The St. Paul Companies, Inc., which is sponsoring our formation, and, unless the context otherwise requires, its subsidiaries. "St. Paul Re" refers to the reinsurance segment of St. Paul prior to this initial public offering, which includes the continuing business and related assets being transferred to Platinum upon completion of this initial public offering and the run-off business that will remain with St. Paul after this offering and not be renewed.
We intend to commence our property and casualty reinsurance business operations, whereby we indemnify insurers and other reinsurers against all or a portion of their insurance or reinsurance risks for property loss and related damage and negligence resulting in bodily injury or property damage, upon completion of this initial public offering of Common Shares, which we refer to as the "Public Offering". Concurrently with the Public Offering, we intend to privately place Common Shares with St. Paul, which we refer to as the "St. Paul Investment". St. Paul will obtain its Common Shares in return for the contribution of the Transferred Business described herein and will own up to 24.9% of Platinum Holdings' outstanding Common Shares following the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, which Common Shares will be limited to 9.9% of the voting power of the outstanding Common Shares. As part of the consideration for St. Paul's contribution of the Transferred Business, we will grant St. Paul up to two options which will entitle it to buy from us, after the completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, additional Common Shares in the amount and under the circumstances described in this prospectus. Assuming an initial public offering price of $25 per share, we will have a capitalization of approximately $1 billion upon completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment.
In this prospectus, amounts are expressed in U.S. dollars and the financial statements have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America ("U.S. GAAP"), except as otherwise indicated.
General
Our objective is to provide property and casualty reinsurance coverages to a diverse clientele of insurers and select reinsurers on a worldwide basis. We will operate principally by using reinsurance brokers to market our products and principally as a lead reinsurer on treaty reinsurance business, whereby we will accept a specified portion of a category of risks insured by a client. A substantial majority of our business will be written as excess-of-loss reinsurance, which indemnifies
1
the reinsured against all or a specified portion of loss above a specified amount. We intend to organize our worldwide reinsurance business around three operating segments:
- •
- Global Property and Marine. The Global Property and Marine operating segment will include principally property reinsurance coverages and marine reinsurance coverages. Marine reinsurance coverages include all types of marine vessels and related warehouses and liabilities. We intend to focus our underwriting activities primarily on catastrophe excess-of-loss and per risk excess-of-loss contracts. Catastrophes are events such as hurricanes and earthquakes that produce pre-tax losses before reinsurance which, in our definition, are in excess of $10 million to us or $1 billion to the insurance industry, and per risk excess-of-loss contracts cover losses in excess of a specified level on a single risk, rather than aggregate losses for all covered risks. We intend to write other types of property reinsurance as well, including selected property proportional reinsurance, where we will share a proportional part of the original premiums and losses of the reinsured. This segment generated $315 million, or 22.8%, of Platinum's 2001 pro forma net premiums written, which are gross written premiums less premiums ceded to reinsurers.
- •
- Global Casualty. The Global Casualty operating segment will include principally general and automobile liability, professional liability, workers' compensation, accident and health coverages and casualty clash. We intend to focus our underwriting activities primarily on excess-of-loss reinsurance coverages. This segment generated $592 million, or 42.8%, of Platinum's 2001 pro forma net premiums written.
- •
- Finite Risk. The Finite Risk operating segment, which writes policies under which our aggregate risk and return are generally capped at a finite amount, will include principally non-traditional reinsurance treaties, including multi-year excess-of-loss, aggregate stop loss, finite quota share, loss portfolio transfer, and adverse loss development contracts. We intend to provide clients, either directly or through brokers, with customized solutions for their risk management and other financial management needs. We intend to focus our finite risk underwriting activities primarily on multi-year excess-of-loss and aggregate stop loss reinsurance treaties. Coverage classes within these products will primarily include property, casualty, marine and whole account property and casualty exposures. This segment generated $475 million, or 34.4%, of Platinum's 2001 pro forma net premiums written.
In addition, we may write other property and casualty reinsurance on an opportunistic basis. For a discussion of the basis on which pro forma net premiums written were determined, see
"—Selected Pro Forma Financial Information and Operating Data" below.
Background and the Transferred Business
St. Paul and its subsidiaries constitute one of the oldest insurance organizations in the United States, dating back to 1853. Through its division St. Paul Re, St. Paul has been engaged in the reinsurance business since 1983. In December of 2001, in an effort to enhance the profitability of its reinsurance business, St. Paul decided to narrow the product focus of its reinsurance operations and to exit certain lines of that business. As part of this effort, St. Paul Re reduced its anticipated 2002 exposure and expenses by exiting unprofitable lines of business and reducing the number of reinsurance branch offices outside the U.S. The narrowing of reinsurance product lines included exiting aviation, bond and credit reinsurance coverages, as well as certain financial risk and capital markets lines. International branch office closings included Munich, Brussels, Hong Kong, Sydney and Singapore. In addition to curtailing various reinsurance operations, St. Paul's management decided that its reinsurance business and its primary insurance business should ideally operate as separate entities because of their different risk profiles and business characteristics.
2
Accordingly, St. Paul determined to sponsor the formation of Platinum Holdings and its subsidiaries on the terms described herein, including the Public Offering and St. Paul's contribution of the Transferred Business to Platinum Holdings in return for the minority share ownership interests described herein. Contingent upon the completion of the Public Offering, St. Paul Re will contribute to us the Transferred Business through the arrangements described below:
- •
- Renewal Opportunities and Commitments. We will be acquiring from St. Paul Re its existing customer lists and the right to seek to renew substantially all of St. Paul Re's continuing reinsurance contracts. We also will assume commitments, if any, of St. Paul Re to offer reinsurance coverages in the future.
- •
- Assumed Reinsurance Contracts. Through 100% quota share retrocession agreements (the "Quota Share Retrocession Agreements"), we will reinsure substantially all of the reinsurance contracts St. Paul Re entered into on or after January 1, 2002, which we refer to as the "Assumed Reinsurance Contracts". St. Paul Re will retain all of its reinsurance exposure not being transferred to us and will administer the associated run-off. Consequently, we will not assume any underwriting exposure with respect to reinsurance contracts entered into by St. Paul prior to January 1, 2002, except as noted below with respect to finite reinsurance. Underwriting gain or loss with respect to the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts for the period from January 1, 2002 through the later of the business day immediately after the completion of the Public Offering or July 1, 2002 will be retained by St. Paul.
- •
- The terms of the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements provide, with limited exceptions, that retrocessional reinsurance, which is reinsurance obtained by a reinsurer to insure against all or a portion of its reinsurance written, purchased by St. Paul Re shall be for our expense and shall inure to our benefit in respect of the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts, providing us with remaining retrocessional reinsurance coverage for such contracts through 2002 or the earlier termination or expiration of the various retrocession agreements. We will bear all the risk associated with non-payment by third party retrocessionaires under such retrocessional reinsurance. All the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements will take effect as of 12:01 A.M., on the later of the business day immediately following the date of the completion of the Public Offering or July 1, 2002. Accordingly, while St. Paul will be contractually committed to effect the transfer, the effective time of the transfer of the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts will occur after the sale to investors of Common Shares in the Public Offering.
- •
- We will have the right to underwrite specified reinsurance business on behalf of St. Paul and, in the case of the UK business, St. Paul will continue to write such business, in each case for a period of one year following the completion of the Public Offering, and we will reinsure such business pursuant to the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements. This will allow us to participate in reinsurance business which is bound after the completion of the Public Offering without any delay occasioned by the start-up of our operations, including the lack of required licenses, and facilitate the transition of St. Paul Re's business to us.
- •
- For a period of three years following the completion of the Public Offering, we will underwrite on behalf of St. Paul renewals of in-force contracts of finite reinsurance. St. Paul will retrocede to us 100% of the unpaid losses under currently in-force contracts and we will have the option to reinsure losses under renewed contracts for a retrocession premium pursuant to the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements. Under the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements, a portion of future premiums will be applied to settle balances related to prior year experience for the benefit of St. Paul. St. Paul will have an option to renew this arrangement with us for a subsequent period of two years.
3
- •
- Related Assets. We will be acquiring from St. Paul tangible and intangible assets relating to the continuing businesses being transferred to us, including furniture and equipment, systems and software, assignments of leases, licenses and other assets, as well as all of the outstanding capital stock of Platinum US.
- •
- Employees. Upon or following the completion of the Public Offering, we expect to employ approximately 180 employees previously employed by St. Paul Re.
St. Paul has agreed with us that, subject to certain exceptions, for a period of two years following the completion of the Public Offering, it will not offer reinsurance of the type covered by the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts and for which we have acquired renewal rights or hire certain of our employees.
For discussion of the share ownership interests St. Paul will obtain for its contribution of the Transferred Business, see "St. Paul's Share Ownership" below.
Our Organization
The following chart summarizes our corporate structure upon completion of the transactions contemplated by this prospectus. Our operating business will be conducted by Platinum US, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda. Platinum Bermuda expects to reinsure up to approximately 70% of the reinsurance written by each of Platinum US and Platinum UK after the Public Offering, excluding business subject to the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements. St. Paul will continue to write reinsurance in the U.K. and reinsure it 100% to Platinum US for a period of one year following the completion of the Public Offering.
Management and Directors
We are assembling a senior management team of experienced insurance industry professionals, whose backgrounds include underwriting and marketing property and casualty reinsurance worldwide. Steven H. Newman, who will be the Chairman of Platinum Holdings' Board of Directors, Jerome T. Fadden, who is Platinum Holdings' President and Chief Executive Officer, Michael D. Price, who is our Chief Underwriting Officer and Neal J. Schmidt, who will be our Chief Actuary, have extensive experience in the global property and casualty reinsurance industry. The new senior management team intends to initiate a number of actions to improve the underwriting
4
performance and profitability of the Company. These actions are described more fully under "Platinum's Strategy" below.
Our Board of Directors will consist of seven members. We expect that Mr. Newman, Mr. Fadden and Jay S. Fishman, Chairman of the Board of Directors and Chief Executive Officer of The St. Paul Companies, Inc., will be members of the Board of Directors. The other directors are expected to be H. Furlong Baldwin, Jonathan F. Bank, Dan R. Carmichael and Peter T. Pruitt.
Our Competitive Strengths
We believe that with our experienced management team, unencumbered capital base and the long-term potential of the business and assets of St. Paul Re obtained from St. Paul, we will have the benefits of being both an established business and a new market entrant. As a well-capitalized, focused reinsurer, we believe we will be able to expand our relationships with clients of St. Paul Re as well as new clients to a greater extent than if our operations were part of a multi-line insurer such as St. Paul.
We intend to focus our initial marketing efforts on those brokers and their ceding company clients with which St. Paul Re has established business relationships. We feel that the existing portfolio of business generated by St. Paul Re represents a valuable asset given the renewal nature of the reinsurance industry and the importance of continuity of relationships. We believe that the market perceptions and reputation established by St. Paul Re with respect to service and responsiveness will benefit us in light of the transfer of personnel and underwriting activities from St. Paul Re to us.
Platinum's Strategy
Our goal is to achieve superior long-term returns for our shareholders, while establishing Platinum as a conservative risk manager and market leader in certain classes of property and casualty reinsurance.
- •
- Build our future on a strong foundation. We will commence operations with the benefit of the Transferred Business:
- •
- Renewal Rights and Assumed Reinsurance Contracts.Our initial portfolio will contain a diversity of business that would normally take many years to develop. We will be acquiring St. Paul Re's existing customer lists and the right to seek to renew its in-force reinsurance contracts, which produced 2001 pro forma net premiums written of approximately $1.4 billion.
- •
- Fully operational infrastructure.We will select experienced employees from the skilled St. Paul Re employee base. These employees have broker and ceding company relationships and underwriting pricing and claims experience that will allow us to be fully staffed and operational in key underwriting and support functions.
- •
- Add new executive leadership to existing talent. In order to take full advantage of the historical strengths of St. Paul Re, we have significantly strengthened our senior management team with the addition of Mr. Newman and Mr. Fadden. Mr. Newman and Mr. Fadden have extensive experience in leading publicly traded reinsurance companies and intend to implement a number of initiatives to create a more focused and more profitable reinsurance business.
- •
- Focus on profitability, not market share.Our new management team intends to pursue a strategy that emphasizes underwriting discipline and profitability over market share.
5
- •
- Exercise disciplined underwriting and risk management. We intend to exercise risk management discipline by (i) maintaining a diverse spread of risk in our book of business across products and geographic zones, (ii) focusing on excess-of-loss contracts as opposed to pro rata contracts, and (iii) reducing our aggregate catastrophe exposure.
- •
- Operate a lean and expense-focused underwriting business.We believe a lean underwriting culture will support our focus on profitability and allow us to be more responsive to changing market conditions. We intend to keep our headcount low and maintain a limited number of offices. In addition, we expect to originate most of our business from brokers, rather than directly from ceding companies or cedents, which are insurance companies seeking reinsurance coverages, which we believe will keep our expenses low.
- •
- Grow our business by leveraging our global platform. We intend to operate in all three of the world's leading reinsurance markets with offices in New York, London and Bermuda. St. Paul Re has conducted admitted reinsurance activities in the U.S. and London for many years. Our new Bermuda subsidiary will provide us with both a new market in which to write reinsurance and the flexibility to provide reinsurance products that are best facilitated by an offshore company.
- •
- Operate from a position of financial strength. As a newly formed company, our initial capital position is unencumbered by any development of loss reserves for business written prior to January 1, 2002, which are reserves established to reflect estimated cost of loss payments that ultimately will be required to be paid. We expect to have approximately $1 billion of equity capital following the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment to support our anticipated underwriting activities. Our investment strategy will focus on security and stability in our investment portfolio by maintaining a diversified portfolio that will consist primarily of investment grade fixed-income securities.
Key elements of this strategy will be prudent risk selection, appropriate pricing through strict underwriting discipline and increasing our writings of lines of business, which we believe will contribute to our long-term profitability.
Recent Industry Trends
After an extended period of increased competition and eroding premiums, the reinsurance markets began experiencing improvements in rates, terms and conditions in the first quarter of 2000. These improvements continued in 2001 and were accelerated by the terrorist attack of September 11, 2001, which resulted in a range of estimated property and casualty insurance losses to the insurance industry of between $30 billion and $35 billion, the largest estimated catastrophe losses ever experienced by the industry. We believe property and other reinsurance premiums have often risen in the aftermath of significant catastrophe losses. As claims are reserved, industry surplus is depleted and the industry's capacity to write new business diminishes. At the same time, there appears to be heightened awareness that commercial properties are exposed to a variety of risks. We believe that market trends similar to those that have occurred in past cycles are developing in the current environment. With respect to January 2002 renewals, St. Paul Re experienced substantial rate increases, generally ranging from 20% to 50% depending on the line of business. We believe that the current imbalance between the increased demand for property-related insurance and reinsurance and the reduced supply of this type of coverage will continue at least for the immediate future.
6
St. Paul's Share Ownership
St. Paul has determined that the efficiency, profitability and competitive position of its reinsurance operations can be maximized by separating them from St. Paul's primary insurance operations. Despite the separation of the two businesses, St. Paul will continue to participate in future financial results of the reinsurance business through its ownership of the St. Paul Investment. Upon completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, St. Paul is expected to own between approximately 20.1% and approximately 24.9% of our outstanding Common Shares as discussed below, which shares will be limited to 9.9% of the voting power of the outstanding Common Shares.
In return for its contribution of the Transferred Business, St. Paul will obtain an approximate 24.9% interest in our Common Shares following the Public Offering if the initial public offering price equals or exceeds $25 per share. In the event the initial public offering price is less than $25 per share, St. Paul's interest will be reduced pro rata to an approximate 20.1% interest in our Common Shares at an initial public offering price of $23 per share following the Public Offering. If the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional Common Shares in the Public Offering, St. Paul will be issued such additional Common Shares as permit it to retain the proportionate interest it would have obtained without such exercise. In addition, in the event the initial public offering price is less than $25 per share, we will grant St. Paul a ten-year option to purchase at the initial public offering price the number of Common Shares, equal to 3,200,000 shares (or 3,680,000 shares if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional Common Shares) at an initial public offering price of $23 per share, which it did not obtain by virtue of the foregoing reduction. Regardless of the level of the initial public offering price, we will grant St. Paul an option to acquire in specified circumstances up to 2 million shares at an exercise price per share equal to 130% of the initial public offering price. St. Paul has informed us that it currently intends to continue its share ownership in Platinum Holdings for the foreseeable future.
Principal Executive Offices
Platinum Holdings was organized on April 19, 2002 as a company limited by shares under Bermuda law. Platinum Holdings' principal executive offices are located at Clarendon House, 2 Church Street, Hamilton HM 11, Bermuda. Its telephone number is (441) 295-5950.
7
The Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment
Common Shares Offered in the Public Offering | 40,000,000 shares. | |
St. Paul Investment | 13,262,300 shares if the initial public offering price equals or exceeds $25 per share, subject to pro rata reduction to 10,062,300 shares at an initial public offering price of $23 per share. | |
Common Shares outstanding after the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment | 53,262,300 shares, subject to reduction if the number of shares issued to St. Paul is reduced as noted above. | |
Proposed NYSE symbol | PTP. | |
Use of Proceeds | Assuming the Common Shares are offered at $25 per share, the net proceeds from the Public Offering are estimated to be approximately $940 million. A portion of the proceeds, currently estimated at not less than $10 million, will be retained by Platinum Holdings and the balance will be contributed to the capital of Platinum US (in an amount not less than $200 million), Platinum UK (in an amount not less than $100 million) and Platinum Bermuda (in an amount not less than $500 million). See "Use of Proceeds". | |
Dividend Policy | The Board of Directors of the Company intends to declare and pay quarterly cash dividends beginning in the fourth quarter of 2002. The declaration and payment of dividends to holders of Common Shares will be at the discretion of the Board of Directors. See "Dividend Policy". |
The foregoing does not give effect to any exercise by the underwriters for the Public Offering of their option to purchase up to an additional 6,000,000 Common Shares. If the underwriters exercise this option in whole or in part, St. Paul will be issued (as part of the consideration for the Transferred Business) in the aggregate up to 1,989,300 Common Shares, in order to maintain its proportionate initial share ownership in Platinum Holdings at the level it would have obtained without the underwriters exercising their option to purchase additional Common Shares. As a result, if the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares is exercised in full, St. Paul will be issued these additional Common Shares and there would be up to 61,251,600 Common Shares outstanding upon completion of the Public Offering. In order to maintain St. Paul's intended ownership level, the total number of Common Shares to be issued to St. Paul is subject to proportionate adjustment if the number of Common Shares sold in the Public Offering is adjusted hereafter.
If the initial public offering price per Common Share is equal to or greater than $25 per Common Share, St. Paul will acquire 13,262,300 Common Shares pursuant to the St. Paul Investment, which will represent approximately 24.9% of the Common Shares outstanding after the completion of the Public Offering. If the initial public offering price of the Common Shares is less than $25, the number of Common Shares issued to St. Paul in the St. Paul Investment will be reduced pro rata so that at an initial public offering price of $23 per share, St. Paul would receive 10,062,300 Common Shares representing approximately 20.1% of the Common Shares outstanding after the completion of the Public Offering.
The following table sets forth the shares issuable to St. Paul at various initial public offering prices, assuming (i) no exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares and from 50,062,300 to 53,262,300 Common Shares outstanding following the Public Offering and St. Paul Investment and (ii) full exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common
8
Shares and from 57,571,600 to 61,251,600 Common Shares outstanding following the Public Offering and St. Paul Investment. St. Paul's percentage ownership will remain unchanged regardless of exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares:
IPO Price Per Share | Shares Issued to St. Paul with No Over-Allotment Option Exercised | Shares Issued to St. Paul if Underwriters' Over-Allotment Option Exercised in Full | Ownership of Common Shares by St. Paul following the Public Offering and St. Paul Investment | ||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
$23 | 10,062,300 | 11,571,600 | 20.1 | % | |||
$24 | 11,612,300 | 13,354,100 | 22.5 | ||||
$25 | 13,262,300 | 15,251,600 | 24.9 | ||||
$26 | 13,262,300 | 15,251,600 | 24.9 |
We will grant St. Paul up to two options to purchase additional Common Shares following the completion of the Public Offering. Below is a summary of their terms:
- •
- If and to the extent St. Paul acquires fewer than 13,262,300 Common Shares pursuant to the St. Paul Investment because the initial public offering price per Common Share is less than $25, we will grant St. Paul a ten-year option to purchase, at a price per Common Share equal to the initial public offering price, such number of Common Shares which St. Paul did not obtain by virtue of the reduction of shares referred to above (the proportion of the 13,262,300 Common Shares not initially issued to St. Paul), equal to 3,200,000 Common Shares (or 3,680,000 Common Shares if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional Common Shares) at an initial public offering price of $23 per Common Share. We refer to this option as the "St. Paul Ownership Option". The option has customary antidilution provisions. St. Paul has agreed with us that, prior to any exercise of the St. Paul Ownership Option, it will, if necessary, dispose of a sufficient number of Common Shares so that, immediately after exercise of the St. Paul Ownership Option, St. Paul will not be a "United States 25% Shareholder" as defined under "Description of Our Common Shares—Restrictions on Transfer."
The following table shows the number of shares that are issuable to St. Paul under the St. Paul Ownership Option at various initial public offering prices:
IPO Price Per Share | Shares Issuable under St. Paul Ownership Option | Shares Issuable under St. Paul Ownership Option If Underwriters' Over-Allotment Option Exercised in Full | Ownership by St. Paul of Common Shares following the Public Offering and St. Paul Investment and Full Exercise of St. Paul Ownership Option | ||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
$23 | 3,200,000 | 3,680,000 | 24.9 | % | |||
$24 | 1,650,000 | 1,897,500 | 24.9 | ||||
$25 | — | — | 24.9 | ||||
$26 | — | — | 24.9 |
- •
- In addition, regardless of the level of the initial public offering price, we will grant St. Paul a ten-year option to purchase up to 2 million Common Shares at an exercise price of 130% of the initial public offering price. We refer to this option as the "St. Paul Participation Option." The option is exercisable in whole or in part at any time after the second anniversary of the date of completion of the Public Offering. The option has customary antidilution provisions. St. Paul has agreed with us that, prior to any exercise of the the St. Paul Participation Option, it will dispose of a sufficient number of Common Shares so that, immediately after exercise of the St. Paul Participation Option, St. Paul will not be a "United States 25% Shareholder".
9
Selected Pro Forma Financial Information and Operating Data
Financial information in this prospectus is presented in U.S. dollars and on the basis of U.S. GAAP unless otherwise indicated.
In this prospectus, we are presenting unaudited pro forma financial information of Platinum Holdings with respect to the Transferred Business, contingent upon the completion of this Public Offering. This pro forma financial information is based on the terms of the agreements between Platinum and St. Paul effecting the transfer of the Transferred Business, the material terms of which are described under "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions", which we refer to herein as the "Inception Agreements".
We caution that the Platinum pro forma consolidated balance sheet and pro forma combined underwriting results presented herein are not indicative of the actual results that we expect to achieve once we commence operations. Many factors may cause our actual results to differ materially from the pro forma consolidated balance sheet and underwriting results including, but not limited to, the following:
- •
- Platinum's pro forma combined statement of underwriting results includes premium and loss development on business entered into prior to January 1, 2002. Under the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements, we are assuming no premium or loss development on business entered into prior to January 1, 2002. Therefore, our reported premiums written and earned and reported losses and loss adjustment expenses, which are the expenses of settling claims, in our initial years of operation could be substantially lower than as presented in Platinum's pro forma combined statement of underwriting results. As such, our reported results in our initial years of operation will not be subject to prior year development for periods prior to January 1, 2002.
- •
- Following the Public Offering, we will report underwriting results under the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements for the period prior to the later of the business day immediately after the date of completion of the Public Offering or July 1, 2002 based on the application of retroactive reinsurance accounting, resulting in the premiums earned and losses incurred by St. Paul during such period being excluded from our statement of underwriting results. Due to this exclusion, following the Public Offering, our reported 2002 premiums written and earned and our net
underwriting results in 2002 could be substantially different than as presented in Platinum's pro forma combined statement of underwriting results.
- •
- Platinum's pro forma consolidated balance sheet reflects the inception of the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements assuming transferred balances as of April 24, 2002. Platinum's actual consolidated balance sheet will report transferred amounts determined as of 12:01 a.m. on the later of the business day immediately after the date of completion of the Public Offering or July 1, 2002. Accordingly, underwriting gain or loss with respect to the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts for the period from January 1, 2002 through such date will be retained by St. Paul.
- •
- Although we expect to continue to be afforded the benefits of most of St. Paul Re's retrocessional reinsurance program through their expiration during 2002, we may enter into retrocessional reinsurance contracts with significantly different terms and conditions from those that have been made available to us from St. Paul Re and which form the basis of our initial operations.
- •
- The additional and reinstatement premiums, which are premiums charged for the restoration of the limit of a catastrophe contract to its full amount after payment of losses, recorded in
10
- •
- Platinum's pro forma financial statements continue to reflect the discounting of the liability for certain Assumed Reinsurance Contracts based on our current intention to make arrangements to permit such discounting. If we do not put such arrangements in place, reinsurance contracts of a similar type entered into in the future would be reported on an undiscounted basis.
2001 by St. Paul Re's Finite Risk operating segment were primarily caused by losses relating to the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack. These additional and reinstatement premiums were unusually high and not necessarily indicative of the recurring premium volume we expect to write in that business segment.
Pro Forma Consolidated Balance Sheet Data
We have prepared our unaudited pro forma consolidated balance sheet as of our inception date on April 24, 2002 to reflect our initial capitalization in the amount of $12,000 and adjusted to reflect, among other things,
- •
- amounts reflecting (a) the receipt of $940 million, representing the estimated net proceeds from the Public Offering, based on an assumed initial public offering price of $25 per Common Share without giving effect to any exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares and (b) the redemption of the Common Shares that were issued at inception. It is further
assumed that the net proceeds from the Public Offering will be invested in long-term, taxable fixed income securities;
- •
- amounts related to the net assets contributed to Platinum by St. Paul, which are transferred at St. Paul's book value. Tangible assets so contributed include the net assets of Platinum US as well as certain fixed assets such as furniture and equipment, systems and software. Intangible assets contributed include broker and customer lists, contract renewal rights and licenses; and
- •
- our entering into the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements with St. Paul Re reinsuring the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts as of April 24, 2002.
| At Inception April 24, 2002 | ||
---|---|---|---|
| ($ in millions, except per share amount) | ||
Cash and invested assets | $ | 1,110 | |
Deferred acquisition costs | 21 | ||
Other assets | 7 | ||
Total assets | $ | 1,138 | |
Unpaid losses and loss adjustment expense reserves | $ | 38 | |
Unearned premium reserves | 134 | ||
Total shareholders' equity | 966 | ||
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity | $ | 1,138 | |
Book value per Common Share(1) | $ | 18.15 |
- (1)
- Reflects the issuance of 53,262,300 million Common Shares in the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment.
11
Pro Forma Combined Underwriting Results
We have prepared our unaudited pro forma combined statements of underwriting results to represent our reinsurance business as if we had commenced our operations and the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment had been completed as of January 1, 2001. Our presentation of our pro forma underwriting results assumes that all of the Inception Agreements were entered into as of January 1, 2001. We have based our presentation on St. Paul Re's actual underwriting results for the periods presented. We have then adjusted these historical results to remove any of St. Paul Re's reinsurance businesses that will not be part of Platinum following the completion of the Public Offering, including
- •
- amounts related to St. Paul Re's reinsurance businesses that were not, and will not be, renewed after January 1, 2002, and
- •
- amounts related to St. Paul Re's allocations from the St. Paul corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance programs that will not be available to Platinum.
Except as noted above, the pro forma combined underwriting results assume that all other retrocessional reinsurance with respect to the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts entered into in 2002 and prior years will remain available to Platinum.
Our future results will depend in part on the amount of our investment income, which cannot be predicted and which will fluctuate depending upon the types of investments we select, our underwriting results and market factors. Actual tax expense in future periods will be based on underwriting results plus investment income and other income and expense items not reflected in the pro forma combined underwriting results. Our effective tax rate will reflect the proportion of income recognized by our operating subsidiaries, with Platinum US taxed at the U.S. corporate income tax rate (35%), Platinum UK taxed at the U.K. corporate tax rate (up to 30%), Platinum Ireland taxed at the Irish corporate tax rate (25% on non-trading income and 16% on trading income, the latter rate to be reduced to 12.5% as of January 1, 2003), and Platinum Bermuda taxed at a zero corporate tax rate. In 2002, we expect to have a greater portion of our income subject to U.S. taxation and U.K. taxation than we expect to have in the future because our Bermuda operations are entirely new but can be expected to grow as a proportion of our business. As a result of changes in the geographic distribution of taxable income as well as changes in the amount of our non-taxable income and expense, the relationship between our reported income before tax and our income tax expense may change significantly from one period to the next.
12
| Three Months Ended March 31, | | |||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Year Ended December 31, 2001 | ||||||||||||
| 2002 | 2001 | |||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||||||||
Net premiums earned | |||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 415 | $ | 341 | $ | 1,382 | |||||||
Change in unearned premiums, net | (93 | ) | (100 | ) | (80 | ) | |||||||
Net premiums earned | 322 | 241 | 1,302 | ||||||||||
Losses and Underwriting Expenses | |||||||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 215 | 150 | 1,440 | ||||||||||
Policy acquisition expenses | 83 | 79 | 237 | ||||||||||
Other underwriting expenses | 13 | 17 | 63 | ||||||||||
Total underwriting losses and expenses | 311 | 246 | 1,740 | ||||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | 11 | $ | (5 | ) | $ | (438 | ) | |||||
Selected Ratios - U.S. GAAP | |||||||||||||
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio | 66.6 | % | 62.4 | % | 110.6 | % | |||||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 29.8 | % | 39.9 | % | 23.0 | % | |||||||
Combined ratio | 96.4 | % | 102.3 | % | 133.6 | % | |||||||
Selected Ratios - Statutory | |||||||||||||
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio | 66.6 | % | 62.4 | % | 110.6 | % | |||||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 26.3 | % | 33.6 | % | 23.3 | % | |||||||
Combined ratio | 92.9 | % | 96.0 | % | 133.9 | % | |||||||
Impact of catastrophes on combined ratio (1) | (2.3 | )% | (3.1 | )% | 40.9 | % | |||||||
- (1)
- Excludes ceded losses under St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties, because such treaties extend to non-catastrophic as well as catastrophic losses as described below.
Included in the 2001 pro forma combined underwriting results are pre-tax losses related to the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack totaling $468 million. This amount includes gross losses and loss adjustment expenses of $819 million, $123 million of ceded reinsurance, $137 million of additional and reinstatement premiums and $91 million of reduced contingent commission expenses. The determination of the impact of catastrophes on the combined ratio (which is a combination of the expense ratio and the loss ratio) excludes the ceded losses under St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties; these treaties provide coverage for excess losses arising from catastrophic and non-catastrophic events. The benefits of St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaty for 2002 will remain available to Platinum for the balance of 2002 unless earlier terminated pursuant to its terms.
13
Pro Forma Underwriting Results by Operating Segment
The following provides a summary of the pro forma underwriting results for our three operating segments. To provide a more meaningful indication of the underlying performance of our business segments, the results exclude the impact of St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties and the impact of the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack.
| Three months ended March 31, | | |||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Year ended December 31, 2001 | ||||||||||
2002 | 2001 | ||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||||||
Net premiums written | |||||||||||
Global Property and Marine | $ | 127 | $ | 123 | $ | 356 | |||||
Global Casualty | 200 | 158 | 611 | ||||||||
Finite Risk | 93 | 71 | 365 | ||||||||
Total | $ | 420 | $ | 352 | $ | 1,332 | |||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | |||||||||||
Global Property and Marine | $ | 40 | $ | 25 | $ | 68 | |||||
Global Casualty | (23 | ) | (43 | ) | (119 | ) | |||||
Finite Risk | (1 | ) | (3 | ) | (26 | ) | |||||
Total | $ | 16 | $ | (21 | ) | $ | (77 | ) | |||
Combined ratio | |||||||||||
Global Property and Marine | 56.3% | 66.3% | 80.8% | ||||||||
Global Casualty | 116.1% | 138.8% | 122.1% | ||||||||
Finite Risk | 101.6% | 104.2% | 107.1% | ||||||||
Total | 95.1% | 108.1% | 106.1% | ||||||||
14
Before investing in our Common Shares, you must carefully consider the following risk factors. These risks could materially affect our business, results of operations or financial condition and cause the trading price of the Common Shares to decline. You could lose part or all of your investment.
Risk Related to Our Business
If we are unable to implement our business strategy or operate our business as we currently expect, our results may be adversely affected.
Platinum Holdings, Platinum UK, Platinum Bermuda and Platinum Ireland were recently formed. Platinum US, a wholly owned subsidiary of St. Paul, has been in existence since 1995 as an inactive insurance company. None of these companies has any operating history. Businesses, such as ours, which are starting up or in their initial stages of development present substantial business and financial risks and may suffer significant losses. We must develop business relations, establish operating procedures, hire staff, obtain facilities, implement new systems, obtain licenses and complete other tasks appropriate for the conduct of our intended business activities. If we are unable to implement these actions to operate our business as we currently expect, our results may be adversely affected. As a result of industry factors or factors specific to Platinum, we may have to alter our anticipated methods of conducting our business, such as the nature, amount and types of risks we assume.
We may not be able to successfully continue the business being contributed by
St. Paul Re because we do not have St. Paul's established name recognition and capital base.
Although we anticipate commencing our operations with an existing reinsurance business, including renewal opportunities, broker and cedent relationships, a workforce and other tangible and intangible assets that are being contributed by St. Paul Re, we may not be able to successfully continue this business. We will not have any of the benefits which may have flowed to the business from being affiliated with St. Paul, including its name recognition, its reputation in the industry and its strong capital base. In addition, we will not have certain offices that produced 2002 business but that were closed in late 2001 and early 2002. It is possible that clients of St. Paul Re will choose not to renew expiring contracts with us and will choose to reinsure with our competitors. It is possible that cedents will choose to not do business with us because we will have a smaller capital base or lower ratings than St. Paul has or because the cedents' credit approval committees will not approve doing business with us. It is possible that clients that do renew expiring contracts with us may demand policy terms that are less favorable to us or may renew only with reduced coverage limits. In addition, certain of the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts afford the reinsured party a right to cancel coverage upon transfer of the Transferred Business to us. While we expect that few, if any, cancellations will occur, substantial cancellations would adversely affect our future results of operations, particularly in the near-term. We may not be able to maintain the broker relationships established by St. Paul Re, or retain those employees of St. Paul Re who are expected to join us upon completion of the Public Offering. We may not be able to build upon this base of business or operate our business as successfully as St. Paul Re. It is also possible that the restructuring of St. Paul Re that St. Paul initiated in December 2001 and the Public Offering may adversely affect our ability to maintain the St. Paul Re business that is being transferred to us.
Neither our pro forma financial information nor the historical combined financial information of St. Paul Re in this prospectus is an indicator of our future actual results.
As a newly formed company, we have no actual results of operations. We are, therefore, presenting in this prospectus our pro forma financial information with respect to the reinsurance
15
business which St. Paul will be transferring to us, as if the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment had been completed and we had commenced our operations as of January 1, 2001. We are also presenting historical combined financial information of St. Paul Re to illustrate the underwriting results of our actual historical reinsurance business.
We caution that our pro forma financial information and the historical combined financial information of St. Paul Re presented in this prospectus are not necessarily comparable with or indicative of the actual results that we expect to achieve once we commence operations for the reasons set forth below:
- •
- Platinum's pro forma combined statement of underwriting results includes premium and loss development on business entered into prior to January 1, 2002. Under the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements, we are assuming no premium or loss development on business entered into prior to January 1, 2002. Therefore, our reported premiums written and earned and reported losses and loss adjustment expenses in our initial years of operation could be substantially lower than as presented in Platinum's pro forma combined statement of underwriting results. As such, our reported results in our initial years of operation will not be subject to prior year development for periods prior to January 1, 2002.
- •
- Following the Public Offering, we will report underwriting results under the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements for the period prior to the later of the business day immediately after the date of completion of the Public Offering or July 1, 2002 based on the application of retroactive reinsurance accounting, resulting in the premiums earned and losses incurred by St. Paul during such period being excluded from our statement of underwriting results. Due to this exclusion, following the Public Offering, our reported 2002 premiums written and earned and our net underwriting results in 2002 could be substantially different than as presented in Platinum's pro forma combined statement of underwriting results.
- •
- Platinum's pro forma consolidated balance sheet reflects the inception of the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements assuming transferred balances as of April 24, 2002. Platinum's actual consolidated balance sheet will report transferred amounts determined as of 12:01 a.m. on the later of the business day immediately after the date of completion of the Public Offering or July 1, 2002. Accordingly, underwriting gain or loss with respect to the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts for the period from January 1, 2002 through such date will be retained by St. Paul.
- •
- Although we expect to continue to be afforded the benefits of most of St. Paul Re's retrocessional reinsurance program through their expiration during 2002, we may enter into retrocessional reinsurance contracts with significantly different terms and conditions from those that have been made available to us from St. Paul Re and which form the basis of our initial operations.
- •
- The additional and reinstatement premiums recorded in 2001 by St. Paul Re's Finite Risk operating segment were primarily caused by losses relating to the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack. These additional and reinstatement premiums were unusually high and not necessarily indicative of the recurring premium volume we expect to write in that business segment.
- •
- Platinum's pro forma financial statements continue to reflect the discounting of the liability for certain Assumed Reinsurance Contracts based on our current intention to make arrangements to permit such discounting. If we do not put such arrangements in place, reinsurance contracts of a similar type entered into in the future would be reported on an un-discounted basis.
16
Our future consolidated financial results will also depend on the amount of our investment income, which cannot be predicted and which will fluctuate depending upon the types of investments we select, our underwriting results and market factors, such as the level of interest rates, as well as our consolidated effective tax rate.
Intense competition could adversely affect our profitability.
The property and casualty reinsurance industry is highly competitive and, except for regulatory considerations, there are relatively few barriers to entry. We will compete with major U.S. and non-U.S. reinsurers, including several Bermuda-based reinsurers that write property and casualty reinsurance and that target the same market as we do and utilize similar business strategies.
In addition to reinsurance company competitors, other financial institutions are now able to offer services similar to those that we expect to offer. Financial institutions have also created alternative capital market products that compete with reinsurance products, such as reinsurance securitization. Such alternative products may be perceived to be more beneficial for ceding companies than reinsurance offered by reinsurance companies and may result in lower demand for certain of our products.
Since we have no operating history, many of our competitors have greater name and brand recognition than we currently do. Many of them also have more (in some cases substantially more) capital and greater marketing and management resources than we expect to have, and may offer a broader range of products and more competitive pricing than we expect to or will be able to offer.
Our competitive position will be based on many factors, including our perceived overall financial strength, ratings assigned by independent rating agencies, geographic scope of business, client relationships, premiums charged, contract terms and conditions, products and services offered (including the ability to design customized programs), speed of claims payment, reputation, experience and qualifications of employees and local presence. Since we have not yet commenced operations, we may not be able to compete successfully on any of these bases. If competition limits our ability to write new business at adequate rates, our return on capital may be adversely affected.
The September 11, 2001 terrorist attack has generated substantial new capital inflows into the reinsurance industry, increasing competition which could adversely affect our profitability.
Following the terrorist attack of September 11, 2001, a number of new reinsurers and other entities have been formed and a number of existing market participants have raised new capital in an effort to participate in an improving marketplace. These new and better financed companies are expected to increase the level of competition in the industry, which may affect our competitive position. While we believe that we and our competitors will be able to raise premium rates in the near and intermediate term, the additional competition following the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack may limit such increases or result in decreases in premium rates.
We are not yet rated by A.M. Best and this could affect our competitive position with customers.
Competition in the types of reinsurance business that we intend to underwrite is based on many factors, including the perceived financial strength of the reinsurer and ratings assigned by independent rating agencies. A.M. Best Company, Inc. ("Best's") is generally considered to be a significant rating agency with respect to the evaluation of insurance and reinsurance companies. Best's ratings are based on a quantitative evaluation of performance with respect to profitability, leverage and liquidity and a qualitative evaluation of spread of risk, reinsurance program, investments, reserves and management. Insurance ratings are used by insurers and reinsurance intermediaries as an important means of assessing the financial strength and quality of reinsurers.
17
In addition, a ceding company's own rating may be adversely affected by the lack of a rating of its reinsurer. Therefore, the lack of a rating may dissuade a ceding company from reinsuring with us and may influence a ceding company to reinsure with a competitor of ours that has an insurance rating.
Our management has met with Best's, which has advised us that it expects to assign an initial financial strength rating of "A" (Excellent) to our operating subsidiaries upon the completion of the Public Offering and the receipt of the offering proceeds in line with certain representations we made to Best's. In addition, the rating assignment is contingent upon the funding of our operating subsidiaries to the levels indicated by our management as well as the execution of all pertinent transactions as detailed by this prospectus. The rating assignment further contemplates the initiation of certain capital support agreements between Platinum Holdings and its operating subsidiaries.
However, we may not obtain the "A" rating if we do not receive a sufficient amount of proceeds from the Public Offering in order to capitalize our operating subsidiaries at appropriate levels, execute the transactions described in this prospectus or otherwise satisfy the conditions set by Best's for the assignment to us of such a rating.
Consolidation in the insurance industry could lead to lower margins for us and less demand for our reinsurance products and services.
The insurance industry is undergoing a process of consolidation as industry participants seek to enhance their product and geographic reach, client base, operating efficiency and general market power through merger and acquisition activities. These larger entities may seek to use the benefits of consolidation to, among other things, implement price reductions for their products and services. If competitive pressures compel us to reduce our prices, our operating margins would decrease.
As the insurance industry consolidates, competition for customers may become more intense and the importance of acquiring and properly servicing each customer will become greater. We could incur greater expenses relating to customer acquisition and retention, which could reduce our operating margins. In addition, insurance companies that merge may be able to enhance their negotiating position when buying reinsurance and may be able to spread their risks across a consolidated, larger capital base so that they require less reinsurance.
We are dependent on key executives and have not yet completed assembling our management team.
Our success will depend in substantial part upon the continued service of Steven H. Newman as our Chairman of the Board of Directors and Jerome T. Fadden as our President and Chief Executive Officer. Mr. Fadden's employment contract will expire on March 4, 2007 unless extended. Mr. Newman will serve as a consultant to Platinum US through March 1, 2005 unless his consulting contract is extended. We have not yet completed assembling our leadership team, including our chief financial officer, and may not be able to do so. Our success will also depend on our ability to attract and retain additional executives and underwriting personnel. We believe that there are only a limited number of available, qualified executives in the reinsurance industry, and our inability to hire additional senior executives or the loss of the services of any of our senior executives could delay or prevent us from fully implementing our business strategy and could significantly and negatively affect our business.
Under Bermuda law, non-Bermudians (other than spouses of Bermudians) may not engage in any gainful occupation in Bermuda without a work permit. None of our executive officers is a Bermudian, and all such officers will be working in Bermuda under work permits. We are seeking work permits for Mr. Fadden and other persons who will be employees of Platinum Holdings, as
18
well as all persons who will be employees of Platinum Bermuda who are not Bermuda citizens, from the Bermuda authorities. The Bermuda government recently announced a new policy that places a six-year term limit on individuals with work permits, subject to certain exemptions for key employees. It is possible that we could lose the services of one or more of these people if we are unable to obtain or renew their work permits, which could significantly and adversely affect our business.
The occurrence of severe catastrophic events may have a material adverse effect on our financial results and financial condition.
Because we intend to underwrite property and casualty reinsurance and will have large aggregate exposures to natural and man-made disasters, we expect that our loss experience generally will include infrequent events of great severity. The frequency and severity of catastrophe losses are inherently unpredictable. Consequently, the occurrence of losses from catastrophic events is likely to cause a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition. For example, St. Paul Re recorded pre-tax catastrophe losses of $135 million in 2000 and $143 million in 1999, materially impacting its results of operations during those years. In addition, catastrophes are an inherent risk of our business and a catastrophe or series of catastrophes can be expected to have a material adverse effect on our ability to write new business, and our financial condition and results of operations, possibly to the extent of eliminating our shareholders' equity and statutory surplus (which is the amount remaining after all liabilities, including loss reserves, are subtracted from all admitted assets, as determined under statutory accounting principles, which are the principles prescribed or permitted by U.S. insurance regulatory authorities). Increases in the values and geographic concentrations of insured property and the effects of inflation have historically resulted in increased severity of industry losses in recent years and we expect that those factors will increase the severity of catastrophe losses in the future.
The September 11, 2001 terrorist attack may result in government intervention impacting the insurance and reinsurance markets.
In response to the tightening of supply in certain insurance markets resulting from, among other things, the terrorist attack of September 11, 2001, the U.S. government and other governments may intervene in the insurance and reinsurance markets. Following the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack, various proposed legislation that is designed to ensure the availability of insurance coverage for terrorist acts has been introduced in the U.S. Congress. Legislation has been adopted in the U.S. House of Representatives designed, among other things, to provide federal government loans over a short-term period to commercial insurers and reinsurers for funding losses arising from terrorist acts against U.S. properties, which loans would be repaid through industry assessments and, if losses exceed a threshold, policyholder assessments. Alternative proposed legislation has been introduced in the U.S. Senate, including legislation providing for the direct payment by the U.S. government for losses arising from terrorist acts to the insureds of insurers who continue to write such coverage, legislation that would provide direct government assistance to insurers and legislation that would require insurers to write coverage for terrorist acts and establish a mandatory reinsurance pool, which is an organization of reinsurers through which a particular type of reinsurance is written, with premiums, losses and expenses being shared in agreed ratios. We cannot predict whether any such legislation will be enacted or what form it may take. You should note that governmental intervention could significantly and adversely affect us by, among other things:
- •
- providing competing insurance and reinsurance capacity in the markets and to the customers we expect to target;
- •
- regulating the terms of insurance and reinsurance capacity and reinsurance policies in a manner that could significantly and adversely affect us, directly or indirectly, by requiring
19
- •
- providing sources of liquidity to U.S. companies that may not be available to our non-U.S. subsidiaries; or
- •
- otherwise disproportionally benefiting U.S. or other foreign countries' companies over Bermuda-based companies such as Platinum Holdings and its Bermuda subsidiary.
coverage for terrorist acts to be offered by insurers and reinsurers, benefiting our competitors, reducing the demand for our products or benefiting insurers as compared to reinsurers such as ourselves;
The September 11, 2001 terrorist attack has caused uncertainty as to future insurance and reinsurance coverage for terrorist acts, and we may in the future have substantial exposure to such acts.
Following the terrorist attack of September 11, 2001, there is uncertainty in the insurance and reinsurance markets about the extent to which future coverages will extend to terrorist acts. There is also uncertainty about the definition of terrorist acts. We believe that coverage of claims that are the result of terrorist acts (as they are ultimately defined by industry and government standards) will generally be excluded from property catastrophe reinsurance contracts covering large commercial risks above specified property values, but generally will not be excluded for smaller commercial coverages, personal lines written for individuals or families or other coverages. Accordingly, we presently continue to incur exposure to terrorist acts. The extent to which coverage for terrorist acts will be offered by the insurance and reinsurance markets in the future is uncertain. Coverage for losses resulting from terrorist acts may be offered separately in the reinsurance market, and we may or may not offer such coverage in the future. If our and the insurance industry's attempts to exclude terrorist acts from contracts covering large commercial risks that exceed specified values were to fail, we could incur large unexpected losses if further terrorist attacks occur.
The failure to be effective of any of the loss limitation methods we employ could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or our results of operations.
Our property and casualty reinsurance contracts cover unpredictable events such as hurricanes, windstorms, hailstorms, earthquakes, volcanic eruptions, fires, industrial explosions, freezes, riots, floods, and other natural or man-made disasters. We intend to seek to limit our loss exposure by writing the majority of our products on an excess-of-loss basis. We also intend to limit the aggregate amount of all treaties for each client and to execute prudent underwriting of each program written. In the case of treaties where we reinsure a proportionate part of premiums and losses, which are referred to as pro rata or proportional treaties, we intend to seek per occurrence limitations or caps on the ratio of losses to premiums, which are referred to as loss cap ratios, to limit the impact of losses from any one event. A limited number of the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts that are pro rata do not contain these limits, which means that there is no contractual limit to the losses that we may be required to pay pursuant to such Assumed Reinsurance Contracts. In addition, we intend to seek to limit our loss exposure by geographic diversification. Geographic zone limitations involve significant underwriting judgments, including the specification of the areas constituting the zones and the inclusion of a particular policy within a particular zone's limits. Various provisions of our policies, such as limitations or exclusions from coverage or choice of forum, may not be enforceable in the manner we intend, due to, among other things, disputes relating to coverage and choice of legal forum. Underwriting is a matter of judgment, involving important assumptions about matters that are inherently unpredictable and beyond our control, and for which historical experience and probability analysis may not provide sufficient guidance. One or more catastrophic or other events could result in claims that substantially exceed our expectations, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or our results of operations, possibly to the extent of eliminating our shareholders' equity and statutory surplus. St. Paul Re recorded net pretax losses of $556 million as a result of the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack, the
20
most significant catastrophe to date for the property-casualty insurance industry. Contributing to the significance of these losses were certain contracts having occurrence limits that excluded natural perils but not man-made disasters. Had these occurrence limits excluded man-made disasters, St. Paul Re's losses would have been approximately $25 million lower.
We intend to purchase retrocessional reinsurance, which will subject us to credit risk and may become unavailable on acceptable terms.
In order to limit the effect on our financial condition of large and multiple losses, we intend to buy retrocessional reinsurance, which is reinsurance for our own account. From time to time, market conditions have limited, and in some cases have prevented, insurers and reinsurers from obtaining the types and amounts of reinsurance which they consider adequate for their business needs. As a result of the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack, both pricing and terms have become more severe in the retrocessional reinsurance market, which may limit our ability to obtain desired amounts of retrocessional reinsurance at acceptable pricing. If we are unable to obtain retrocessional reinsurance, our financial position and results of operations may be materially adversely affected. Moreover, the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack, threats of further terrorist attacks and the military initiatives and political unrest in Afghanistan, the Middle East and the surrounding regions have adversely affected general economic, market and political conditions, increasing many of the risks of our business. Over time, the rating agencies could re-examine the ratings affecting our industry. We may not be able to obtain our desired amounts of retrocessional reinsurance on acceptable terms. St. Paul Re had retrocessional arrangements through St. Paul, and we may not be able to obtain replacement agreements. Even if we are able to obtain such retrocessional reinsurance, we may not be able to negotiate terms as favorable to us as the terms that St. Paul Re was able to obtain through St. Paul in prior years. Loss of all or portions of our retrocessional coverage could subject us to increased exposure, which could be material.
A retrocessionaire's insolvency or its inability or unwillingness to make payments under the terms of its reinsurance treaty with us could have a material adverse effect on us. Therefore, our retrocessions subject us to credit risk because the ceding of risk to retrocessionaires does not relieve a reinsurer of its liability to the ceding companies.
If we are required to increase our loss reserves, our operating results will be adversely affected.
At any time, our loss reserves may prove to be inadequate to cover our actual losses and benefits experience. To the extent loss reserves may be insufficient to cover actual losses or loss adjustment expenses, we will have to add to these loss reserves and incur a charge to our earnings, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of underwriting and cash flows. St. Paul Re has experienced such instances where a re-estimation of loss reserves has proved to be material and, in 2001, recorded a net additional provision of $95 million related to losses incurred in prior years. This provision reflected worse than expected loss emergence in St. Paul Re's North American Property segment, largely driven by certain property business underwritten through its London office, and in the surplus lines business.
Our loss reserves will not represent an exact calculation of liability, but rather will be estimates of the expected cost of the ultimate settlement of losses. We expect that all of our loss reserve estimates will be based on actuarial and statistical projections at a given time, of facts and circumstances known at that time and estimates of trends in loss severity and other variable factors, including new concepts of liability and general economic conditions. Changes in these trends or other variable factors could result in claims in excess of our loss reserves.
Unforeseen losses, the type or magnitude of which we cannot predict, may emerge in the future. These additional losses could arise from changes in the legal environment, catastrophic
21
events, extraordinary events affecting our clients such as reorganizations and liquidations or changes in general economic conditions.
In addition, because we, like other reinsurers, will not separately evaluate each of the individual risks assumed under reinsurance treaties, we will be largely dependent on the original underwriting decisions made by ceding companies. We will be subject to the risk that our ceding companies may not have adequately evaluated the risks to be reinsured and that the premiums ceded to us may not adequately compensate us for the risks we assume.
Under U.S. GAAP, Platinum US, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda will not be permitted to establish loss reserves until an event occurs which may give rise to a loss. Once such an event occurs, reserves will be established based upon estimates of the total losses incurred by the ceding insurers and an estimate of the portion of such loss our three operating subsidiaries have reinsured. As a result, only loss reserves applicable to losses incurred up to the reporting date may be set aside, with no allowance for the provision of a contingency reserve to account for expected future losses. Losses arising from future events will be estimated and recognized at the time the loss is incurred and could be substantial.
The property and casualty reinsurance business is historically cyclical, and we expect to experience periods with excess underwriting capacity and unfavorable pricing.
Historically, property and casualty reinsurers have experienced significant fluctuations in operating results. Demand for reinsurance is influenced significantly by underwriting results of primary insurers and prevailing general economic and market conditions, all of which affect cedents' decisions as to the amount or portion of risk that they retain for their own accounts and consequently reinsurance premium rates. The supply of reinsurance is related to prevailing prices, the levels of insured losses and levels of industry surplus which, in turn, may fluctuate in response to changes in rates of return on investments being earned in the reinsurance industry. As a result, the property and casualty reinsurance business historically has been a cyclical industry characterized by periods of intense price competition due to excessive underwriting capacity as well as periods when shortages of capacity permitted favorable premium levels. We can expect to experience the effects of such cyclicality.
The cyclical trends in the industry and the industry's profitability can also be affected significantly by volatile and unpredictable developments, including what management believes to be a trend of courts to grant increasingly larger awards for certain damages, natural disasters (such as catastrophic hurricanes, windstorms, tornadoes, earthquakes and floods), fluctuations in interest rates, changes in the investment environment that affect market prices of and income and returns on investments and inflationary pressures that may tend to affect the size of losses experienced by primary insurance companies. Although market conditions have improved recently with respect to some lines of property and casualty reinsurance, we cannot predict whether market conditions will continue to improve, remain constant or deteriorate. A return to negative market conditions may affect our ability to write reinsurance at rates that we consider appropriate relative to the risk assumed. If we cannot write property and casualty reinsurance at appropriate rates, our ability to transact reinsurance business would be significantly and adversely affected.
A significant amount of our invested assets will be subject to market volatility.
Our investment portfolio will consist initially of fixed income securities and, in the future, may include marketable equity securities. The fair market value of these assets and the investment income from these assets will fluctuate depending on general economic and market conditions. Fixed income and equity markets have become increasingly volatile in the last year and particularly since the events of September 11, 2001. Because substantially all of our invested assets will be classified as available for sale, changes in the market value of our securities will be reflected in our
22
consolidated balance sheet. In addition, market fluctuations and market volatility will affect the value of our investment portfolio and could adversely affect our liquidity.
Increases in interest rates or fluctuations in currency exchange rates may cause us to experience losses.
Because of the unpredictable nature of losses that may arise under reinsurance policies, our liquidity needs can be expected to be substantial and to arise at any time. The market value of our fixed income investments will be subject to fluctuation depending on changes in various factors, including prevailing interest rates. We expect to hedge our investment portfolio against interest rate risk. Nevertheless, increases in interest rates during periods when we sell fixed income securities to satisfy liquidity needs may result in losses.
Our functional currency will be the U.S. dollar. Our operating currency generally will also be the U.S. dollar. However, the premiums receivable and losses payable in respect of a portion of our business will be denominated in currencies of other countries, principally the industrialized countries. Consequently, we may, from time to time, experience exchange gains and losses that could affect our financial position and results of operations. We do not expect to—and as a practical matter will not be able to—hedge our foreign currency exposure with respect to potential losses until a loss payable in a foreign currency occurs (after which we may match such liability with assets denominated in the same currency or enter into forward purchase contracts for specific currencies). This type of exposure could be substantial. We also do not intend to hedge our non-U.S. dollar currency exposure with respect to premiums receivable, which will be generally collected over the relevant contract term. We expect to exchange non-U.S. dollar denominated premiums upon receipt. We may make foreign currency denominated investments, generally for the purpose of improving overall portfolio yield.
Platinum UK may not be licensed in the United Kingdom at the time of completion of the Public Offering, and any license, once obtained, may be subject to limitations on Platinum UK's operations.
Platinum UK has applied to the Financial Services Authority ("FSA") to write the business conducted by St. Paul Re in the United Kingdom. Platinum UK may not be licensed by the FSA at the time of the completion of the Public Offering. Any license, when obtained, may contain restrictions which could be material to our results of operations. St. Paul has agreed that it will continue to write reinsurance in the United Kingdom and that Platinum US will reinsure such business for a period of one year after the completion of the Public Offering.
We have not completed arranging a bank credit facility or letter of credit facility, and failure to do so would limit our liquidity and could affect our ability to compete for certain business.
We are in the process of negotiating a bank credit facility to provide Platinum Holdings, as well as Platinum US, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda, with liquidity beyond the net proceeds of the Public Offering that will be allocated to each. Failure to arrange a credit facility, or another source of liquidity, would limit Platinum Holdings liquidity to the net proceeds of the Public Offering retained by it and dividends received from Platinum US, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda. In addition, failure to arrange a letter of credit facility could adversely affect our ability to write business in certain instances where providing a letter of credit satisfies regulatory requirements permitting the ceding insurer to take statutory credit for the reinsurance.
23
Platinum Holdings is a holding company and, consequently, it is dependent on the payment of cash dividends or the extension of loans by Platinum US, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda.
Platinum Holdings is a holding company that will conduct no reinsurance operations of its own. All its operations will be conducted through its wholly-owned operating subsidiaries, Platinum US, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda. As a holding company, Platinum Holdings' cash flow will consist primarily of dividends, interest and other permissable payments from its subsidiaries. Platinum Holdings will depend on such payments to receive funds for general corporate purposes and to meet its obligations, including the payment of any dividends to its shareholders. Additionally, under the Bermuda Companies Act 1981, Platinum Holdings may declare or pay a dividend only if, among other things, it has reasonable grounds for believing that it is, or would after the payment be, able to pay its liabilities as they become due. For a discussion of the legal limitations on our subsidiaries' ability to pay dividends to Platinum Holdings, see "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Pro Forma Financial Condition and Underwriting Results—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Restrictions on Dividend Payments from our Operating Subsidiaries" and "Business—Regulation".
The regulatory system under which we operate, and potential changes thereto, could significantly and adversely affect our business.
Platinum Holdings. As the indirect parent of Platinum US, Platinum Holdings will be subject to the insurance holding company laws of Maryland, where Platinum US is organized and domiciled. This law generally requires the insurance holding company and each insurance company directly or indirectly owned by the holding company to register with the Maryland Insurance Commissioner and to furnish annually financial and other information. Generally, all transactions affecting the insurers in the holding company system must be fair and, if material, require prior notice and approval or non-disapproval by the Maryland Insurance Commissioner.
Platinum US. Platinum US is organized and domiciled in Maryland and licensed, authorized or accredited to write reinsurance in 21 states of the United States and is seeking licenses in eleven additional states. State insurance laws regulate many aspects of its reinsurance business and state insurance departments in the licensure states will supervise its reinsurance operations. Its principal insurance regulatory authority will be the Maryland Insurance Commissioner. The purpose of the state insurance regulatory statutes is to protect insureds and ceding insurance companies, not our shareholders. Among other things, Maryland regulation requires Platinum US to maintain minimum levels of capital, surplus and liquidity, and impose restrictions on payment of dividends and distributions. These statutes and regulations may, in effect, restrict the ability of Platinum US to write new business or, as indicated above, distribute funds to Platinum Holdings. In recent years, the state insurance regulatory framework has come under increased federal scrutiny, and some state legislators have considered or enacted laws that may alter or increase state authority to regulate insurance companies and insurance holding companies. Moreover, the National Association of Insurance Commissioners (NAIC), which is an association of the senior insurance regulatory officials of all 50 states and the District of Columbia, and state insurance regulators regularly reexamine existing laws and regulations, interpretations of existing laws and the development of new laws, which may be more restrictive or may result in higher costs to us than current statutory requirements.
Platinum UK. As described above, we expect that, upon completion of the Public Offering, Platinum UK will not be authorized by the FSA to conduct insurance business in the U.K. However, once Platinum UK becomes an authorized person, its insurance business will be subject to close supervision by the FSA.
24
We expect the FSA will take a rigorous and proactive approach to its supervisory duties. Among other things, the FSA is seeking to strengthen its requirements for senior management arrangements, systems and controls by requiring insurance companies to maintain risk management teams, to determine and document policies for dealing with risks and to demonstrate how combinations of risks have been aggregated and mitigated. In addition, as part of an initiative to integrate regulation throughout the financial services sector, the FSA intends to place an increased emphasis on risk identification and management in relation to the prudential regulation of insurance businesses in the U.K.
Further, given that the framework for supervision of insurance companies in the U.K. is largely formed by European Union ("EU") directives (which are implemented by member states through national legislation), changes at the EU level may affect the regulatory scheme under which Platinum UK operates. A general review of EU insurance directives is currently in progress and may lead to changes such as increased minimum capital requirements.
Platinum Bermuda. Platinum Bermuda is a registered Bermuda insurance company and is subject to regulation and supervision in Bermuda. The applicable Bermuda statutes and regulations generally are designed to protect insureds and ceding insurance companies, not our shareholders. Platinum Bermuda is not registered or licensed as an insurance company in any jurisdiction outside Bermuda. Platinum Bermuda will conduct its business through its offices in Bermuda and will not maintain an office, and its personnel will not conduct any insurance activities in the U.S. or elsewhere. Although Platinum Bermuda does not believe it will be in violation of insurance laws of any jurisdiction outside Bermuda, inquiries or challenges to Platinum Bermuda's insurance activities may still be raised in the future.
Platinum Bermuda may be at a competitive disadvantage in jurisdictions where it is not licensed, authorized or accredited or does not enjoy an exemption from licensing. Platinum Bermuda may not be able to obtain any additional licenses, authorizations or accreditations or may be able to do so only at great cost. Many U.S. jurisdictions do not permit insurance companies to take credit for reinsurance obtained from unlicensed or non-admitted insurers on their U.S. statutory financial statements without appropriate security. We expect that Platinum Bermuda's reinsurance clients will typically require it to post a letter of credit or enter into other security arrangements, which will increase its costs of operations relative to reinsurers not required to do so. If Platinum Bermuda is unable to obtain a letter of credit facility on commercially acceptable terms or is unable to arrange for other types of security, its ability to operate its business may be severely limited.
The offshore insurance and reinsurance regulatory framework recently has become subject to increased scrutiny in many jurisdictions, including in the United States and in various states within the United States. In the past, there have been congressional and other proposals in the United States regarding increased supervision and regulation of the insurance industry, including proposals to supervise and regulate reinsurers domiciled outside the United States. If Platinum Bermuda were to become subject to any insurance laws and regulations of the United States or any U.S. state, which are generally more restrictive than those applicable to it in Bermuda, at any time in the future, it might be required to post deposits or maintain minimum surplus levels and might be prohibited from engaging in lines of business or from writing specified types of policies or contracts. Complying with those laws could have a material adverse effect on our ability to conduct business or our results of operations.
We will be dependent on the business provided to us by reinsurance brokers and we may be exposed to liability for brokers' failure to make payments to clients for their claims.
We intend to market most of our reinsurance products through reinsurance brokers. The reinsurance brokerage industry generally, and our sources of business specifically, are concentrated. On a pro forma basis, based on net premiums written during the three months ended
25
March 31, 2002, the five brokers from which St. Paul Re derived the largest portions of its business (with the approximate percentage of our business derived from such brokers and their affiliates) are Aon Corporation (25.7%), Marsh & McLennan Companies (18.6%), Benfield Blanch Inc. (18.5%), Willis Group Holdings (9.7%) and Clayton Denis M. & Co. (4.5%). Loss of all or a substantial portion of the business provided by such intermediaries could have a material adverse effect on us. In addition, at least two of these brokers have announced their intention to form new Bermuda reinsurance companies that may compete with us, and these brokers may favor their own reinsurers over other companies, including us.
In accordance with industry practice, we expect to frequently pay amounts owing in respect of claims under our policies to reinsurance brokers, for payment over to the ceding insurers. In the event that a broker fails to make such a payment, depending on the jurisdiction, we may remain liable to the ceding insurer for the deficiency. Conversely, in certain jurisdictions, when premiums for such policies are paid to reinsurance brokers for payment over to us, such premiums will be deemed to have been paid and the ceding insurer will no longer be liable to us for those amounts whether or not actually received by us. Consequently, we will assume a degree of credit risk associated with our brokers during the payment process.
Because we are dependent on certain contractual relationships with St. Paul, our principal shareholder, we may experience conflicts of interest with St. Paul that may be detrimental to our business.
Concurrently with the Public Offering, in return for the contribution of the Transferred Business, we have agreed to issue up to 13,262,300 Common Shares to St. Paul and to grant to St. Paul the St. Paul Ownership Option and St. Paul Participation Option, each as described in more detail under "St. Paul Investment and Principal Shareholders". Following the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, St. Paul will own up to approximately 24.9% of our Common Shares (which shares will be limited to 9.9% of the voting power of the outstanding Common Shares). St. Paul's interest in owning Common Shares may be different than other shareholders.
In connection with our formation, we have agreed with St. Paul and certain of its affiliates to enter into, among other things, a Formation and Separation Agreement, several Master Services Agreements, Quota Share Retrocession Agreements, Run-off Services Agreements and Underwriting Management Agreements. These agreements, which we refer to as the "Inception Agreements", will become effective upon the completion of the Public Offering (except the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements which will take effect at 12:01 A.M., on the later of the business day immediately following the date of completion of the Public Offering or July 1, 2002) and will govern our relationship with St. Paul with respect to various intercompany services, which we and St. Paul will provide one another following the completion of the Public Offering. The terms of the Inception Agreements have been negotiated between Platinum and St. Paul but do not necessarily reflect terms that Platinum or St. Paul would agree to with an independent third party. Notwithstanding these contractual relationships, St. Paul (other than as restricted by the non-competition provisions of the Formation and Separation Agreement), and its subsidiaries and affiliates, may from time to time compete with us, including by assisting or investing in the formation of other entities engaged in the insurance and reinsurance businesses. Conflicts of interest could also arise with respect to business opportunities that could be advantageous to St. Paul and any of its subsidiaries or affiliates, on the one hand, and us, on the other hand. Other than as specified in the Inception Agreements, St. Paul is under no obligation to deal with us on any basis other than arm's length or to treat us as a "preferred provider" or grant us any other preferential treatment. St. Paul or its subsidiaries or affiliates have entered, and may enter, into agreements and maintain relationships with numerous companies that may directly compete with us.
26
Risks Related to Our Common Shares
There is no prior public market for the Common Shares.
Prior to the Public Offering, there has been no public trading market for the Common Shares. If an active trading market does not develop and continue upon completion of the Public Offering, your investment may become less liquid and the market price of the Common Shares may decline, even below the initial public offering price. The initial public offering price per Common Share in the Public Offering will be determined by agreement among the Company, St. Paul and the representatives of the underwriters and may not be indicative of the market price of the Common Shares after the Public Offering. The Common Shares have been approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange (the "NYSE") under the symbol "PTP" subject to notice of issuance.
It may be difficult to enforce service of process and enforcement of judgments against us and our officers and directors.
We are a Bermuda company and certain of our officers and directors will be residents of various jurisdictions outside the U.S. A substantial portion of our assets and our officers and directors, at any one time, are or may be located in jurisdictions outside the U.S. Although we have irrevocably appointed CT Corporation System as an agent in New York, New York to receive service of process with respect to actions against us arising out of violations of the U.S. federal securities laws in any federal or state court in the U.S. relating to the transactions covered by this prospectus, it may be difficult for investors to effect service of process within the U.S. on our directors and officers who reside outside the U.S. or to enforce against us or our directors and officers judgments of U.S. courts predicated upon civil liability provisions of the U.S. federal securities laws.
Future sales of Common Shares may affect their market price.
Sales of substantial amounts of the Common Shares in the public market following the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, or the perception that such sales could occur, could adversely affect the market price of the Common Shares and may make it more difficult for us to sell our equity securities in the future, or for shareholders to sell their Common Shares, at a time and price which they deem appropriate. Upon completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, depending on the initial public offering price of our Common Shares, there will be up to 53,262,300 Common Shares outstanding. In the event the underwriters' option to purchase an additional 6,000,000 Common Shares is exercised, St. Paul will be issued (as part of the consideration for the Transferred Business) in the aggregate up to an additional 1,989,300 shares in order to maintain the proportionate initial share ownership in the Company it obtained prior to the underwriters exercising their option to purchase additional Common Shares. As a result, if the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares is exercised in full and these additional shares are issued to St. Paul, there would be, depending on the initial public offering price of our Common Shares, up to 61,251,600 Common Shares outstanding upon completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment. The Common Shares sold in the Public Offering will be freely tradeable without restriction or future registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "1933 Act"), by persons other than "affiliates" of the Company. The Common Shares sold in the St. Paul Investment will be "restricted securities" within the meaning of the 1933 Act and may not be sold in the absence of registration under the 1933 Act or an exemption therefrom. St. Paul has been granted rights to require the Company to register its Common Shares issued to St. Paul. Pursuant to a lock-up agreement, each of the Company and St. Paul and the Company's officers and directors has agreed that for a period of 180 days from the closing date of the Public Offering it will not, without the prior written consent of Goldman, Sachs & Co., sell, offer to sell, contract to sell or otherwise dispose of any Common Shares or any other securities convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for any Common Shares or grant options to purchase any Common Shares subject
27
to certain limited exceptions. For a description of the St. Paul Investment, see "St. Paul Investment and Principal Shareholders".
Public investors will suffer immediate and substantial dilution.
In the St. Paul Investment, we will issue to St. Paul, as the consideration for the Transferred Business contributed to us, depending on the initial public offering price of our Common Shares, up to 13,262,300 Common Shares. St. Paul will contribute to us the Transferred Business in return for, and not pay cash for, its Common Shares, and we will record the assets so contributed at their historical cost. As a result, the initial public offering price per Common Share is significantly higher than our net tangible book value per share. Accordingly, if you purchase Common Shares in the Public Offering, you will suffer immediate and substantial dilution of your investment. Based upon the issuance and sale of 40,000,000 Common Shares at an assumed initial public offering price of $25, you will incur immediate dilution of approximately $6.85 in the net tangible book value per Common Share.
There are limitations on the ownership, transfers and voting rights of our Common Shares.
Under our bye-laws, our directors are required to decline to register any transfer of Common Shares that would result in a person (or any group of which such person is a member), beneficially owning, directly or indirectly, 10% or more of the voting shares, or in the case of St. Paul and its subsidiaries beneficially owning, directly or indirectly, 25% or more of such shares. Similar restrictions apply to our ability to issue or repurchase shares. The directors also may, in their discretion, decline to register the transfer of any shares if they have reason to believe (1) that the transfer may lead to adverse tax or regulatory consequences in any jurisdiction or (2) that the transfer would violate the registration requirements of the U.S. federal securities laws or of any other jurisdiction. These restrictions would apply to a transfer of shares even if the transfer has been executed on the NYSE. A transferor of Common Shares will be deemed to own those shares for dividend, voting and reporting purposes until a transfer of those Common Shares has been registered on our register of shareholders. We are authorized to request information from any holder or prospective acquiror of Common Shares as necessary to give effect to the transfer, issuance and repurchase restrictions referred to above, and may decline to effect any transaction if complete and accurate information is not received as requested.
In addition, our bye-laws generally provide that any person (or any group of which such person is a member) beneficially owning, directly or indirectly, shares carrying 10% or more of the total voting rights attached to all of our outstanding voting shares, will have the voting rights attached to its issued shares reduced so that it may not exercise 10% or more of such total voting rights. Because of the attribution provisions of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"), and the rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "SEC") regarding determination of beneficial ownership, this requirement may have the effect of reducing the voting rights of a shareholder whether or not such shareholder directly holds 10% or more of our Common Shares. Further, the directors have the authority to require from any shareholder certain information for the purpose of determining whether that shareholder's voting rights are to be reduced. Failure to respond to such a notice, or submitting incomplete or inaccurate information, gives the directors (or their designee) discretion to disregard all votes attached to that shareholder's Common Shares. See "Description of Our Common Shares".
The insurance law of Maryland prevents any person from acquiring control of us or of Platinum US unless that person has filed a notification with specified information with the Maryland Insurance Commissioner and has obtained his prior approval. Under the Maryland statute, acquiring 10% or more of the voting stock of an insurance company or its parent company is presumptively considered a change of control, although such presumption may be rebutted. Accordingly, any
28
person who acquires, directly or indirectly, 10% or more of the voting securities of Platinum Holdings without the prior approval of the Maryland Insurance Commissioner will be in violation of this law and may be subject to injunctive action requiring the disposition or seizure of those securities by the Maryland Insurance Commissioner or prohibiting the voting of those securities and to other actions determined by the Maryland Insurance Commissioner. In addition, many U.S. state insurance laws require prior notification of state insurance departments of a change in control of a non-domiciliary insurance company doing business in that state. While these pre-notification statutes do not authorize the state insurance departments to disapprove the change in control, they authorize regulatory action in the affected state if particular conditions exist such as undue market concentration. Any future transactions that would constitute a change in control of Platinum Holdings may require prior notification in those states that have adopted preacquisition notification laws.
Common Shares may be offered or sold in Bermuda only in compliance with the provisions of the Investment Business Act 1998 of Bermuda. In addition, sales of Common Shares to persons resident in Bermuda for Bermuda exchange control purposes may require the prior approval of the Bermuda Monetary Authority. Consent under the Exchange Act of 1972 (and regulations thereunder) has been obtained from the Bermuda Monetary Authority for the issue and transfer of the Common Shares being offered pursuant to this offering and between non-residents of Bermuda for exchange control purposes, provided our Common Shares remain listed on an appointed stock exchange, which includes the NYSE. This prospectus will be filed with the Registrar of Companies in Bermuda in accordance with Bermuda law. In giving such consent, and in accepting this prospectus for filing, neither the Bermuda Monetary Authority nor the Registrar of Companies accepts any responsibility for the financial soundness of any proposal or for the correctness of any of the statements made or opinions expressed herein.
The Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 ("FSMA") regulates the acquisition of "control" of any U.K. insurance company authorized under FSMA. Any company or individual that (together with its or his associates) directly or indirectly acquires 10% or more of the shares in the parent company of a U.K. authorized insurance company, or is entitled to exercise or control the exercise of 10% or more of the voting power in such a parent company, would be considered to have acquired "control" for the purposes of the relevant legislation, as would a person who had significant influence over the management of such parent company by virtue of his shareholding in it. A purchaser of more than 10% of the Common Shares would therefore be considered to have acquired "control" of Platinum UK.
Under FSMA, any person proposing to acquire "control" over a U.K. authorized insurance company must give prior notification to the FSA of his intention to do so. The FSA would then have three months to consider that person's application to acquire "control". In considering whether to approve such application, the FSA must be satisfied both that the acquirer is a fit and proper person to have such "control" and that the interests of consumers would not be threatened by such acquisition of "control". Failure to make the relevant prior application would constitute a criminal offense.
The foregoing provisions of our bye-laws and legal restrictions will have the effect of rendering more difficult or discouraging unsolicited takeover bids from third parties or the removal of incumbent management.
Your investment could be materially adversely affected if we are deemed to be engaged in business in the U.S.
Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda are Bermuda companies, Platinum UK is a U.K. company, and Platinum Ireland is an Irish company. We believe that Platinum Holdings, Platinum UK, Platinum Bermuda and Platinum Ireland will each operate in such a manner that none of these
29
companies will be subject to U.S. tax (other than U.S. excise tax on reinsurance premiums and withholding tax on certain investment income from U.S. sources) because they will not be engaged in a trade or business in the U.S. Nevertheless, because definitive identification of activities which constitute being engaged in a trade or business in the U.S. is not provided by the Code or regulations or court decisions, the U.S. Internal Revenue Service (the "IRS") might contend that any of Platinum Holdings, Platinum UK, Platinum Bermuda or Platinum Ireland are/is engaged in a trade or business in the U.S. If Platinum Holdings, Platinum UK, Platinum Bermuda or Platinum Ireland were engaged in a trade or business in the U.S., and if Platinum UK, Platinum Bermuda or Platinum Ireland were to qualify for benefits under the applicable income tax treaty with the United States, but such trade or business were attributable to a "permanent establishment" in the U.S., Platinum Holdings, Platinum UK, Platinum Bermuda and/or Platinum Ireland would be subject to U.S. tax at regular corporate rates on the income that is effectively connected with the U.S. trade or business, plus an additional 30% "branch profits" tax on such income remaining after the regular tax in certain circumstances, in which case our earnings and your investment could be materially adversely affected.
If you acquire 10% or more of the Common Shares, CFC rules may apply to you.
Under the Code, each "United States shareholder" of a foreign corporation that is a "controlled foreign corporation" ("CFC") for an uninterrupted period of 30 days or more during a taxable year, and who owns shares in the CFC on the last day of the CFC's taxable year must include in its gross income for U.S. federal income tax purposes its pro rata share of the CFC's "subpart F income", even if the subpart F income is not distributed. For these purposes, any U.S. person who owns, directly or through the constructive ownership rules of the Code, 10% or more of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock of a foreign corporation will be considered to be a "United States shareholder". In general, a foreign insurance company such as Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda is treated as a CFC only if such "United States shareholders" collectively own more than 25% of the total combined voting power or total value of our stock. St. Paul will own up to approximately 24.9% of the Common Shares upon completion of this offering, although, pursuant to our bye-laws, the combined voting power of these shares is limited to approximately 9.9% of the combined voting power of all Common Shares. We expect that, because of the limitations on concentration of voting power of our Common Shares, the dispersion of our share ownership among holders other than St. Paul, the provisions for directed voting on matters requiring action by the shareholders of Platinum Bermuda and Platinum UK (including the election of the members of the boards of directors) and the restrictions on transfer, issuance or repurchase of the Common Shares, you will not be subject to treatment as a "United States shareholder" of a CFC. In addition, because under our bye-laws no single shareholder (including St. Paul) is permitted to exercise as much as 10% of the total combined voting power of the Company, you should not be viewed as a "United States shareholder" of a CFC for purposes of these rules. There can be no assurance, however, that these rules will not apply to you. Accordingly, U.S. persons who might, directly, or through the constructive ownership rules of the Code, acquire 10% or more of our Common Shares should consider the possible application of the CFC rules.
Under certain circumstances, you may be required to pay taxes on your pro rata share of Platinum Bermuda's and Platinum UK's related person insurance income.
If Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's related person insurance income ("RPII") were to equal or exceed 20% of Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's gross insurance income in any taxable year and direct or indirect insureds (and persons related to such insureds) own (or are treated as owning directly or indirectly) 20% or more of the voting power or value of the shares of Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda, a U.S. person who owns the Common Shares of Platinum Holdings directly or indirectly on the last day of the taxable year would be required to include in its income for U.S.
30
federal income tax purposes the shareholder's pro rata share of Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's RPII for the entire taxable year, determined as if such RPII were distributed proportionately to such United States shareholders at that date regardless of whether such income is distributed. In addition, U.S. tax-exempt organizations would be required to treat RPII as unrelated business taxable income if Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's RPII equaled or exceeded 20% of Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's gross insurance income in any taxable year. The amount of RPII earned by Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda (generally, premium and related investment income from the direct or indirect insurance or reinsurance of any direct or indirect U.S. shareholder of Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda or any person related to such shareholder, including St. Paul) will depend on a number of factors, including the geographic distribution of Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda's business and the identity of persons directly or indirectly insured or reinsured by Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda. Some of the factors which determine the extent of RPII in any period may be beyond Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's control. Consequently, there can be no assurance that Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's RPII will not equal or exceed 20% of its gross insurance income in any taxable year and that ownership of its shares by direct or indirect insureds and related persons will not equal or exceed the 20% threshold described above.
The RPII rules provide that if a shareholder who is a U.S. person disposes of shares in a foreign insurance corporation that has RPII (even if the amount of RPII is less than 20% of the corporation's gross insurance income) and in which U.S. persons own 25% or more of the shares, any gain from the disposition will generally be treated as ordinary income to the extent of the shareholder's share of the corporation's undistributed earnings and profits that were accumulated during the period that the shareholder owned the shares (whether or not such earnings and profits are attributable to RPII). In addition, such a shareholder will be required to comply with certain reporting requirements, regardless of the amount of shares owned by the shareholder. These rules should not apply to dispositions of Common Shares because Platinum Holdings will not itself be directly engaged in the insurance business and because proposed U.S. Treasury regulations appear to apply only in the case of shares of corporations that are directly engaged in the insurance business. However, the IRS might interpret the proposed regulations in a different manner and the applicable proposed regulations may be promulgated in final form in a manner that would cause these rules to apply to dispositions of our Common Shares.
Changes in U.S. federal income tax law could materially adversely affect shareholders' investment.
Recently proposed U.S. legislation, if enacted, would under certain circumstances treat a foreign corporation as a U.S. corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes and under other circumstances would require obtaining IRS approval of the terms of related-party transactions.
The Company and its subsidiaries would appear generally not to be subject to the proposed legislation as currently drafted. We cannot predict whether the proposed legislation (or any similar legislation) will be enacted or, if enacted, what the specific provisions or the effective date of any such legislation would be, or whether it would have any effect on the Company or its subsidiaries.
If such legislation were enacted and made applicable to the Company and its subsidiaries, we could be treated as a U.S. corporation. If we were treated as a U.S. corporation, we would be subject to taxation in the U.S. at regular corporate rates, in which case our earnings and shareholders' investments would be materially adversely affected. In addition, the U.S. tax consequences to our shareholders would be significantly different from those described below in "Certain Tax Considerations—Taxation of Shareholders—United States Taxation of U.S. and Non-U.S. Shareholders". Prospective investors should consult their tax advisors regarding the U.S. tax consequences to them, in their particular circumstances, if we were treated as a U.S. corporation.
31
We may become subject to taxes in Bermuda after 2016.
We expect, by the time of completion of the Public Offering, to receive a standard assurance from the Bermuda Minister of Finance, under Bermuda's Exempted Undertakings Tax Protection Act 1966, that if any legislation is enacted in Bermuda that would impose tax computed on profits or income, or computed on any capital asset, gain or appreciation, or any tax in the nature of estate duty or inheritance tax, then the imposition of any such tax will not be applicable to us or to any of our operations or our shares, debentures or other obligations until March 28, 2016. Consequently, if our Bermuda tax exemption is not extended past March 28, 2016, we may be subject to any Bermuda tax after that date. For more information on Bermuda taxation of Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda, see "Certain Tax Considerations".
Bermuda could be subject to sanctions by a number of multinational organizations which could adversely affect Bermuda companies.
A number of multinational organizations, including the EU, the Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development ("OECD"), including its Financial Action Task Force, and the Financial Stability Forum have all recently identified certain countries as blocking information exchange, engaging in harmful tax competition or not maintaining adequate controls to prevent corruption, such as money laundering activities. Recommendations to limit such harmful practices are under consideration by these organizations, and a recent report published on November 27, 2001 by the OECD contains an extensive discussion of specific recommendations. The OECD has threatened non-member jurisdictions that do not agree to cooperate with the OECD with punitive sanctions by OECD member countries. It is unclear what these sanctions will be and if they will be imposed. Bermuda has committed to a course of action to enable compliance with the requirements of these multinational organizations. No assurance can be given, however, that the action taken by Bermuda would be sufficient to preclude all effects of the measures or sanctions described above, which if ultimately adopted could adversely affect Bermuda companies such as Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda.
Some of the statements contained in this prospectus, including those using words such as "believes", "expects", "intends", "estimates", "projects", "predicts", "assumes", "anticipates", "plans" and "seeks", and variations thereof, are forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements are statements other than of historical fact. Since Platinum has no history of operations, most of the statements relating to Platinum and its business, including statements relating to its competitive strengths and business strategies, are forward-looking statements. These forward-looking statements are subject to risks and uncertainties and are not a guarantee of future performance. In light of these risks and uncertainties, actual results may differ materially from those suggested by the forward-looking statements for various reasons, including those discussed in this section. We can provide no assurance that we will be able to conduct our business successfully, execute our strategies effectively or achieve our financial and other objectives.
As with any common stock investment, the price of our Common Shares may fluctuate widely depending on many factors, including:
- •
- the perceived prospects of our business in particular and the insurance, asset management, securities and financial services industries generally;
- •
- differences between our actual financial and operating results and those expected by investors and analysts;
- •
- changes in analysts' recommendations or projections;
- •
- changes in general economic, market and political conditions; and
- •
- broad market and interest rate fluctuations.
32
Net tangible book value per Common Share represents the amount of tangible assets less total liabilities, divided by the number of Common Shares outstanding. Dilution in net tangible book value per Common Share represents the difference between the amount per Common Share paid by purchasers of our Common Shares in the Public Offering and the net tangible book value per Common Share, immediately after the Public Offering. Because St. Paul will contribute to us the Transferred Business, and will not pay cash for its Common Shares, and we will record the assets so contributed at their net book value, the initial public offering price per Common Share is significantly higher than our net tangible book value per share. Accordingly, if you purchase Common Shares in the Public Offering, you will suffer immediate and substantial dilution of your investment. After giving effect to (1) St. Paul's contribution of the Transferred Business in return for up to 13,262,300 Common Shares, and (2) our sale of 40,000,000 Common Shares in the Public Offering at an assumed initial public offering price of $23 to $26 per Common Share after deduction of underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us, resulting in net proceeds to us of approximately $865 to $978 million, the range of our pro forma net tangible book value as of April 24, 2002 would have been approximately $891 to $1,003 million, or $17.80 to $18.85 per Common Share. This represents an immediate dilution in pro forma net tangible book value of approximately $5.20 to $7.15 per Common Share to purchasers in this offering.
Assumed initial public offering price per Common Share | $ | 23.00 | $ | 24.00 | $ | 25.00 | $ | 26.00 | |||||
Net tangible book value per Common Share after the offering | 17.80 | 18.00 | 18.15 | 18.85 | |||||||||
Net tangible book value dilution per Common Share to investors | $ | (5.20 | ) | $ | (6.00 | ) | $ | (6.85 | ) | $ | (7.15 | ) | |
As we are newly formed, our net tangible book value before the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment was $12,000 as of April 24, 2002.
The following tables set forth as of April 24, 2002, the total consideration paid and the average price per Common Share paid by St. Paul and by investors, before deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses of $1.27 to $1.43 per Common Share payable by us related to shares purchased by investors, assuming this offering is priced as indicated.
Offer price of $23 per share
| Common Shares Purchased | Pro Forma Total Consideration | | |||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Average Price Per Common Share | |||||||||||
| Number | Percent | Amount | Percent | ||||||||
St. Paul | 10,062,300 | 20.1 | % | $ | 26,460,000 | 2.8 | % | $ | 2.63 | |||
Investors | 40,000,000 | 79.9 | 920,000,000 | 97.2 | 23.00 | |||||||
Total | 50,062,300 | 100.0 | % | $ | 946,460,000 | 100 | % | $ | 18.91 | |||
Offer price of $24 per share
| Common Shares Purchased | Pro Forma Total Consideration | | |||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Average Price Per Common Share | |||||||||||
| Number | Percent | Amount | Percent | ||||||||
St. Paul | 11,612,300 | 22.5 | % | $ | 26,460,000 | 2.7 | % | $ | 2.28 | |||
Investors | 40,000,000 | 77.5 | 960,000,000 | 97.3 | 24.00 | |||||||
Total | 51,612,300 | 100 | % | $ | 986,460,000 | 100 | % | $ | 19.11 | |||
33
Offer price of $25 per share
| Common Shares Purchased | | | | ||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Pro Forma Total Consideration | Average Price Per Common Share | ||||||||||
| Number | Percent | Amount | Percent | ||||||||
St. Paul | 13,262,300 | 24.9 | % | $ | 26,460,000 | 2.6 | % | $ | 2.00 | |||
Investors | 40,000,000 | 75.1 | 1,000,000,000 | 97.4 | 25.00 | |||||||
Total | 53,262,300 | 100 | % | $ | 1,026,460,000 | 100 | % | $ | 19.27 | |||
Offer price of $26 per share
| Common Shares Purchased | | | | ||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Pro Forma Total Consideration | Average Price Per Common Share | ||||||||||
| Number | Percent | Amount | Percent | ||||||||
St. Paul | 13,262,300 | 24.9 | % | $ | 26,460,000 | 2.5 | % | $ | 2.00 | |||
Investors | 40,000,000 | 75.1 | 1,040,000,000 | 97.5 | 26.00 | |||||||
Total | 53,262,300 | 100 | % | $ | 1,066,460,000 | 100 | % | $ | 20.02 | |||
The above tables do not include Common Shares issuable upon (1) exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares in the Public Offering and the concurrent issuance to St. Paul of additional Common Shares to maintain its proportionate share ownership immediately following the Public Offering, (2) the St. Paul Ownership Option, (3) the St. Paul Participation Option or (4) options to be issued to our management and other employees pursuant to our employee compensation plans. Including the underwriters' option to purchase additional shares (and the issuance to St. Paul of additional shares to maintain its ownership level), St. Paul's contribution would be for an average price of from $2.63 to $2.00 per share and investors would be contributing at an average share price of from $23 to $26 per share.
Assuming the Common Shares are offered at $25 per share, the net proceeds from the Public Offering are estimated to be approximately $940 million. A portion of the net proceeds, currently estimated at not less than $10 million, will be retained by Platinum Holdings and the balance will be contributed to the capital of Platinum US (in an amount not less than $200 million), Platinum UK (in an amount not less than $100 million) and Platinum Bermuda (in an amount not less than $500 million).
The Company intends to declare and pay quarterly cash dividends beginning with the fourth quarter of 2002. The declaration and payment of dividends will be at the discretion of the Board of Directors of the Company and will depend upon our results of operations and cash flows, the financial position and capital requirements of Platinum US, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda, general business conditions, legal, tax and regulatory restrictions on the payment of dividends and other factors the Board of Directors of the Company deems relevant. While the Company is not itself subject to any significant legal prohibitions on the payment of dividends, Platinum US will be subject to regulatory constraints imposed by Maryland insurance law, Platinum UK will be subject to regulatory constraints imposed by U.K. insurance law, Platinum Ireland will be subject to constraints imposed by Irish law, and Platinum Bermuda will be subject to regulatory constraints imposed by Bermuda insurance law, which affect their ability to pay dividends to the Company. See "Business—Regulation". Accordingly, there is no requirement or assurance that dividends will be declared or paid in the future.
34
The following table sets forth the capitalization of the Company as of April 24, 2002 and as adjusted to give effect to the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment based on an assumed initial public offering price in the Public Offering of $25 per Common Share and, with respect to the As Adjusted capitalization, the assumption that 13,262,300 Common Shares were issued to St. Paul in the St. Paul Investment.
| Actual | As Adjusted | |||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
Long-term debt | $ | — | $ | — | |||
Shareholders' equity | |||||||
Common Shares, par value $1.00 per share, $0.01 per share, as adjusted (12,000 shares authorized; 135,000,000 shares authorized, as adjusted; 12,000 shares outstanding; 53,262,300 shares outstanding, as adjusted) | 12,000 | 532,623 | |||||
Additional paid-in capital | — | 965,927,377 | |||||
Retained earnings | — | — | |||||
Total shareholders' equity | 12,000 | 966,460,000 | |||||
Total capitalization | $ | 12,000 | $ | 966,460,000 | |||
35
PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION
We caution that the Platinum pro forma consolidated balance sheet and pro forma combined underwriting results presented herein are not indicative of the actual results that we expect to achieve once we commence operations. Many factors may cause our actual results to differ materially from the pro forma consolidated balance sheet and underwriting results including, but not limited to, the following:
- •
- Platinum's pro forma combined statement of underwriting results includes premium and loss development on business entered into prior to January 1, 2002. Under the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements, we are assuming no premium or loss development on business entered into prior to January 1, 2002. Therefore, our reported premiums written and earned and reported losses and loss adjustment expenses in our initial years of operation could be substantially lower than as presented in Platinum's pro forma combined statement of underwriting results. As such, our reported results in our initial years of operation will not be subject to prior year development for periods prior to January 1, 2002.
- •
- Following the Public Offering, we will report underwriting results under the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements for the period prior to the later of the business day immediately after the date of completion of the Public Offering or July 1, 2002 based on the application of retroactive reinsurance accounting, resulting in the premiums earned and losses incurred by St. Paul during such period being excluded from our statement of underwriting results. Due to this exclusion, following the Public Offering, our reported 2002 premiums written and earned and our net underwriting results in 2002 could be substantially different than as presented in Platinum's pro forma combined statement of underwriting results.
- •
- Platinum's pro forma consolidated balance sheet reflects the inception of the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements assuming transferred balances as of April 24, 2002. Platinum's actual consolidated balance sheet will report transferred amounts determined as of 12:01 a.m., on the later of the business day immediately after the date of completion of the Public Offering or July 1, 2002. Accordingly, underwriting gain or loss with respect to the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts for the period from January 1, 2002 through such date will be retained by St. Paul.
- •
- Although we expect to continue to be afforded the benefits of most of St. Paul Re's retrocessional reinsurance program through their expiration during 2002, we may enter into retrocessional reinsurance contracts with significantly different terms and conditions from those that have been made available to us from St. Paul Re and which form the basis of our initial operations.
- •
- The additional and reinstatement premiums recorded in 2001 by St. Paul Re's Finite Risk operating segment were primarily caused by losses relating to the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack. These additional and reinstatement premiums were unusually high and not necessarily indicative of the recurring premium volume we expect to write in that business segment.
- •
- Platinum's pro forma financial statements continue to reflect the discounting of the liability for certain Assumed Reinsurance Contracts based on our current intention to make arrangements to permit such discounting. If we do not put such arrangements in place, reinsurance contracts of a similar type entered into in the future would be reported on an undiscounted basis.
36
Pro Forma Consolidated Balance Sheet
We have prepared our unaudited pro forma consolidated balance sheet as of our inception date on April 24, 2002 to reflect our initial capitalization in the amount of $12,000 and adjusted to reflect, among other things,
- •
- amounts reflecting (a) the receipt of $940 million, representing the estimated net proceeds from the Public Offering based on an assumed initial public offering price of $25 per Common Share, without giving effect to any exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares and (b) the redemption of the Common Shares that were issued at inception. It is further assumed that the net proceeds from the Public Offering will be invested in long-term, taxable fixed income securities;
- •
- amounts related to the net assets contributed to Platinum by St. Paul, which are transferred at St. Paul's book value. Tangible assets so contributed include the net assets of Platinum US as well as certain fixed assets such as furniture and equipment, systems and software. Intangible assets contributed include broker and customer lists, contract renewal rights, and licenses; and
- •
- our entering into the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements with St. Paul Re reinsuring the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts as of April 24, 2002.
| | April 24, 2002 (Date of Inception) Adjustments | | |||||||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| | Pro Forma Platinum | ||||||||||||||||||
| Historical | (1) | (2) | (3) | (4) | |||||||||||||||
| ($ in thousands) | |||||||||||||||||||
Assets: | ||||||||||||||||||||
Investments | $ | — | $ | — | $ | 940,000 | $ | 19,311 | $ | — | $ | 959,311 | ||||||||
Cash | 12 | 108 | (120 | ) | 150,329 | 150,329 | ||||||||||||||
Deferred acquisition costs | — | — | — | — | 21,146 | 21,146 | ||||||||||||||
Other assets | — | — | — | 7,149 | — | 7,149 | ||||||||||||||
Total assets | $ | 12 | $ | 108 | $ | 939,880 | $ | 26,460 | $ | 171,475 | $ | 1,137,935 | ||||||||
Liabilities: | ||||||||||||||||||||
Unpaid losses and loss adjustment expense reserves | $ | — | $ | — | $ | — | $ | — | $ | 37,848 | $ | 37,848 | ||||||||
Unearned premium reserves | — | — | — | — | 133,627 | 133,627 | ||||||||||||||
Total liabilities | $ | — | $ | — | $ | — | $ | — | $ | 171,475 | $ | 171,475 | ||||||||
Shareholders' equity: | ||||||||||||||||||||
Common shares | $ | 12 | $ | — | $ | 388 | $ | 133 | $ | — | $ | 533 | ||||||||
Additional paid-in capital | — | 108 | 939,492 | 26,327 | — | $ | 965,927 | |||||||||||||
Retained earnings | — | — | — | — | — | — | ||||||||||||||
Total shareholders' equity | $ | 12 | $ | 108 | $ | 939,880 | $ | 26,460 | $ | — | $ | 966,460 | ||||||||
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity | $ | 12 | $ | 108 | $ | 939,880 | $ | 26,460 | $ | 171,475 | $ | 1,137,935 | ||||||||
37
Notes to Pro Forma Consolidated Balance Sheet
The following describe amounts included in the "Adjustments" columns above:
- 1.
- Amounts reflecting the additional capitalization of Platinum Holdings.
- 2.
- Amounts reflecting (a) the receipt of $940 million, representing the estimated net proceeds from the Public Offering based on an assumed initial public offering price of $25 per Common Share, without giving effect to any exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares and (b) the redemption of the Common Shares that were issued at inception and capital contributed prior to the Public Offering. It is further assumed that the net proceeds from the Public Offering will be invested in long-term, taxable fixed income securities.
- 3.
- Amounts representing the receipt of St. Paul's contribution of the Transferred Business at historical cost in exchange for the issuance of Common Shares. Amounts related to net tangible assets contributed to Platinum by St. Paul are recorded at St. Paul's book value as of March 31, 2002. Assets include the net assets of Platinum US as well as certain fixed assets and other intangible assets such as broker and customer lists and contract renewal rights and licenses.
- 4.
- Amounts reflecting Platinum entering into the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements with St. Paul Re reinsuring the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts as of April 24, 2002 using a March 31, 2002 valuation date.
Pro Forma Combined Statements of Underwriting Results for the Three Months Ended March 31, 2002 and 2001 and the Year Ended December 31, 2001
We have prepared our unaudited pro forma combined statements of underwriting results to represent our reinsurance business, as if we had commenced our operations and the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment had been completed as of January 1, 2001. Our presentation of our pro forma underwriting results assumes that all of the Inception Agreements were entered into as of January 1, 2001. We have based our presentation on St. Paul Re's actual underwriting results for the periods presented. We have then adjusted these historical results to remove any of St. Paul Re's reinsurance businesses that will not be part of Platinum following the completion of this Public Offering, including
- •
- amounts related to St. Paul Re's reinsurance businesses that were not, and will not be, renewed after January 1, 2002, and
- •
- amounts related to St. Paul Re's allocations from the St. Paul corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance program that will not be available to Platinum.
Except as noted above, the pro forma combined underwriting results assume that all other retrocessional reinsurance with respect to the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts entered into in 2002 will remain available to Platinum.
Our future results will depend in part on the amount of our investment income, which cannot be predicted and which will fluctuate depending upon the types of investments we select, our underwriting results and market factors. Actual tax expense in future periods will be based on underwriting results plus investment income and other income and expense items not reflected in the pro forma combined statements of underwriting results. Our effective tax rate will reflect the proportion of income recognized by our operating subsidiaries, with Platinum US taxed at the U.S. corporate income tax rate (35%), Platinum UK taxed at the U.K. corporate tax rate (up to 30%), Platinum Ireland taxed at a 25% corporate tax rate on non-trading income and a 16% corporate tax rate on trading income (the latter rate to be reduced to 12.5% as of January 1, 2003), and Platinum Bermuda taxed at a zero corporate tax rate. In 2002, we expect to have a greater portion of our income subject to U.S. taxation and U.K. taxation than we expect to have in the future because our Bermuda operations are entirely new but can be expected to grow as a proportion of our business. As a result of changes in our geographic distribution of taxable income as well as changes in the
38
amount of our non-taxable income and expense, the relationship between our reported income before tax and our income tax expense may change significantly from one period to the next.
Three Months Ended March 31, 2002
| | Adjustments | | |||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Historical St. Paul Re | Pro Forma Platinum | ||||||||||||
| (1) | (2) | ||||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||||||
Net premiums earned | ||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 463 | $ | (48 | ) | $ | — | $ | 415 | |||||
Change in unearned premiums, net | (86 | ) | (7 | ) | — | (93 | ) | |||||||
Net premiums earned | 377 | (55 | ) | — | 322 | |||||||||
Losses and underwriting expenses | ||||||||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 247 | (32 | ) | — | 215 | |||||||||
Policy acquisition expenses | 100 | (17 | ) | — | 83 | |||||||||
Other underwriting expenses | 15 | (2 | ) | — | 13 | |||||||||
Total losses and underwriting expenses | 362 | (51 | ) | — | 311 | |||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | 15 | $ | (4 | ) | $ | — | $ | 11 | |||||
Three Months Ended March 31, 2001
| | Adjustments | | |||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Historical St. Paul Re | Pro Forma Platinum | ||||||||||||
| (1) | (2) | ||||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||||||
Net premiums earned | ||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 421 | $ | (81 | ) | $ | 1 | $ | 341 | |||||
Change in unearned premiums, net | (119 | ) | 20 | (1 | ) | (100 | ) | |||||||
Net premiums earned | 302 | (61 | ) | — | 241 | |||||||||
Losses and underwriting expenses | ||||||||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 205 | (53 | ) | (2 | ) | 150 | ||||||||
Policy acquisition expenses | 97 | (18 | ) | — | 79 | |||||||||
Other underwriting expenses | 21 | (4 | ) | — | 17 | |||||||||
Total losses and underwriting expenses | 323 | (75 | ) | (2 | ) | 246 | ||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | (21 | ) | $ | 14 | $ | 2 | $ | (5 | ) | ||||
| | Adjustments | | |||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Historical St. Paul Re | Pro Forma Platinum | ||||||||||||
| (1) | (2) | ||||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||||||
Net premiums earned | ||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 1,677 | $ | (228 | ) | $ | (67 | ) | $ | 1,382 | ||||
Change in unearned premiums, net | (84 | ) | 4 | — | (80 | ) | ||||||||
Net premiums earned | 1,593 | (224 | ) | (67 | ) | 1,302 | ||||||||
Losses and underwriting expenses | ||||||||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 1,922 | (356 | ) | (126 | ) | 1,440 | ||||||||
Policy acquisition expenses | 315 | (78 | ) | — | 237 | |||||||||
Other underwriting expenses | 82 | (19 | ) | — | 63 | |||||||||
Total losses and underwriting expenses | 2,319 | (453 | ) | (126 | ) | 1,740 | ||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | (726 | ) | $ | 229 | $ | 59 | $ | (438 | ) | ||||
39
Notes to Pro Forma Combined Statements of Underwriting Results
The following describe amounts deducted in the "Adjustments" columns above:
- 1.
- Amounts related to St. Paul Re's reinsurance businesses that were not, and will not be, renewed after January 1, 2002, and
- 2.
- Amounts related to St. Paul Re's allocations from St. Paul's corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance program.
Included in the 2001 pro forma combined underwriting results are pre-tax losses related to the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack totaling $468 million. This amount includes gross losses and loss adjustment expenses of $819 million, $123 million of ceded reinsurance, $137 million of additional and reinstatement premiums and $91 million of reduced contingent commission expenses.
40
MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF PRO FORMA FINANCIAL CONDITION
AND UNDERWRITING RESULTS
You should read the following pro forma discussion and analysis in conjunction with our audited consolidated balance sheet and the related notes included on pages F-3 through F-11 of this prospectus, as well as our unaudited pro forma financial information and the related notes set forth under "Pro Forma Financial Information". Our audited consolidated balance sheet and our unaudited pro forma financial information have been prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP. The following pro forma discussion and analysis contains forward-looking statements that involve risks and uncertainties. Our actual results may differ materially from the results described or implied by the pro forma discussion and analysis and these forward-looking statements. You should read the information under "Risk Factors" beginning on page 15 of this prospectus for information about material risks and uncertainties that affect our business.
Overview
Our objective is to provide property and casualty reinsurance coverages to a diverse clientele of insurers and select reinsurers on a worldwide basis. We will operate principally by using reinsurance brokers to market our products and principally as a lead reinsurer on treaty reinsurance business. A substantial majority of our business will be written as excess-of-loss reinsurance. We intend to organize our worldwide reinsurance business around three operating segments:
- •
- Global Property and Marine. The Global Property and Marine operating segment will include principally property and marine reinsurance coverages. We intend to focus our underwriting activities primarily on catastrophe excess-of-loss and per risk excess-of-loss contracts. We intend to write other types of property reinsurance as well, including selected property pro rata reinsurance. This segment generated $315 million, or 22.8%, of Platinum's 2001 pro forma net premiums written. Following the completion of the Public Offering, we expect the proportion of our net premiums written generated by the Global Property and Marine segment to increase relative to 2001 levels.
- •
- Global Casualty. The Global Casualty operating segment will include principally general and automobile liability, professional liability, workers' compensation, accident and health coverages and casualty clash. We intend to focus our underwriting activities primarily on excess-of-loss reinsurance coverages. This segment generated $592 million, or 42.8%, of Platinum's 2001 pro forma net
premiums written. Following the completion of the Public Offering, we expect the proportion of our net premiums written generated by the Global Casualty segment to decrease relative to 2001 levels.
- •
- Finite Risk. The Finite Risk operating segment will include principally non-traditional reinsurance treaties, including multi-year excess-of-loss, aggregate stop loss, finite quota share, loss portfolio transfer, and adverse loss development contracts. We intend to provide clients, either directly or through brokers, with customized solutions for their risk management and other financial management needs. We intend to focus our finite risk underwriting activities primarily on multi-year excess-of-loss and aggregate stop loss reinsurance treaties. Coverage classes within these products will primarily include property, casualty, marine and/or whole account property and casualty exposures. This segment generated $475 million, or 34.4%, of Platinum's 2001 pro forma net premiums written.
In addition, we may write other property and casualty reinsurance on an opportunistic basis. For a discussion of the basis on which pro forma net premiums written were determined, see "Pro Forma Financial Information" above.
41
Background and the Transferred Business
St. Paul and its subsidiaries constitute one of the oldest insurance organizations in the United States, dating back to 1853. Through its division St. Paul Re, St. Paul has been engaged in the reinsurance business since 1983. In December of 2001, in an effort to enhance the profitability of its reinsurance business, St. Paul decided to narrow the product focus of its reinsurance operations and exit certain lines of that business. As part of this effort, St. Paul Re reduced its anticipated 2002 exposure and expenses by exiting unprofitable lines of business and reducing the number of reinsurance branch offices outside the U.S. The narrowing of reinsurance product lines included exiting aviation, bond and credit reinsurance coverages, as well as certain financial risk and capital markets lines. International branch office closings included Munich, Brussels, Hong Kong, Sydney and Singapore. In addition to curtailing various reinsurance operations, St. Paul's management decided that its reinsurance business and its primary insurance business should ideally operate as separate entities because of their different risk profiles and business characteristics. As a result, contingent upon the completion of the Public Offering, St. Paul Re will contribute to us the Transferred Business, through the arrangements described below:
- •
- Renewal Opportunities and Commitments. We will be acquiring from St. Paul Re its existing customer lists and the right to seek to renew substantially all of St. Paul Re's continuing reinsurance contracts. We will also assume commitments, if any, of St. Paul Re to offer reinsurance coverages in the future.
- •
- Assumed Reinsurance Contracts. Through 100% quota share retrocession agreements (the "Quota Share Retrocession Agreements"), we will reinsure substantially all of the reinsurance contracts St. Paul Re entered into on or after January 1, 2002, which we refer to as the "Assumed Reinsurance Contracts". St. Paul Re will retain all of its reinsurance exposure not being transferred to us and will administer the associated run-off. Consequently, we will not assume any underwriting exposure with respect to reinsurance contracts entered into by St. Paul prior to January 1, 2002, except as noted below with respect to finite reinsurance. Underwriting gain or loss with respect to the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts for the period from January 1, 2002 through the later of the business day immediately after the completion of the Public Offering and July 1, 2002 will be retained by St. Paul.
- •
- The terms of the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements provide, with limited exceptions, that retrocessional reinsurance purchased by St. Paul Re shall be for our expense and shall inure to our benefit in respect of the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts, providing us with retrocessional reinsurance coverage for such contracts through 2002 or the earlier termination or expiration of the various retrocession agreements. We will bear all the risk associated with non-payment by third party retrocessionaires under such retrocessional reinsurance. All the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements will take effect as of 12:01 A.M., on the later of the business day immediately following the date of the completion of the Public Offering or July 1, 2002. Accordingly, while St. Paul will be contractually committed to effect the transfer, the effective time of the transfer of the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts will occur after the sale to investors of Common Shares in the Public Offering.
- •
- We will have the right to underwrite specified reinsurance business on behalf of St. Paul and in the case of the UK business St. Paul will continue to write such business in each case for a period of one year following the completion of the Public Offering, and we will reinsure such business pursuant to the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements. This will allow us to continue to participate in reinsurance business which is bound after the completion of the Public Offering without any delay occasioned by the start-up of our operations, including the lack of required licenses, and facilitate the transition of St. Paul Re's business to us.
42
- •
- For a period of three years following the completion of the Public Offering, we will underwrite on behalf of St. Paul renewals of in-force contracts of finite reinsurance. St. Paul will retrocede to us 100% of the unpaid losses under currently in-force contracts and we will have the option to reinsure losses under renewed contracts for a retrocession premium pursuant to the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements. Under the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements, a portion of future premiums will be applied to settle balances related to prior year experience for the benefit of St. Paul. St. Paul will have an option to renew this arrangement with us for a subsequent period of two years.
- •
- Related Assets. We will be acquiring from St. Paul tangible and intangible assets relating to the continuing businesses being transferred to us, including furniture and equipment, systems and software, assignments of leases, licenses and other assets as well as all of the outstanding capital stock of Platinum US.
- •
- Employees.Upon or following the completion of the Public Offering, we expect to employ approximately 180 employees previously employed by St. Paul Re.
The Public Offering and the transactions contemplated thereby were first announced to the public on April 25, 2002. Platinum believes St. Paul Re's withdrawal from certain business may have adversely affected premiums written during 2002 prior to the public announcement of the Public Offering. Management is unable to predict how the Public Offering's announcement will affect premiums written in the future. See "Risk Factors".
Our Drivers of Profitability
Revenues
We expect to derive our revenues from two principal sources, premiums from our reinsurance business and income from our investment portfolio. Reinsurance premiums are a function of the amount and type of contracts we write as well as prevailing market prices. There are many types of reinsurance contracts with unique pricing, terms and conditions and expected profit margins. Therefore, changes in the amount of premiums we will write may not be an accurate indicator of our anticipated profitability.
We expect our investment income to be a function of the average assets in our portfolio and the average yield that we earn on those assets. The investment yield will be a function of market interest rates as well as the credit quality and maturity or our invested assets. In addition, we could realize capital gains or losses on our investment portfolio as a result of changing market conditions, including, but not limited to, changes in market interest rates and changes in the market's perception of the credit quality of our invested assets. We intend to earn investment income primarily on the assets invested in our portfolio, but we may also earn revenue from investment income on premium and loss deposits withheld by our clients.
Expenses
We expect that our expenses will consist primarily of two types of expenses, loss and loss adjustment expenses, or "LAE", and operating and administrative costs. Loss and loss adjustment expenses will be a function of the amount and type of reinsurance contracts we will write. We will initially record loss and loss adjustment expenses based on an actuarial analysis of the estimated losses we expect to incur on each contract written. The ultimate loss and loss adjustment expenses will depend on the actual costs to settle these claims. We intend to increase or decrease our initial loss estimates as actual losses occur. Our ability to estimate loss and loss adjustment expenses accurately at the time of pricing our contracts will be a critical factor in determining our profitability.
Operating and administrative costs are expected to consist primarily of acquisition expenses, which are commission and brokerage fees paid to intermediaries for the production of premiums
43
written, excise taxes and other underwriting expenses, overhead costs, interest expense and income taxes. We expect our acquisition expenses to consist principally of ceding commissions paid to cedents and brokerage commissions that represent a percentage of the premiums on reinsurance contracts written. We expect that acquisition expenses will be a function of the amount and types of contracts written. Overhead costs are expected to consist primarily of salaries and related costs. These costs will be primarily fixed in nature and will not vary with the amount of premiums written. Interest expense will be a function of outstanding borrowing or funding commitments (such as letter of credit agreements) and the contractual interest rate related to these commitments. Income taxes will be a function of our profitability and the tax rate in the various jurisdictions in which we do business.
Critical Accounting Policies
Our significant accounting policies are described in the notes to Platinum Holdings' audited consolidated balance sheet. The following is a summary of the critical accounting policies that will affect our future financial performance: premiums, reserves, reinsurance and investments.
Premiums
Premiums will be recorded at the inception of each policy, based upon information received from ceding companies and their brokers. For excess-of-loss contracts, the amount of premium is usually contractually documented at inception, and no management judgment is necessary in accounting for this. Premiums are earned on a pro rata basis over the coverage period. For proportional treaties, the amount of premium is normally estimated at inception by the ceding company. We will account for such premium using the initial estimates, and then adjust them once a sufficient period for actual premium reporting has elapsed. For the year ended December 31, 2001, the pro forma premiums written resulting from estimate accruals were less than 25% of total premiums written. We will also accrue for reinstatement and additional premiums resulting from losses. Such accruals will be based upon actual contractual terms, and the only element of management judgment involved is with respect to the amount of loss reserves, as described below.
Reinstatement and additional premiums are written at the time a loss event occurs where coverage limits for the remaining life of the contract are reinstated under pre-defined contract terms. Reinstatement premiums are the premiums charged for the restoration of the reinsurance limit of a catastrophe contract to its full amount after payment by the reinsurer of losses as a result of an occurrence. These premiums relate to the future coverage obtained during the remainder of the initial policy term, and are earned over the remaining policy term. Additional premiums are premiums charged after coverage has expired, related to experience during the policy term, which are earned immediately.
Reserves
Under U.S. GAAP, we will not be permitted to establish loss reserves until the occurrence of an event which may give rise to a loss. Once such an event occurs, we will establish reserves based upon estimates of total losses incurred by the ceding insurers as a result of the event and our estimate of the portion of such loss we have reinsured. As a result, only loss reserves applicable to losses incurred up to the reporting date may be set aside, with no allowance for the provision of a contingency reserve to account for expected future losses. Losses arising from future events will be estimated and recognized at the time the loss is incurred and could be substantial.
Setting appropriate reserves for loss and loss adjustment expenses is an inherently uncertain process. Loss reserves will represent our estimates, at a given point in time, of ultimate settlement and adjustment costs of losses incurred (including incurred but not reported, or IBNR, losses, which are losses that have been sustained but not yet reported to the insurer). We will regularly
44
review and update these estimates, using the most current information available to us. Consequently, the ultimate liability for a loss is likely to differ from the original estimate. Whenever we determine that any existing loss reserves are inadequate, we are required to record such change in estimate; increasing the loss reserves with a corresponding reduction, which could be material, in our operating results in the period in which the deficiency is identified. Adjustments resulting from changes in our estimates will be reflected in current income. The establishment of new reserves, or the adjustment of reserves for reported claims, could result in significant upward or downward changes to our financial condition or results of underwriting in any particular period.
The reserve for losses and loss adjustment expenses will be based upon reports, individual case estimates received from ceding companies and management's estimates. Management's estimates are used mostly to estimate IBNR loss amounts. For certain catastrophic events, there is considerable uncertainty underlying the assumptions and associated estimated reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses. Reserves will be reviewed regularly and, as experience develops and additional information becomes known, the reserves will be adjusted as necessary. Such changes in estimate, if necessary, will be reflected in results of operations in the current period. We currently intend to make arrangements to permit us to discount the liability for certain assumed reinsurance contracts using rates based on our return on invested assets or, in many cases, on yields contractually guaranteed to us on funds held by the ceding company.
Generally, reserves are established without regard to whether we may subsequently contest the loss. We expect our policy to be to establish reserves for reported losses based upon reports received from ceding companies, supplemented by our reserve estimates.
Reinsurance
Written premiums (which are total premiums for a given period), earned premiums (which are the portion of written premiums which applies to the expired portion of the policy period), incurred losses (which are total losses, whether paid or unpaid) and LAE reflect the net effects of assumed and ceded reinsurance transactions. Reinsurance accounting is followed for assumed and ceded transactions when risk transfer requirements have been met. These requirements involve significant assumptions being made relating to the amount and timing of expected cash flows, as well as the interpretation of underlying contract terms. Reinsurance contracts that do not transfer significant insurance risk are required to be accounted for as deposits. These deposits are accounted for as financing transactions, with interest expense credited to the contract deposit. Premiums received on retroactive reinsurance contracts are not reflected in the statement of operations, but rather are recorded in the consolidated balance sheet as an increase to loss and loss adjustment expenses reserves for the liabilities assumed and as assets based on the consideration received. A deferred charge or credit is recorded for any difference between liabilities assumed and consideration received.
Investments
In accordance with our investment guidelines, our investments will initially consist of high-grade marketable fixed income securities. We may, in the future, elect to invest a portion of our funds in marketable equity securities. Investments will be carried at estimated fair value as determined by the most recently traded price of each security as of the balance sheet date. Unrealized gains and losses on our investments will be included as a separate component of shareholders' equity. Realized gains and losses on sales of investments will be determined on a specific identification basis. In addition, unrealized depreciation in the value of individual securities considered by management to be other than temporary will be charged to income in the period it is determined. Investment income will be recorded when earned and will include the amortization of premiums and
45
discounts on investments. For a more detailed discussion, see "Business—Our Business—Investments".
Formation of Platinum Holdings and Presentation of Pro Forma Financial Information
and Historical St. Paul Re Combined Financial Information
Formation of Platinum Holdings
In connection with our formation, we have agreed with St. Paul and certain of its affiliates to enter into the Inception Agreements. They will become effective contingent upon the completion of the Public Offering (except the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements which will take effect at 12:01 A.M., on the later of the business day immediately following the date of the completion of the Public Offering or July 1, 2002) and will govern our relationship with St. Paul thereafter with respect to various intercompany arrangements and services. The principal terms of these agreements are summarized under "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions" in this prospectus.
Presentation of Pro Forma Financial Information and St. Paul Re Combined Financial Information
As a newly formed company, we have no actual results of operations. In this prospectus, we are therefore presenting pro forma financial information of Platinum Holdings with respect to the reinsurance business which St. Paul will be transferring to us under the terms of the Inception Agreements, contingent upon the completion of the Public Offering. This pro forma financial information is intended, under the various assumptions discussed in more detail under "Pro Forma Financial Information", to illustrate the performance of our business as if the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment had been completed and we had commenced our operations as of January 1, 2001.
We are also presenting the historical combined financial information of St. Paul Re. For a detailed discussion of the historical underwriting results of St. Paul Re, see "The Predecessor Business".
Our future results will depend in part on the amount of our investment income, which cannot be predicted and which will fluctuate depending upon the types of investments we select, our underwriting results and market factors. Actual tax expense in future periods will be based on underwriting results plus investment income and other income and expense items not reflected in the pro forma consolidated statements of underwriting results. For discussion of our effective tax rate, see "—Income Tax" below.
We caution that the Platinum pro forma consolidated balance sheet and pro forma combined underwriting results presented herein are not indicative of the actual results that we may achieve once we commence operations. Many factors may cause our actual results to differ materially from these pro forma consolidated balance sheet and results including, but not limited to, the following:
- •
- Platinum's pro forma combined statement of underwriting results includes premium and loss development on business entered into prior to January 1, 2002. Under the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements, we are assuming no premium or loss development on business entered into prior to January 1, 2002. Therefore, our reported premiums written and earned and reported losses and loss adjustment expenses in our initial years of operation could be substantially lower than as presented in Platinum's pro forma combined statement of underwriting results. As such, our reported results in our initial years of operation will not be subject to prior year development for periods prior to January 1, 2002.
- •
- Following the Public Offering, we will report underwriting results under the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements for the period prior to the later of the business day immediately after the date of completion of the Public Offering or July 1, 2002 based on the application of
46
- •
- Platinum's pro forma consolidated balance sheet reflects the inception of the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements assuming transferred balances as of April 24, 2002. Platinum's actual consolidated balance sheet will report transferred amounts determined as of 12:01 a.m. on the later of the business day immediately after the date of completion of the Public Offering or July 1, 2002. Accordingly, underwriting gain or loss with respect to the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts for the period from January 1, 2002 through such date will be retained by St. Paul.
- •
- Although we expect to continue to be afforded the benefits of most of St. Paul Re's retrocessional reinsurance program through their expiration in 2002, we may enter into retrocessional reinsurance contracts with significantly different terms and conditions from those that have been made available to us from St. Paul Re and which form the basis of our initial operations.
- •
- The additional and reinstatement premiums recorded in 2001 by St. Paul Re's Finite Risk operating segment were primarily caused by losses relating to the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack. These additional and reinstatement premiums were unusually high and not necessarily indicative of the recurring premium volume we expect to write in that business segment.
- •
- Platinum's pro forma financial statements continue to reflect the discounting of the liability for certain Assumed Reinsurance Contracts based on our current intention to make arrangements to permit such discounting. If we do not put such arrangements in place, reinsurance contracts of a similar type entered into in the future would be reported on an undiscounted basis.
retroactive reinsurance accounting, resulting in the premiums earned and losses incurred by St. Paul during such period being excluded from our statement of underwriting results. Due to this exclusion, following the Public Offering, our reported 2002 premiums written and earned and our net underwriting results in 2002 could be substantially different than as presented in Platinum's pro forma combined statement of underwriting results.
Exposure to Catastrophes
As with other reinsurers, our operating results and financial condition can be adversely affected by volatile and unpredictable natural and man-made disasters, such as hurricanes, windstorms, earthquakes, floods, fires, riots and explosions. Although we will attempt to limit our exposure to acceptable levels, it is possible that an actual catastrophic event or multiple catastrophic events could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. As noted above under "—Critical Accounting Policies", under U.S. GAAP, we are not permitted to establish loss reserves until the occurrence of an event which may give rise to a claim. Once such an event occurs, we will establish reserves based upon estimates of total losses incurred by the ceding insurers as a result of the event and our estimate of the portion of such loss we have insured. As a result, only loss reserves applicable to losses incurred up to the reporting date may be set aside, with no allowance for the provision of a contingency reserve to account for expected future losses. Losses arising from future events will be estimated and recognized at the time the loss is incurred and could be substantial.
47
Except in Bermuda, we will be subject to local income tax requirements in the jurisdictions in which we operate. The income tax expense reflected in our pro forma financial statements therefore reflects a number of different local tax rates, and as a result may change from one period to the next depending on both the amount and the geographic distribution of our taxable income. Actual tax expense in future periods will be based on underwriting results plus investment income and other income and expense items not reflected in the Pro Forma Consolidated Statements of Underwriting Results. Our effective tax rate will reflect the proportion of income recognized by our operating subsidiaries with Platinum US taxed at the U.S. corporate income rate (35%), Platinum UK taxed at the U.K. corporate tax rate (up to 30%), Platinum Ireland taxed at the Irish corporate tax rate (25% on non-trading income and 16% on trading income, the latter rate to be reduced to 12.5% as of January 1, 2003), and Platinum Bermuda taxed at a zero corporate tax rate. In 2002, we expect to have a greater portion of our income subject to U.S. taxation and U.K. taxation than we expect to have in the future because our Bermuda operations are entirely new but can be expected to grow as a proportion of our business over time. As a result of changes in our geographic contribution of taxable income as well as changes in the amount of our non-taxable income and expense, the relationship between our reported income before tax and our income tax expense may change significantly from one period to the next.
Pro Forma Combined Underwriting Results of Platinum Holdings
The following table summarizes our pro forma combined underwriting results for the three months ended March 31, 2002 and 2001, and for the year ended December 31, 2001, as if the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment had been completed on January 1, 2001. For a discussion of the historical results of underwriting of St. Paul Re, see "The Predecessor Business".
| Three Months Ended March 31, | | |||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Year Ended December 31, 2001 | ||||||||||||
| 2002 | 2001 | |||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||||||||
Net premiums earned | |||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 415 | $ | 341 | $ | 1,382 | |||||||
Change in unearned premiums, net | (93 | ) | (100 | ) | (80 | ) | |||||||
Net premiums earned | 322 | 241 | 1,302 | ||||||||||
Losses and Underwriting expenses | |||||||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 215 | 150 | 1,440 | ||||||||||
Policy acquisition expenses | 83 | 79 | 237 | ||||||||||
Other underwriting expenses | 13 | 17 | 63 | ||||||||||
Total losses and underwriting expenses | 311 | 246 | 1,740 | ||||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | 11 | $ | (5 | ) | $ | (438 | ) | |||||
Selected Ratios - U.S. GAAP | |||||||||||||
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio | 66.6 | % | 62.4 | % | 110.6 | % | |||||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 29.8 | % | 39.9 | % | 23.0 | % | |||||||
Combined ratio | 96.4 | % | 102.3 | % | 133.6 | % | |||||||
Selected Ratios - Statutory | |||||||||||||
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio | 66.6 | % | 62.4 | % | 110.6 | % | |||||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 26.3 | % | 33.6 | % | 23.3 | % | |||||||
Combined ratio | 92.9 | % | 96.0 | % | 133.9 | % | |||||||
Impact of catastrophes on combined ratio (1) | (2.3 | )% | (3.1 | )% | 40.9 | % | |||||||
- (1)
- Excludes ceded losses under St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties, because such treaties extend to non-catastrophic as well as catastrophic losses as described below.
48
Included in the 2001 pro forma combined underwriting results are pre-tax losses related to the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack totaling $468 million. This amount includes gross losses and loss adjustment expenses of $819 million, $123 million of ceded reinsurance, $137 million of additional and reinstatement premiums and $91 million of reduced contingent commission expenses. The determination of the impact of catastrophes on the combined ratio excludes the ceded losses under St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaty; this treaty which remains available to Platinum in 2002 (unless earlier terminated pursuant to its terms), provides coverage for excess losses arising from catastrophic and non-catastrophic events.
Retrocessional Reinsurance
Our pro forma combined underwriting results for the three months ended March 31, 2002 and 2001, and for the twelve months ended December 31, 2001 reflect the benefits of most of St. Paul Re's retrocessional reinsurance program as it relates to Platinum. The pro forma results do not reflect the effects of the St. Paul corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance program, which will not be available to Platinum in 2002 or thereafter. St. Paul Re has utilized retrocession agreements principally to increase aggregate premium capacity and to reduce the risk of loss on reinsurance underwritten. In addition, through St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties, St. Paul Re has maintained catastrophe reinsurance programs for the purpose of limiting its exposure with respect to multiple claims arising from a single occurrence or event. St. Paul Re's retrocession agreements provide for recovery of a portion of claims and claims expense from retrocessionnaires. Under these programs, on a pro forma basis, St. Paul Re ceded the following amounts to retrocessionaires:
| Three Months Ended March 31, | | ||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Year Ended December 31, 2001 | |||||||||
| 2002 | 2001 | ||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||
Ceded premiums written | $ | 29 | $ | 32 | $ | 167 | ||||
Ceded premiums earned | 15 | 24 | 165 | |||||||
Ceded losses and loss adjustment expenses | 2 | 43 | 368 | |||||||
Ceded underwriting expenses | 3 | 3 | 8 | |||||||
Net underwriting benefit (detriment) | $ | (10 | ) | $ | 22 | $ | 211 | |||
Included in the above totals were the following impacts of St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties as they relate to Platinum:
| Three Months Ended March 31, | | ||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Year Ended December 31, 2001 | |||||||||
| 2002 | 2001 | ||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||
Ceded premiums written | $ | 4 | $ | 11 | $ | 87 | ||||
Ceded premiums earned | 4 | 10 | 87 | |||||||
Ceded losses and loss adjustment expenses | — | 25 | 194 | |||||||
Net underwriting benefit (detriment) | $ | (4 | ) | $ | 15 | $ | 107 | |||
Under the terms of St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties, St. Paul Re remits an initial margin premium in quarterly installments to its counterparty, regardless of whether losses are ceded under the treaty. If losses are ceded under these treaties, St. Paul Re remits additional premiums ceded, plus accrued interest, to its counterparty when the related losses and loss adjustment expenses are settled. For the three months ended March 31, 2002, no losses were ceded under the 2002 treaty.
49
Pro Forma Combined Underwriting Results
Three Months Ended March 31, 2002 Compared to Three Months Ended March 31, 2001
Net premiums
Net premiums written for the three month period ended March 31, 2002 increased 21.8% to $415 million from $341 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001, including $197 million, or 47.5%, from the Global Casualty segment, $125 million, or 30.1%, from the Global Property and Marine segment and $93 million, or 22.4%, from the Finite Risk segment.
Net premiums earned (which are that portion of net premiums written which applies to the expired portion of the policy period) for the three months ended March 31, 2002 increased 33.9% to $322 million from $241 million for the three months ended March 31, 2001.
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
Losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred were $215 million in the three months ended March 31, 2002 compared to $150 million in the three months ended March 31, 2001. The increase from the first quarter of 2002 was principally attributable to the growth in earned premium. The loss and loss adjustment expense ratio, also referred to as loss ratio (which is the ratio of losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred, including estimates for claims incurred but not reported, to premiums earned) was 66.6% and 62.4% for the three months ended March 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively. Catastrophe losses resulted in benefits of $7 million and $7 million for the three months ended March 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively, due to favorable loss development from prior period catastrophes. This catastrophe loss development had a favorable impact on loss ratios for the three months ended March 31, 2002 and March 31, 2001 of 2.3 percentage points and 3.1 percentage points, respectively.
Acquisition expenses
Acquisition expenses were $83 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2002 compared to $79 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001. The resulting acquisition expense ratio (which is the ratio of acquisition costs and expenses to net premiums earned) was 25.8% for the three months ended March 31, 2002 compared to 33.0% for the three months ended March 31, 2001. The reduction in the expense ratio of 7.2% percentage points was attributable to lower commission and brokerage costs across the portfolio primarily as a result of a change in business mix.
Other underwriting expenses
Other underwriting expenses consisted of the cost of operations associated with underwriting activities. These expenses include compensation, rent, and all other general expenses associated with our underwriting activity and exclude any investment or claim related expense. Other underwriting expenses were $13 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2002 and $17 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001. The other underwriting expense ratio for the three months ended March 31, 2002 was 4.0% compared to 6.9% for the three month period ended March 31, 2001. The decrease was attributable to the growth in premiums earned together with a decrease in expenses.
50
Year Ended December 31, 2001
Net premiums
Net premiums written for the year ended December 31, 2001 totaled $1,382 million, including $592 million, or 42.8%, from the Global Casualty segment, $315 million, or 22.8%, from the Global Property and Marine segment and $475 million, or 34.4%, from the Finite Risk segment. Included in net premiums written for the period were $137 million in additional and reinstatement premiums, principally as a result of losses under finite reinsurance treaties, primarily related to the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack. Net premiums earned for the full year 2001 were $1,302 million.
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
Losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred totaled $1,440 million for the year ended December 31, 2001, which included loss and loss adjustment expense payments of $652 million and a net increase in reserves for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses of $788 million.
For the year ended December 31, 2001, pre-tax catastrophe losses net of reinsurance totaled $744 million, of which $696 million resulted from the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack. The majority of the remaining $48 million of catastrophe losses in 2001 were the result of a variety of storms throughout the year in the U.S., and the explosion of a chemical manufacturing plant in Toulouse, France.
The reported loss ratio of 110.6% for the year ended December 31, 2001 included a 46.7 percentage point detriment from losses incurred in the terrorist attack (not including the effects of St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties). The reported loss ratio for the year ended December 31, 2001 also included a benefit from St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties.
St. Paul Re's actual estimated losses for the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack were based on a variety of actuarial techniques, coverage interpretations and claims estimation methods. They included an estimate of losses incurred but not reported, and an estimate of costs related to the settlement of claims. The estimate of St. Paul Re's losses is also based on its belief that property-casualty insurance losses from the terrorist attack will total between $30 billion and $35 billion for the insurance industry. While the estimate of industry losses is subject to significant uncertainties and may change over time as additional information becomes available, Platinum will not be subject to the impact of any loss development associated with the terrorist attack in that reinsurance contracts which gave rise to the terrorist attack losses are not included in the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts and Platinum is not assuming any liability for prior period losses.
The estimated net pre-tax operating loss as a result of the terrorist attack totaled $468 million, consisting of the following components:
| Year Ended December 31, 2001 | ||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|
| ($ in millions) | ||||
Gross losses and loss adjustment expenses | $ | 819 | |||
Reinsurance recoverables | (123 | ) | |||
Additional and reinstatement premiums | (137 | ) | |||
Reduction in reinsurance contingent commission expense | (91 | ) | |||
Total estimated pretax operating loss | $ | 468 | |||
51
The estimated net pre-tax operating loss of $468 million related to the terrorist attack would have been distributed among Platinum's intended business segments as follows:
| Year Ended December 31, 2001 | |||
---|---|---|---|---|
| ($ in millions) | |||
Global Property & Marine | $ | 307 | ||
Global Casualty | 32 | |||
Finite Risk | 129 | |||
Total | $ | 468 | ||
Acquisition expenses
Acquisition expenses were $237 million for the year ended December 31, 2001. The acquisition expenses were reduced by $91 million related to contingent commissions that are no longer payable as a result of the losses caused by the terrorist attack of September 11, 2001. This resulted in a 10.0 percentage point benefit resulting from the contingent commission adjustment described above. The resulting acquisition expense ratio, that is, acquisition expenses expressed as a percentage of earned premium, was 18.2% for the year ended December 31, 2001.
Other underwriting expenses
Other underwriting expenses were $63 million for the year ended December 31, 2001. This resulted in an other underwriting expense ratio of 4.8% for the year ended December 31, 2001.
52
Pro Forma Underwriting Results By Operating Segment
The following table summarizes pro forma underwriting results and combined ratios for each of our three operating segments for the three months ended March 31, 2002 and 2001, and the year ended December 31, 2001.
| Three Months Ended March 31, | | |||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Year Ended December 31, 2001 | ||||||||||
| 2002 | 2001 | |||||||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||||||
Global Property & Marine | |||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 125 | $ | 118 | $ | 315 | |||||
Net premiums earned | 92 | 71 | 311 | ||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 30 | 15 | 399 | ||||||||
Underwriting expenses | 22 | 21 | 90 | ||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | 40 | $ | 35 | $ | (178 | ) | ||||
Combined ratio | 56.3 | % | 50.8 | % | 157.5 | % | |||||
Global Casualty | |||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 197 | $ | 153 | $ | 592 | |||||
Net premiums earned | 145 | 108 | 521 | ||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 126 | 106 | 460 | ||||||||
Underwriting expenses | 44 | 38 | 191 | ||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | (25 | ) | $ | (36 | ) | $ | (130 | ) | ||
Combined ratio | 117.6 | % | 134.1 | % | 125.0 | % | |||||
Finite Risk | |||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 93 | $ | 70 | $ | 475 | |||||
Net premiums earned | 85 | 62 | 470 | ||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 59 | 29 | 581 | ||||||||
Underwriting expenses | 30 | 37 | 19 | ||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | (4 | ) | $ | (4 | ) | $ | (130 | ) | ||
Combined ratio | 103.8 | % | 106.2 | % | 127.5 | % | |||||
Total | |||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 415 | $ | 341 | $ | 1,382 | |||||
Net premiums earned | 322 | 241 | 1,302 | ||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 215 | 150 | 1,440 | ||||||||
Underwriting expenses | 96 | 96 | 300 | ||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | 11 | $ | (5 | ) | $ | (438 | ) | |||
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio: | 66.6 | % | 62.4 | % | 110.6 | % | |||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 29.8 | % | 39.9 | % | 23.0 | % | |||||
Combined ratio | 96.4 | % | 102.3 | % | 133.6 | % | |||||
53
The following table summarizes pro forma underwriting results and combined ratios, excluding the impact of St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties and the impact of the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack, for each of our three operating segments for the three months ended March 31, 2002 and 2001, and the year ended December 31, 2001:
| Three Months Ended March 31, | | |||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Year Ended December 31, 2001 | ||||||||||
| 2002 | 2001 | |||||||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||||||
Global Property & Marine | |||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 127 | $ | 123 | $ | 356 | |||||
Net premiums earned | 93 | 76 | 352 | ||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 31 | 30 | 194 | ||||||||
Underwriting expenses | 22 | 21 | 90 | ||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | 40 | $ | 25 | $ | 68 | |||||
Combined ratio | 56.3 | % | 66.3 | % | 80.8 | % | |||||
Global Casualty | |||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 200 | $ | 158 | $ | 611 | |||||
Net premiums earned | 147 | 112 | 540 | ||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 125 | 116 | 468 | ||||||||
Underwriting expenses | 45 | 39 | 191 | ||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | (23 | ) | $ | (43 | ) | $ | (119 | ) | ||
Combined ratio | 116.1 | % | 138.8 | % | 122.1 | % | |||||
Finite Risk | |||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 93 | $ | 71 | $ | 365 | |||||
Net premiums earned | 85 | 63 | 360 | ||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expense | 57 | 29 | 276 | ||||||||
Underwriting expenses | 29 | 37 | 110 | ||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | (1 | ) | $ | (3 | ) | $ | (26 | ) | ||
Combined ratio | 101.6 | % | 104.2 | % | 107.1 | % | |||||
Total | |||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 420 | $ | 352 | $ | 1,332 | |||||
Net premiums earned | 325 | 251 | 1,252 | ||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 213 | 175 | 938 | ||||||||
Underwriting expenses | 96 | 97 | 391 | ||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | 16 | $ | (21 | ) | $ | (77 | ) | |||
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio | 65.7 | % | 69.8 | % | 74.9 | % | |||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 29.4 | % | 38.3 | % | 31.2 | % | |||||
Combined ratio | 95.1 | % | 108.1 | % | 106.1 | % | |||||
54
The following provides a more detailed discussion of the pro forma underwriting results for our three operating segments. To provide a more meaningful analysis of the underlying performance of our business segments, discussion of segment results excludes the impact of St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties and the impact of the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack.
Global Property and Marine
The Global Property and Marine operating segment will include principally property and marine reinsurance coverages. We intend to focus our underwriting activities primarily on catastrophe and excess-of-loss per risk contracts. We intend to write other types of property reinsurance as well, including selected property pro rata insurance. The following table summarizes the pro forma underwriting results of Platinum's Global Property and Marine segment for the three months ended March 31, 2002 and 2001 and the year ended December 31, 2001. The underwriting results exclude the impact of St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties and the impact of the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack.
| Three Months Ended March 31, | | ||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Year Ended December 31, 2001 | |||||||||
| 2002 | 2001 | ||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 127 | $ | 123 | $ | 356 | ||||
Net premiums earned | 93 | 76 | 352 | |||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 31 | 30 | 194 | |||||||
Underwriting expenses | 22 | 21 | 90 | |||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | 40 | $ | 25 | $ | 68 | ||||
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio | 33.3 | % | 38.9 | % | 55.1 | % | ||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 23.0 | % | 27.4 | % | 25.7 | % | ||||
Combined ratio | 56.3 | % | 66.3 | % | 80.8 | % | ||||
Three Months Ended March 31, 2002 Compared to Three Months Ended March 31, 2001
Net premiums
Net premiums written in the Global Property and Marine segment for the three month period ended March 31, 2002 increased 3.0% to $127 million from $123 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001. New business only partially offset non-renewed business and renewal business benefited from significant rate increases. Rate increases were particularly strong for worldwide property catastrophe business and U.S. property per risk excess-of-loss business.
Net premiums written in the Global Property and Marine segment included $102 million in excess-of-loss reinsurance contracts and $25 million in proportional contracts.
Net premiums written in the Global Property and Marine segment grew 10.9% in the U.S. to $71 million for the first quarter of 2002 compared to $64 million in the U.S. for the first quarter of 2001. Net premiums written in the Global Property and Marine segment declined 5.1% outside the U.S. to $56 million for the first quarter of 2002 compared to $59 million outside the U.S. in the first quarter of 2001.
Net premiums earned for the three months ended March 31, 2002 were impacted by the same factors as written premiums and increased by 22.5% to $93 million from $76 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001.
55
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
Losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred were $31 million in the three months ended March 31, 2002 compared to $30 million in the three months ended March 31, 2001. The increase in the first quarter of 2002 was principally attributable to the growth in earned premium. The Global Property and Marine segment's loss ratio was 33.3% and 38.9% for the three month periods ending March 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively. Due to the absence of catastrophe losses, catastrophe losses resulted in benefits of $7 million and $8 million for the three months ended March 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively, resulting from favorable loss development from prior period catastrophes.
Underwriting expenses
Acquisition costs associated with the Global Property and Marine segment were $16 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2002 compared to $14 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001. After deferring those costs related to the unearned portions of net premiums written, the resulting acquisition expense ratio was 17.4% for the three months ended March 31, 2002 compared to 18.2% for the three months ended March 31, 2001. The reduction in the expense ratio of 0.8% was attributable to lower commission and brokerage costs reflecting a change in business mix. Other underwriting expenses of the Global Property and Marine segment, including direct and allocated underwriting expenses were $6 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2002 and $7 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001. The other underwriting expense ratio for the Global Property and Marine segment for the three months ended March 31, 2002 was 5.6% compared with 9.2% for the three month period ended March 31, 2001. The decrease in the other underwriting expense ratio was attributable to the increase in written premiums and a decrease in other underwriting expenses.
Year Ended December 31, 2001
Net premiums
Net premiums written in the Global Property and Marine segment for the year ended December 31, 2001 totaled $356 million. Net premium volume in 2001 reflected the benefit of strong rate increases throughout the segment. Price increases accelerated as the year progressed, particularly in the aftermath of the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack.
Net premiums written in the Global Property and Marine segment in the U.S. totaled $196 million in 2001. Net premiums written in the Global Property and Marine segment for ceding companies outside the U.S. totaled $160 million in 2001.
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
Losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred for the Global Property and Marine segment totaled $194 million for the year ended December 31, 2001. Losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred for the year ended December 31, 2001 included loss and loss adjustment expense payments of $190 million and a net increase in reserves for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses of $4 million.
Underwriting expenses
Acquisition costs for the Global Property and Marine segment were $66 million for the year ended December 31, 2001, after deferring those costs related to the unearned portion of premiums written. The resulting acquisition expense ratio was 18.7% for the year ended December 31, 2001. Other underwriting expenses of the Global Property and Marine segment, including direct and
56
allocated underwriting expenses during 2001, totaled $24 million, resulting in an other underwriting expense ratio of 7.0%.
Global Casualty
The Global Casualty operating segment will include principally general and automobile liability, professional liability, workers' compensation, accident and health coverages and casualty clash. We intend to focus our underwriting activities primarily on excess-of-loss reinsurance coverages. The following table summarizes the pro forma underwriting results of Platinum's Global Casualty segment for the periods covered by this discussion. As with the discussion of the Global Property and Marine segment, the underwriting results below for the three months ended March 31, 2002 and 2001 and for the year ended December 31, 2001 exclude the impact of St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties and the impact of the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack.
| Three Months Ended March 31, | Year Ended December 31, | ||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | 2001 | |||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 200 | $ | 158 | $ | 611 | ||||
Net premiums earned | 147 | 112 | 540 | |||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 125 | 116 | 468 | |||||||
Underwriting expenses | 45 | 39 | 191 | |||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | (23 | ) | $ | (43 | ) | $ | (119 | ) | |
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio | 85.5 | % | 103.8 | % | 86.7 | % | ||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 30.6 | % | 35.0 | % | 35.4 | % | ||||
Combined ratio | 116.1 | % | 138.8 | % | 122.1 | % | ||||
Three Months Ended March 31, 2002 Compared to Three Months Ended March 31, 2001
Net premiums
Net premiums written in the Global Casualty segment for the three month period ended March 31, 2002 increased 26.9% to $200 million from $158 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001. The growth in net premiums written was primarily a result of an increase in premium volume relating to prior underwriting years as well as rate increases in renewal business and growth in the accident and health business.
Net premiums written in the Global Casualty segment included $141 million in excess-of-loss reinsurance contracts and $59 million in proportional contracts.
Net premiums written in the Global Casualty segment grew 38.1% in the U.S. to $174 million for the first quarter of 2002 compared to $126 million in the U.S. in the first quarter of 2001. Net premiums written in the Global Casualty segment declined 18.8% outside the U.S. to $26 million for the first quarter of 2002 compared to $32 million outside the U.S. in the first quarter of 2001.
Net premiums earned for the three months ended March 31, 2002 were impacted by the same factors as written premiums and increased by 31.3% to $147 million from $112 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001.
57
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
Losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred were $125 million in the three months ended March 31, 2002 compared to $116 million in the three months ended March 31, 2001. The increase in the first quarter of 2002 was principally attributable to the growth in earned premium offset by a lower loss ratio. The Global Casualty segment's loss ratio was 85.5% and 103.8% for the three month periods ended March 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively.
Underwriting expenses
Acquisition costs associated with the Global Casualty segment were $40 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2002 compared to $32 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001, after deferring those costs related to the unearned portion of premiums written. The resulting acquisition expense ratio was 27.1% for the three months ended March 31, 2002 compared to 28.9% for the three months ended March 31, 2001. The reduction in the acquisition expense ratio of 1.8 percentage points was attributable to lower commission and brokerage costs as a result of a change in business mix. Other underwriting expenses of the Global Casualty segment, including direct and allocated underwriting expenses, were $5 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2002 and $7 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001. The other underwriting expense ratio for the three months ended March 31, 2002 was 3.5% compared to 6.1% for the three month period ended March 31, 2001. The decrease in the other underwriting expense ratio was attributable to the increase in net premiums and a decrease in expenses.
Year Ended December 31, 2001
Net premiums
Net premiums written in the Global Casualty segment for 2001 included $454 million in excess-of-loss reinsurance contracts and $157 million in proportional contracts. Net premium volume reflected the benefit of significant price increases for substantially all coverages in the segment.
Net premiums written in the Global Casualty segment for ceding companies in the U.S. totaled $501 million in 2001. Net premiums written in the Global Casualty segment for ceding companies outside the U.S. was $110 million in 2001.
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
Losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred for the Global Casualty segment totaled $468 million for the year ended December 31, 2001. Loss and loss adjustment expenses incurred for the year ended December 31, 2001 included loss and loss expense payments of $310 million and a net increase in reserves for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses of $158 million.
Underwriting expenses
Acquisition costs for the Global Casualty segment were $163 million for the year ended December 31, 2001. After deferring those costs related to the unearned portion of net premiums written, the resulting acquisition expense ratio was 30.2% for the year ended December 31, 2001. Other underwriting expenses of the Global Casualty segment, including direct and allocated underwriting expenses during 2001 totaled $28 million, resulting in an other underwriting expense ratio of 5.2%.
58
Finite Risk
The Finite Risk operating segment will include principally non-traditional reinsurance treaties, including multi-year excess-of-loss, aggregate stop loss, finite quota share, loss portfolio transfer, and adverse loss development contracts. We intend to provide clients, either directly or through brokers, with customized solutions for their risk management and other financial management needs. We intend to focus our finite risk underwriting activities primarily on multi-year excess-of-loss and aggregate stop loss reinsurance treaties. Coverage classes within these products will primarily include property, casualty, marine and/or whole account property and casualty exposures. The following table summarizes results for the Finite Risk segment for the periods covered by this discussion. As with the discussion of our other operating segments, the pro forma underwriting results below for the three months ended March 31, 2002 and 2001 and for the year ended December 31, 2001 exclude the impact of St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties and the impact of the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack.
| Three Months Ended March 31, | Year Ended December 31, | ||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | 2001 | |||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 93 | $ | 71 | $ | 365 | ||||
Net premiums earned | 85 | 63 | 360 | |||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 57 | 29 | 276 | |||||||
Underwriting expenses | 29 | 37 | 110 | |||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | (1 | ) | $ | (3 | ) | $ | (26 | ) | |
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio | 67.1 | % | 46.9 | % | 76.6 | % | ||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 34.5 | % | 57.3 | % | 30.5 | % | ||||
Combined ratio | 101.6 | % | 104.2 | % | 107.1 | % | ||||
Three Months Ended March 31, 2002 Compared to Three Months Ended March 31, 2001
Net premiums
Net premiums written in the Finite Risk segment for the three month period ended March 31, 2002 increased 32.1% to $93 million from $71 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001. The increase in premiums written in the first quarter of 2002 versus the first quarter of 2001 was due to one large finite quota share contract being written in 2001 that has significant premium in calendar year 2002.
Net premiums written in the Finite Risk segment grew 64.7% in the U.S. to $56 million for the first quarter 2002 compared to $34 million in the U.S. in the first quarter of 2001. Net premiums written in the Finite Risk segment outside the U.S. remained at $37 million for the first quarter of 2002.
Net premiums earned for the three months ended March 31, 2002 were impacted by the same factors as written premiums and increased by 36.1% to $85 million from $63 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001.
59
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
Losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred were $57 million in the three months ended March 31, 2002 compared to $29 million in the three months ended March 31, 2001. The increase in the first quarter of 2001 was principally attributable to the growth in earned premium and by a higher loss ratio. The Finite Risk segment's loss ratio was 67.1% and 46.9% for the three month periods ended March 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively.
Underwriting expenses
Acquisition costs associated with the Finite Risk segment were $27 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2002 compared to $33 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001. Included in acquisition expenses in the first quarter of 2002 was an $8 million benefit driven by a decrease in the profit commission reserve, compared to $16 million in profit commission expense in the first quarter of 2001. After deferring those costs related to the unearned portion of net premiums written, the resulting acquisition expense ratio was 31.6% for the three months ended March 31, 2002 compared to 52.9% for the three months ended March 31, 2001. The reduction in the expense ratio of 21.3 percentage points was attributable to lower commission and brokerage costs across the portfolio. Other underwriting expenses of the Finite Risk segment, including direct and allocated underwriting expenses were $2 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2002 and $4 million for the three month period ended March 31, 2001. The other underwriting expense ratio for the three months ended March 31, 2002 was 2.9% compared to 4.4% for the three month period ended March 31, 2001. The decrease in the other underwriting expense ratio was attributable to the increase in written premiums compared with the decrease in other underwriting expenses.
Year Ended December 31, 2001
Net Premiums
Net premiums written in the Finite Risk segment for ceding companies in the U.S. totaled $204 million in 2001. Net premiums written in the Finite Risk segment for ceding companies outside the U.S. totaled $161 million in 2001.
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
Losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred for the Finite Risk segment totaled $276 million for the year ended December 31, 2001. Loss and loss adjustment expenses incurred for the year ended December 31, 2001 included loss and loss expense payments of $153 million and a net increase in reserves for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses of $123 million.
Underwriting expenses
Acquisition costs for the Finite Risk segment were $99 million for the year ended December 31, 2001. After deferring those costs related to the unearned portion of net premiums written, the resulting acquisition expense ratio was 27.6% for the year ended December 31, 2001.
Other underwriting expenses of the Finite Risk segment, including direct and allocated underwriting expenses during 2001, totaled $11 million, resulting in an other underwriting expense ratio of 2.9%.
Liquidity and Capital Resources
Platinum Holdings is a holding company that will conduct no reinsurance operations of its own. All its reinsurance operations will be conducted through its wholly-owned operating subsidiaries
60
Platinum US, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda. As a holding company, Platinum Holdings' cash flow will consist primarily of dividends, interest and other permissible payments from its subsidiaries. Platinum Holdings will depend on such payments to receive funds for general corporate purposes and to meet its obligations, including the payment of any dividends to its shareholders.
Our Liquidity Requirements
Our principal consolidated cash requirements are expected to be the payment of dividends to Platinum Holdings' shareholders, servicing debt, the acquisition of and investment in businesses, capital expenditures, premiums retroceded and payment of losses and loss adjustment expenses, policy benefits, brokerage commissions, excise taxes and operating expenses.
We intend to pay dividends on our Common Shares quarterly, subject to the recommendation of our Board of Directors. Our dividends, if any, will be paid by us in U.S. dollars. Our dividend policy in future periods will depend on a number of factors including our results of operations, our financial condition, our capital and cash requirements, general business conditions, legal, contractual and regulatory restrictions regarding the payment of dividends by us and other factors. See "Dividend Policy".
We will operate a treasury function responsible for managing our future banking relationships, capital raising activities including equity and debt issues, our overall cash, cash pooling and liquidity positions and the payment of internal and external dividends. Our subsidiaries will be responsible for managing local cash and liquidity positions.
Our Sources of Cash
Our sources of funds are expected to consist of premiums written, losses recovered from retrocedents, investment income and proceeds from sales and redemptions of investments.
In addition, we intend to establish with a bank a line of credit for ourselves, as well as for Platinum US, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda. We expect that amounts borrowed under the line of credit will bear interest at specified margins over certain base lending rates including LIBOR, bank certificate of deposit rates and the prime commercial lending rate. We expect the credit lines to contain various customary covenants and agreements which may include a requirement that we or, if applicable, our operating subsidiaries maintain a specified minimum statutory surplus and may prohibit us from having more than a specified amount of consolidated indebtedness following consummation of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment.
Restrictions on Dividend Payments from our Operating Subsidiaries
Bermuda. Bermuda legislation imposes limitations on the dividends that Platinum Bermuda may pay. Under the Bermuda Insurance Act, Platinum Bermuda will be required to maintain a specified solvency margin and a minimum liquidity ratio and will be prohibited from declaring or paying any dividends if doing so would cause Platinum Bermuda to fail to meet its solvency margin and its minimum liquidity ratio. Under the Bermuda Insurance Act, Platinum Bermuda will be prohibited from paying dividends of more than 25% of its total statutory capital and surplus at the end of the previous fiscal year unless it files an affidavit stating that the declaration of such dividends has not caused it to fail to meet its solvency margin and minimum liquidity ratio. The Bermuda Insurance Act will also prohibit Platinum Bermuda from declaring or paying dividends without the approval of the Supervisor of Insurance of Bermuda if Platinum Bermuda failed to meet its solvency margin and minimum liquidity ratio on the last day of the previous fiscal year. Additionally, under the Companies Act, Platinum Bermuda may declare or pay a dividend only if it has no reasonable grounds for believing that it is, or would after the payment, be unable to pay its
61
liabilities as they become due, or that the realizable value of its assets would thereby be less than the aggregate of its liabilities and its issued share capital and share premium accounts. See "Business—Regulation—Bermuda".
United States. Platinum US is subject to regulation by the State of Maryland. Under Maryland insurance law, Platinum US may pay dividends out of surplus, provided it must give the Maryland Insurance Commissioner at least thirty days' prior notice before paying an "extraordinary dividend" or making an "extraordinary distribution". Extraordinary dividends and extraordinary distributions are dividends or distributions which, together with any other dividends and distributions paid during the immediately preceding twelve-month period, would exceed the lesser of
- (1)
- ten percent of Platinum US's statutory policyholders' surplus (as determined under statutory accounting principles) as of December 31 of the prior year and
- (2)
- Platinum US's net investment income excluding realized capital gains (as determined under statutory accounting principles) for the twelve-month period ending on December 31 of the prior year, plus any amounts of net investment income (excluding realized capital gains) in the three preceding years which have not been distributed.
These statutory limitations are subject to change. Platinum US may not pay extraordinary dividends or make extraordinary distributions until either the thirty-day notice period has expired (without the Maryland Insurance Commissioner disapproving such payment) or the Maryland Insurance Commissioner has approved the payment within that period. Extraordinary dividends and extraordinary distributions may only be paid out of earned surplus.
In addition, Platinum US must give ten days' prior notice to the Maryland Insurance Commissioner of its intention to pay any dividend or make any distribution other than an extraordinary dividend or extraordinary distribution. The Maryland Insurance Commissioner has the right to prevent payment of such a dividend or such a distribution if he determines, in his discretion, that after the payment thereof Platinum US's policyholders' surplus would be inadequate or could cause Platinum US to be in a hazardous financial condition.
United Kingdom. U.K. law prohibits Platinum UK from declaring a dividend to its stockholders unless it has "profits available for distribution". The determination of whether a company has profits available for distribution is based on its accumulated realized profits less its accumulated realized losses. While the United Kingdom insurance regulatory laws impose no statutory restrictions on an insurer's ability to declare a dividend, the insurance regulator in the United Kingdom strictly controls the maintenance of each insurance company's solvency margin within its jurisdiction and may restrict Platinum UK from declaring a dividend beyond a level which the regulator determines would adversely affect Platinum UK's solvency requirements. It is common practice in the United Kingdom to notify the regulator in advance of any significant dividend payment.
Ireland. Platinum Ireland is currently a holding company incorporated under the laws of Ireland. Irish law prohibits Platinum Ireland from declaring a dividend to its stockholders unless it has "profits available for distribution" as determined under Irish law. As Platinum Ireland is not currently a regulated entity, there are no insurance or other regulatory laws applicable to the payment of dividends by Platinum Ireland.
Establishment of Loss Reserves by Our Insurance Subsidiaries
Under U.S. GAAP, we will not be permitted to establish loss reserves until the occurrence of an event which may give rise to a loss. Once such an event occurs, we will establish reserves based upon estimates of total losses incurred by the ceding insurers as a result of the event and our estimate of the portion of such loss we have reinsured. As a result, only loss reserves applicable to
62
losses incurred up to the reporting date may be set aside, with no allowance for the provision of a contingency reserve to account for expected future losses. Losses arising from future events will be estimated and recognized at the tiime the loss is incurred and could be substantial.
Setting appropriate reserves is an inherently uncertain process. Loss reserves will represent our estimates, at a given point in time, of ultimate settlement and administration costs of losses incurred (including incurred but not reported losses). We will regularly review and update these estimates, using the most current information available to us. Consequently, the ultimate liability for a loss will likely differ from the original estimate. Whenever we determine that any existing loss reserves are inadequate, we will be required to increase the loss reserves with a corresponding reduction, which could be material, in our operating results in the period in which the deficiency is identified. The establishment of new reserves, or the adjustment of reserves for reported claims, could result in significant upward or downward changes to our financial condition or results of operations in any particular period.
Functional Currency
Our functional currency will be the U.S. dollar. Our operating currency will generally also be the U.S. dollar. However, premiums receivable and losses payable in respect of a portion of our business will be denominated in currencies of other countries, principally the industrialized countries. Consequently, we may, from time to time, experience currency exchange gains and losses that could affect our financial position and results of operations. We do not expect to and as a practical matter will not be able to hedge our non-U.S. dollar currency exposure with respect to potential loss until a loss payable in a non-U.S. dollar currency occurs, after which we may match such liability with assets denominated in the same currency or enter into forward purchase contracts for specific currencies. This type of exposure could be substantial. We also do not intend to hedge our non-U.S. dollar currency exposure with respect to premiums receivable, which will be generally collected over the relevant contract term. We expect to exchange non-U.S. dollar denominated premiums upon receipt. We may make foreign currency investments, generally for the purpose of improving overall portfolio yield.
Investment of Funds
With the exception of cash holdings, our funds will be primarily invested initially in fixed income securities, the market value of which is subject to fluctuation depending on changes in prevailing interest rates. We may in the future elect to also invest a portion of our funds in marketable equity securities. We expect to hedge our investment portfolio against interest rate risk. Nevertheless, an increase in interest rates may result in losses, both realized and unrealized, on our investments.
We do not expect our investment portfolio to include options, warrants, swaps, collars or similar derivative instruments. Our investment policy guidelines will provide that financial futures and options and foreign exchange contracts may not be used in a speculative manner, but may be used, subject to certain numerical limits, only as part of a defensive strategy to protect the market value of the portfolio. Also, we do not expect our portfolio to contain any investments in real estate or mortgage loans.
Posting of Security by Our Non-U.S. Operating Subsidiaries
Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda are not licensed, approved or accredited as reinsurers anywhere in the United States and therefore, under the terms of most of their contracts in the United States, they will have to provide security to reinsureds to cover unpaid liabilities in a form acceptable to state insurance commissioners. Typically, this type of security will take the form of a letter of credit issued by an acceptable bank, the establishment of a trust, or a cash advance.
63
Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda are expected to obtain letters of credit through commercial banks. In turn, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda will provide the banks security by giving the banks liens over certain of Platinum UK's and Platinum Bermuda's investments.
Capital Expenditures; Inflation
None of Platinum Holdings, Platinum US, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda will have any material commitments for capital expenditures upon the completion of the Public Offering.
Platinum US, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda will estimate the effect of inflation on their business and reflect these estimates in the pricing of their reinsurance contracts when estimating reserves. The actual effects of inflation on the results of the operating subsidiaries cannot be accurately known until claims are ultimately settled. Levels of inflation also affect investment returns.
Exposures to Market Risk
Market risk can be described as the risk of change in fair value of a financial instrument due to changes in interest rates, equity prices, creditworthiness, foreign exchange rates or other factors. We seek to mitigate that risk by a number of actions, as described below.
Interest Rate Risk
Our exposure to market risk for changes in interest rates will be concentrated in our investment portfolio once we commence operations. Changes in investment values attributable to interest rate changes will be mitigated, however, by corresponding and partially offsetting changes in the economic value of our insurance reserves. This exposure will be monitored through periodic reviews of our consolidated asset and liability positions. Estimates of cash flows, as well as the impact of interest rate fluctuations relating to the investment portfolio and insurance reserves, will be modeled and reviewed periodically.
Credit Risk
Our investment portfolio is expected to include initially fixed maturities and short-term investments, which will be subject to credit risk. This risk is defined as the potential loss in market value resulting from adverse changes in the borrower's ability to repay the debt. Our investment objective will be to earn competitive relative returns by investing in a diversified portfolio of securities. Credit risk will be actively managed through stringent review and analysis of the creditworthiness of all potential investments.
We will also have other receivable amounts subject to credit risk. The most significant of these are reinsurance recoverables. To mitigate the risk of these counterparties' nonpayment of amounts due, we will establish business and financial standards for reinsurer approval, incorporating ratings by major rating agencies and considering then-current market information.
Equity Price Risk
Our investment portfolio may in the future include marketable equity securities, which will be carried on our consolidated balance sheet at market value. These securities have exposure to price risk, which is defined as the potential loss in market value resulting from an adverse change in prices. If we invest in equity securities, our objective with respect to such investments will be to earn competitive relative returns by investing in a diverse portfolio of high-quality, liquid securities. Portfolio characteristics are expected to be analyzed regularly and market risk will be actively managed through a variety of modeling techniques. If we invest in equity securities, our holdings are expected to be diversified across industries, and concentrations in any one company or
64
industry will be limited by parameters established by senior management, as well as by statutory requirements.
Foreign Currency Exposure
Our exposure to market risk for changes in foreign exchange rates will be concentrated in our insurance reserves denominated in foreign currencies. In addition, there may be foreign currency exposure in our investment portfolio related to those investments that are denominated in foreign currencies. Cash flows from foreign operations are expected to be the primary source of funds for purchases of investments denominated in foreign currencies. Those investments will be purchased primarily to hedge insurance reserves and other liabilities denominated in the same currency, effectively reducing foreign currency exchange rate exposure at the Platinum consolidated level.
65
General
Reinsurance is an arrangement in which an insurance company, referred to as the reinsurer, agrees to assume from another insurance company, referred to as the ceding company, all or a portion of the insurance risks that the ceding company has underwritten under one or more insurance contracts. In return, the reinsurer receives a premium for the insured risks that it assumes from the ceding company. Reinsurance, however, does not discharge the ceding company from its liabilities to policyholders. Reinsurance provides ceding insurers with three principal benefits: a reduction in net liability on individual risks, catastrophe protection from large or multiple losses and assistance in maintaining acceptable financial ratios. Reinsurance also provides a ceding company with additional underwriting capacity by permitting it to accept larger risks and write more business than would be possible without an accompanying increase in capital and surplus.
During the period between the time premiums are received by the reinsurer and the time that the reinsurer must pay losses and loss adjustment expenses, the reinsurer has an opportunity to invest the funds received as premiums, less expenses. This investment activity can make a significant contribution to a reinsurer's profitability.
Types of Reinsurance
Property and Casualty Reinsurance
Reinsurance is typically classified into two categories, property and casualty, or non-life, reinsurance and life reinsurance. We intend to write property and casualty reinsurance. We do not currently intend to write any life reinsurance.
Property insurance protects an insured against financial loss arising out of the loss of property caused by an insured peril. Examples of property reinsurance are property catastrophe and property per-risk coverages. Property catastrophe insurance protects an insured against losses arising out of multiple claims for a single event while property per-risk insurance protects an insured against loss arising out of a single claim for a single event.
Casualty insurance protects an insured against financial loss arising out of loss or damage to persons other than the insured or property belonging to a third party. Examples of casualty insurance are general and automobile liability, professional liability, workers' compensation, and accident and health.
Although property reinsurance involves a high degree of volatility, property reinsurance claims are generally reported soon after the event giving rise to the claim and tend to be assessed and paid relatively expeditiously. In comparison, there tends to be a greater time lag between the occurrence, reporting and payment of casualty reinsurance claims. Additionally, as compared with property reinsurance, casualty reinsurance tends to involve greater diversity of exposures and variation in contract terms, pose greater challenges in capturing underwriting information and casualty reinsurance results are also more likely to be affected by the claims handling process.
Excess-of-loss and Proportional Reinsurance
Reinsurance can be written on either an excess-of-loss basis or a pro rata, or proportional, basis. We expect that a substantial majority of the reinsurance we will underwrite will be excess-of-loss reinsurance.
In the case of excess-of-loss reinsurance, the reinsurer, in return for a negotiated premium, assumes all or a specified portion of the ceding company's risks in excess of a specified amount, which amount is known as the ceding company's retention or the reinsurer's attachment point,
66
subject to a negotiated reinsurance contract limit. For example, property catastrophe excess-of-loss reinsurance provides coverage to a primary insurer when aggregate losses and loss adjustment expenses from a single occurrence of a peril covered under a portfolio of primary insurance contracts written by the primary insurer exceed the attachment point specified in the reinsurance contract with the primary insurer. Property per-risk excess-of-loss-reinsurance provides coverage to a primary insurer in excess of its retention level on a single risk. A risk in this context might mean the insurance coverage on a single property location. Because a reinsurer providing excess-of-loss reinsurance does not assume a direct proportion of the ceding company's risk, the premiums that the ceding company pays to the reinsurer are not directly proportional to the premiums that the ceding company receives. Instead, excess-of-loss reinsurance contracts provide a reinsurer flexibility in determining premiums at specific retention levels, independent of the premiums charged by primary insurers, and based upon its own underwriting assumptions.
Excess-of-loss property and casualty reinsurance is often written in layers. One or a group of reinsurers accepts the risk just above the ceding company's retention up to a specified amount, at which point another reinsurer or a group of reinsurers accepts the excess liability up to an additional specified limit or the excess liability reverts to the ceding company. The reinsurer taking on the risk just above the ceding company's retention is typically said to write lower layer excess reinsurance. Lower layers are also referred to as working layers. A claim that reaches just beyond the ceding company's retention will create a claims payment for the lower layer reinsurer, but not for the reinsurers of any higher layers. In a limited number of cases, reinsurance is also written on an aggregate stop-loss basis to protect the ceding company's total portfolio from extraordinary losses resulting from the aggregation of individual risks.
In the case of proportional reinsurance, the reinsurer assumes a predetermined portion of the ceding company's risks under the covered insurance contract or contracts. The frequency of claims under a proportional reinsurance contract is usually greater than under an excess-of-loss contract. Premiums that the ceding company pays to a reinsurer for proportional reinsurance are a predetermined portion of the premiums that the ceding company receives from its insured, consistent with the proportional sharing of risk. In addition, in proportional reinsurance, the reinsurer generally pays the ceding company a ceding commission. The ceding commission is usually based on the ceding company's cost of generating the business being reinsured, which includes commissions, premium taxes and assessments of the ceding company's own operating expenses. A profit commission or increased ceding commission may be included and paid to the ceding company if the loss experience is profitable. The ceding commission may also be affected by competitive factors.
Treaty and Facultative Reinsurance
Reinsurance can be written either through treaty or facultative reinsurance arrangements. In treaty reinsurance, the ceding company cedes, and the reinsurer assumes, a specified portion of a type or category of risks insured by the ceding company. In facultative reinsurance, the ceding company cedes, and the reinsurer assumes, all or part of a specific risk or risks. We plan to underwrite substantially all treaty reinsurance, and we do not expect to underwrite facultative reinsurance except in very limited and opportunistic circumstances.
Generally in the industry, treaty reinsurers do not separately evaluate each of the individual risks assumed under their treaties and are largely dependent on the original risk underwriting decisions made by the ceding company's underwriters. Accordingly, reinsurers will carefully evaluate the ceding company's risk management and underwriting practices, as well as claims settlement practices and procedures, in deciding whether to provide treaty reinsurance and in appropriately pricing the treaty.
67
Generally, reinsurers who provide facultative reinsurance do so separately from their treaty operations. Facultative reinsurance normally is purchased by ceding companies for risks not covered by their reinsurance treaties, for amounts in excess of the monetary limits of their reinsurance treaties and for unusual and complex risks. In addition, facultative risks often provide coverages for relatively severe exposures which results in greater volatility. Reinsurers who provide facultative coverage solely, or through distinct operations, experience relatively high underwriting expenses and, in particular, personnel costs, because each risk is individually underwritten and administered. The ability to evaluate separately each risk reinsured, however, increases the probability that the reinsurance underwriter can price the contract to reflect more accurately the risks involved. Because of the transactional nature of the business and the greater risks generally involved, margins on facultative business are usually higher than on treaty business.
Non-traditional/Finite Reinsurance
Non-traditional/finite reinsurance involves structured reinsurance solutions tailored to meet an individual cedent's strategic and financial objectives. Property and casualty risks can be reinsured on a non-traditional/finite basis. Often these reinsurance solutions provide reinsurance protection across a company's entire insurance portfolio. For instance, a whole account aggregate stop loss, whether single year or multi-year in design, provides protection for a company from deterioration in its accident year results. Another common solution is a loss portfolio transfer, which can take many forms, and which is frequently used to assist companies in efficiently and effectively exiting lines of business or facilitating insurance entity sales transactions. With increasing frequency, non-traditional/finite reinsurance has been utilized in various ways to assist companies in managing property catastrophe exposures and other loss exposures from single or multiple events which, in the aggregate, could be significant. Because of the constantly changing industry and regulatory framework, as well as the changing market demands facing insurance companies, the approaches utilized in non-traditional/finite programs are constantly evolving and will continue to do so. We expect to be active participants in the non-traditional/finite reinsurance business.
In particular, non-traditional/finite reinsurance products are utilized by customers whose needs may not be met efficiently through traditional reinsurance products, specifically, customers who seek to dampen volatility associated with the insurance or reinsurance pricing cycle, adjust their exposure to specific geographic areas or lines of business, increase their level of retention over a period of time, minimize existing and potential liabilities in connection with extraordinary corporate events, such as a merger or acquisition, and manage their capital during periods of rapid growth. These customers use non-traditional/finite products principally to mitigate volatility in earnings and capital as well as to transfer insurance risks. The structure of the product will depend on whether the concern about volatility relates primarily to statutory capital and loss ratios, or to reported earnings under the customer's accounting basis for investors, e.g., International Accounting Standards, U.S. GAAP or other sovereign GAAP. Income tax treatment will also affect the products' structure. The more widely used finite products have similar features but differing terms and limits, depending on the customer's requirements.
Broker and Direct Reinsurance
Reinsurance can be written through reinsurance brokers or directly with ceding companies. We believe that a ceding company's decision to select either the broker market or the direct market is influenced by various factors including, among others, market capacity, market competition, the value of the broker's advocacy on the ceding company's behalf, the spread of risk, flexibility in the terms and conditions, an ability to efficiently compare the analysis and quotes of several reinsurers, the speed of a reinsurance placement, the historical relationship with the reinsurer and the efficiency of claims settlement with respect to a coverage. Through the use of reinsurance brokers, a reinsurer may be able to avoid the need to develop a large staff dedicated to particular
68
reinsurance markets and to maintain the flexibility to move into other reinsurance markets when it perceives opportunities. We believe that the use of reinsurance brokers will allow us to avoid the significant fixed cost of maintaining a sales force. We believe that brokers are particularly useful in assisting clients in arranging excess-of-loss reinsurance programs. We expect to underwrite a substantial majority of our reinsurance through brokers and, to a much more limited extent, may also contract directly with ceding companies.
Retrocession
Reinsurers typically purchase reinsurance to cover their own risk exposure or to increase their capacity. Reinsurance of a reinsurer's business is called retrocession. Reinsurance companies cede risks under retrocessional agreements to other reinsurers, known as retrocessionaires, for reasons similar to those that cause primary insurers to purchase reinsurance. These reasons include reducing liability on individual risks, protecting against catastrophic losses, stabilizing financial ratios and obtaining additional underwriting capacity. We plan to purchase and issue retrocessional policies.
Reinsurance Industry Conditions and Trends
The reinsurance industry historically has been cyclical, characterized by periods of price competition due to excessive underwriting capacity as well as periods when shortages of underwriting capacity have permitted favorable pricing.
Cyclical trends in the industry and the industry's profitability can also be affected significantly by volatile and unpredictable developments, including natural and other disasters, such as hurricanes, windstorms, earthquakes, floods, fires, explosions and other catastrophic events, including terrorist attacks, the frequency and severity of which are inherently unpredictable. We believe that property and casualty reinsurance rates often rise in the aftermath of significant catastrophe losses. As claims are reserved, the industry's capacity to write new business diminishes. The industry is also affected by changes in the propensity of courts to expand insurance coverage and grant large damage awards, as well as fluctuations in interest rates and other changes in the economic environment that affect market prices of investments.
As a result of favorable loss levels and strong investment returns beginning in 1995, the reinsurance industry entered a cycle of increased competition and industry capacity, which pushed property and casualty premium rates down. However, in 1999, there were several significant worldwide catastrophic events, which resulted in insured losses of approximately $31 billion. These losses, and the subsequent contraction of capacity in the market, fueled improvements in rates, terms and conditions beginning with January 2000 renewals. These improvements continued in 2001 with a number of catastrophic events in the first half of the year, and were accelerated by the terrorist attack of September 11, 2001. With insured losses estimated to be in the range of $30 billion to $35 billion, the terrorist attack resulted in the largest insured losses ever experienced by the industry. By comparison, the largest insured catastrophic event prior to the attack was Hurricane Andrew in 1992 with $20 billion in estimated losses.
We believe that the insured losses of 2001 have reduced the industry's capacity to write new business. At the same time, it appears that the heightened awareness that commercial properties are exposed to a variety of risks, and the perception that certain regions of the world may be underinsured, have increased the demand for property-related insurance and reinsurance. As a result, with respect to January 2002 renewals, St. Paul Re experienced substantial rate increases, generally ranging from 20% to 50% depending on the line of business. We expect that the current imbalance between the increased demand for property-related insurance and reinsurance and the reduced supply of this type of coverage will continue to fuel improved rates, terms and conditions for at least the immediate future.
69
Following the terrorist attack of September 11, 2001, there is uncertainty in the insurance and reinsurance markets about the extent to which future coverages will extend to terrorist acts. There is also uncertainty about the definition of terrorist acts. We believe that coverage of claims that are the result of terrorist acts (as they are ultimately defined by industry and government standards) will generally be excluded from property catastrophe reinsurance contracts covering large commercial risks, above specified property values, but generally will not be excluded for smaller commercial coverages, personal lines or other coverages. Accordingly, we presently continue to incur exposure to terrorist acts. The effect of potential U.S. and other governmental intervention on the insurance and reinsurance markets we serve, including on the extent to which coverage for terrorist acts will be offered by the insurance and reinsurance markets in the future, is uncertain. Coverage for losses resulting from terrorist acts may be offered separately in the reinsurance market, and we may or may not offer such coverage in the future. If our and the insurance industry's attempts to exclude coverage for terrorist acts were to fail, we could incur large unexpected losses if further terrorist attacks occur.
General
Platinum Holdings is a newly formed Bermuda insurance holding company. Our objective is to provide on a worldwide basis, through our licensed operating subsidiaries Platinum US, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda, property, casualty, marine, accident and health and finite reinsurance coverages to a diverse clientele of insurers and select reinsurers. Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda are newly formed companies and, as such, have no prior operating history or loss reserve run-off. Platinum US was formed in 1995 and is a licensed insurance company and wholly owned subsidiary of St. Paul incorporated and domiciled in the state of Maryland. Platinum US has been an inactive company with no prior operating history and no exposure to adverse loss development. Upon completion of the Public Offering, we will own Platinum US and Platinum UK through Platinum Ireland, our newly formed and wholly owned intermediate Irish holding subsidiary. We expect that Platinum Ireland will conduct no business operations of its own other than owning Platinum US and Platinum UK. However, we intend to explore the possibility of using Platinum Ireland as a platform for the development of a reinsurance business concentrating on continental Europe. The following chart summarizes our corporate structure upon completion of the transactions contemplated by this prospectus.
70
We intend to organize our worldwide reinsurance business around the following three operating segments: Global Property and Marine, Global Casualty and Finite Risk. In each of our operating segments, we intend to offer our reinsurance solutions to providers of commercial and personal lines of property insurance as well as casualty insurance. We expect to underwrite most of our reinsurance through brokers but we may also contract directly with ceding companies, which will give us the flexibility to pursue business in accordance with our ceding companies' preferred reinsurance purchasing channels. We intend to write substantially all of our reinsurance business through treaties rather than on a facultative basis, and a substantial majority on an excess-of-loss basis rather than on a proportional basis.
We expect to operate principally as a lead or quoting reinsurer on the treaties in which we participate. Generally, the lead or quoting reinsurer negotiates with the ceding company and the broker to establish the proposed terms of coverage, including the premium rate and retention level for excess-of-loss contracts. When not acting as the leading or quoting reinsurer on a particular treaty, we may seek to actively negotiate additional terms or conditions. We believe that, consistent with our underwriting strategy, operating as a lead or quoting reinsurer will allow us to establish walk-away prices and focus on profitability rather than market share. In addition to the benefit of leading negotiations of contract terms and prices, we believe that operating as a lead or quoting reinsurer will aid us in the development of close and continuing relationships with brokers and ceding companies. We also believe that operating as a lead or quoting reinsurer will result in our receiving solicitations from brokers for a broader range of business and provide us with greater access to preferred risks.
Competitive Strengths
We believe that we will have the benefits of being both an established business and a new market entrant because of our management's reputation and St. Paul Re's experience and contacts in the reinsurance market, our unencumbered capital base and our expectation that the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts and our right to seek to renew St. Paul Re's other contracts will be a long-term source of business to us. As a well-capitalized company with reinsurance as our single focus, we believe we will be able to expand our relationships with existing clients and establish relationships with new clients.
We expect our initial portfolio to contain a variety of businesses which we believe would normally take a significant time to develop. Upon completion of the Public Offering, we expect to be diversified across several types of coverage with approximately two-thirds of our premiums coming from traditional property and casualty reinsurance and one-third from finite reinsurance. We believe that the existing portfolio of business generated by St. Paul Re represents a valuable asset given the renewal nature of the reinsurance industry and the importance of continuity of relationships and information.
We believe that the market perceptions and reputation established by St. Paul Re with respect to service and responsiveness will benefit us in light of the transfer of personnel and underwriting activities from St. Paul Re to us. We also believe that we will enjoy a reputation with our brokers and clients for promptly responding to underwriting submissions and consistent underwriting standards that emphasize long term profitability over premium growth or market share.
We believe that the use of reinsurance brokers as our principal source of business provides us with an advantage over direct writers in adjusting treaty participations upward or downward to reflect changing market conditions, as well as discontinuing any participation in treaties if rates and terms are no longer attractive. In addition, we believe that the use of reinsurance brokers will allow us to avoid the significant fixed cost of maintaining a sales force. Furthermore, we believe that access to new opportunities on new treaties for existing clients or new clients are facilitated by using the broker distribution channel, due to the syndicated placement of the business.
71
Platinum's Strategy
Our goal is to achieve superior long-term returns for our shareholders, while establishing Platinum as a conservative risk manager and market leader in certain classes of property and casualty reinsurance.
- •
- Build our future on a strong foundation. We will commence operations with the benefit of the Transferred Business:
- •
- Renewal Rights and Assumed Reinsurance Contracts. Our initial portfolio will contain a diversity of business that would normally take many years to develop. We will be acquiring St. Paul Re's existing customer lists and the right to seek to renew its in-force reinsurance contracts, which produced 2001 pro forma net premiums written of approximately $1.4 billion. Our business is expected to be diversified between property contracts, which tend to be short-tail in nature (where ultimate losses are known relatively quickly), and casualty contracts, which tend to be long-tail in nature (where ultimate losses may not be known for many years). Property catastrophe reinsurance will be a principal focus and will initially constitute a diversified global book of business in excess of $100 million in annual net premiums written.
- •
- Fully operational infrastructure. We will select experienced employees from the skilled St. Paul Re employee base. These employees have broker and ceding company relationships and underwriting pricing and claims experience that will allow us to be fully staffed and operational in key underwriting and support functions. We believe that this strong foundation will allow us to offer clients and brokers a full range of products, support and service immediately following the completion of the Public Offering.
- •
- Add new executive leadership to existing talent. In order to take full advantage of the historical strengths of St. Paul Re, we have significantly strengthened our senior management team with the addition of Mr. Newman and Mr. Fadden. Mr. Newman and Mr. Fadden have extensive experience in leading publicly traded reinsurance companies and intend to implement a number of initiatives to capitalize on the strengths of St. Paul Re to create a more focused and more profitable reinsurance business. We expect these initiatives to include implementing a new underwriting strategy, improving risk management and reducing operating expenses.
- •
- Focus on profitability, not market share. Our new management team intends to pursue a strategy that emphasizes underwriting discipline and profitability over market share. Key elements of this strategy will be prudent risk selection, appropriate pricing through strict underwriting discipline and adjusting our business mix to respond to changing market conditions. We intend to increase our writing of lines of business, such as property catastrophe excess-of-loss and property risk excess- of-loss, which we believe will contribute to our long-term profitability.
- •
- Exercise disciplined underwriting and risk management. We intend to exercise risk management discipline by (i) maintaining a diverse spread of risk in our book of business across products and geographic zones, (ii) focusing on excess-of-loss contracts as opposed to pro rata contracts, and (iii) reducing our aggregate catastrophe exposure relative to historical levels through more sophisticated management of property catastrophe aggregate exposures.
- •
- Operate a lean and expense-focused underwriting business. We believe a lean underwriting culture will support our focus on profitability and allow us to be more responsive to changing market conditions. We intend to keep our headcount low and maintain a limited number of offices. At January 1, 2001, St. Paul Re had approximately 398 employees while we expect to have approximately 180 employees at the completion of the Public Offering. The number of underwriting offices was reduced by St. Paul Re
72
- •
- Grow our business by leveraging our global platform. We intend to operate in all three of the world's leading reinsurance markets with offices in New York, London and Bermuda. St. Paul Re has conducted admitted reinsurance activities in the U.S. and London for many years, and has been well established as a lead underwriter in excess casualty, property catastrophe and certain other classes of reinsurance. Our new Bermuda subsidiary will provide us with both a new market in which to write reinsurance and the flexibility to provide reinsurance products that are best facilitated by an offshore company.
- •
- Operate from a position of financial strength. As a newly formed company, our initial capital position is unencumbered by any development of loss reserves for business written prior to January 1, 2002. We intend to operate the Company with a target capitalization consistent with our ratings objectives. We expect to have approximately $1 billion of equity capital following the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment to support our anticipated underwriting activities. Our investment strategy will focus on security and stability in our investment portfolio by maintaining a diversified portfolio that will consist primarily of investment grade fixed-income securities. We believe these factors, combined with our strict underwriting discipline, will allow us to maintain our strong financial position and to be opportunistic when market conditions are most attractive.
from ten at January 1, 2001 to five as of March 31, 2002. In addition, we expect to originate most of our business from brokers, rather than directly from ceding companies, which we believe will keep our expenses low.
Our Lines of Business
We intend to organize our worldwide reinsurance business around the following three operating segments: Global Property and Marine, Global Casualty and Finite Risk. On the pro forma basis described under "Pro Forma Financial Information", we had net premiums written of $1,382 million for the year ended December 31, 2001, $415 million for the three months ended March 31, 2002 and $341 million for the three months ended March 31, 2001. We expect that our global reinsurance business will be comprised primarily of the types of reinsurance set forth below, which we have grouped in accordance with our three operating segments. The following table sets forth, on a pro forma basis, the distribution by operating segment and by type of reinsurance, of our net premiums written for the year ended December 31, 2001 and the quarters ended March 31, 2002 and 2001. For a more detailed discussion of the pro forma combined results of underwriting, see "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Pro Forma Financial Condition and Underwriting Results".
73
| Three Months Ended March 31, | | | |||||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Year Ended December 31, 2001 | |||||||||||||||||
| 2002 | 2001 | ||||||||||||||||
| $ | % Total | $ | % Total | $ | % Total | ||||||||||||
| | | ($ in millions) | | | |||||||||||||
Global Property and Marine | ||||||||||||||||||
Excess-of-loss | $ | 100 | 24 | % | $ | 90 | 26 | % | $ | 249 | 18 | % | ||||||
Proportional | 25 | 6 | 28 | 9 | 66 | 5 | ||||||||||||
Total Global Property and Marine | 125 | 30 | 118 | 35 | 315 | 23 | ||||||||||||
Global Casualty | ||||||||||||||||||
Excess-of-loss | 139 | 33 | 104 | 30 | 440 | 32 | ||||||||||||
Proportional | 58 | 14 | 49 | 15 | 152 | 11 | ||||||||||||
Total Global Casualty | 197 | 47 | 153 | 45 | 592 | 43 | ||||||||||||
Finite Risk | 93 | 23 | 70 | 20 | 475 | 34 | ||||||||||||
Total | $ | 415 | 100 | % | $ | 341 | 100 | % | $ | 1,382 | 100 | % | ||||||
The following table sets forth, on a pro forma basis, the distribution by operating segment and by location of the cedent of our net premiums written for the year ended December 31, 2001 and the quarters ended March 31, 2002 and 2001.
| Three Months Ended March 31, | | | |||||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Year Ended December 31, 2001 | |||||||||||||||||
| 2002 | 2001 | ||||||||||||||||
| $ | % Total | $ | % Total | $ | % Total | ||||||||||||
| | | ($ in millions) | | | |||||||||||||
Global Property and Marine | ||||||||||||||||||
United States | $ | 70 | 17 | % | $ | 61 | 18 | % | $ | 173 | 13 | % | ||||||
International | 55 | 13 | 57 | 17 | 142 | 10 | ||||||||||||
Total Global Property and Marine | 125 | 30 | 118 | 35 | 315 | 23 | ||||||||||||
Global Casualty | ||||||||||||||||||
United States | 171 | 41 | 122 | 36 | 485 | 35 | ||||||||||||
International | 26 | 6 | 31 | 9 | 107 | 8 | ||||||||||||
Total Global Casualty | 197 | 47 | 153 | 45 | 592 | 43 | ||||||||||||
Finite Risk | ||||||||||||||||||
United States | 56 | 13 | 34 | 10 | 266 | 19 | ||||||||||||
International | 37 | 10 | 36 | 10 | 209 | 15 | ||||||||||||
Total Finite Risk | 93 | 23 | 70 | 20 | 475 | 34 | ||||||||||||
Total | $ | 415 | 100 | % | $ | 341 | 100 | % | $ | 1,382 | 100 | % | ||||||
Global Property and Marine
The Global Property and Marine operating segment will include principally property and marine reinsurance coverages that will be written both in the United States and international markets. We expect that the majority of the property business will consist of catastrophe excess-of-loss reinsurance treaties. We expect that this global operating segment will also include property per risk excess-of-loss treaties and property pro rata treaties. We expect that marine reinsurance will include coverage for hull and cargo as well as third party marine coverages for "protection and indemnity" and excess liabilities, primarily under excess-of-loss treaties. We may write a limited amount of other types of reinsurance on an opportunistic basis. Following the completion of the Public Offering we
74
expect the proportion of our net premiums written generated by the Global Property and Marine segment to increase relative to 2001 levels.
- •
- Property. We expect that our property reinsurance activities will emphasize catastrophe excess-of-loss reinsurance. Such contracts will provide a defined limit of liability, permitting us to quantify our aggregate maximum loss exposure. By contrast, maximum liability under pro rata contracts is more difficult to quantify precisely within the occurrence limits that are normally part of the contracts. Quantification of loss exposure will be fundamental to our ability to manage our loss exposure through geographical zone limits and program limits.
In addition, when our pricing standards are met, we may, to a limited extent, write other property coverages, including per risk excess-of-loss or pro rata treaties. In writing per risk excess-of-loss business we intend to avoid lower layers in favor of higher layers. These lines will diversify risk (although they involve some catastrophe exposure) and thus reduce the volatility in results of operations caused by catastrophes.
- •
- Marine. We intend to provide reinsurance coverage of marine and offshore energy insurance programs. We expect that coverages reinsured will include hull damage, protection and indemnity, cargo damage and general marine liability. We expect that such reinsurance treaties will include excess-of-loss as well as proportional treaties. We will emphasize excess-of-loss treaties that provide for an evaluation using experience and exposure pricing models.
Excess-of-loss contracts will also help us to control our underwriting results by increasing our flexibility to determine premiums for reinsurance at specific retention levels, independent of the premiums charged by primary insurers, and based upon our own underwriting assumptions. Also, because primary insurers typically retain a larger loss exposure under excess-of-loss contracts, we believe that they have a greater incentive to underwrite risks and adjust losses in a prudent manner.
Global Casualty
The Global Casualty segment will include principally general and automobile liability, professional liability, workers' compensation, accident and health and casualty clash coverages. We also expect to include accident and health reinsurance treaties in the form of self-insured aggregate medical stop loss coverages, which go into effect when a self-insuring employer's total group health insurance claims attain a certain level, as well as other types of coverages as opportunities develop. We intend to generally write reinsurance coverage in this segment through excess-of-loss treaties, including umbrella coverages, which protect against losses in excess of amounts covered by other policies, although we expect to reinsure selected classes of casualty business on a pro rata basis, including accident and health business. Following the completion of the Public Offering, we expect the proportion of our net premiums written generated by the Global Casualty segment to decrease relative to 2001 levels.
- •
- General and Automobile Liability. We intend to reinsure accident and casualty risks and collision damage of motor vehicles. Automobile insurance can include coverage in three major areas—casualty, accident benefits and physical damage. Casualty insurance provides coverage payment for injuries and for property damage to third parties. Accident benefits insurance provides coverage for loss of income and medical and rehabilitation expenses for insured persons who are injured in an automobile accident, regardless of fault. Physical damage insurance provides for payment of damages to an insured automobile arising from a collision with another object or from other risks such as fire or theft.
In addition, we expect to provide a broad range of coverage for reinsurance of industrial, manufacturer, operational, environmental, product and general third party liability. We expect that our general and automobile liability reinsurance products will generally be written on an
75
- •
- Professional Liability. We intend to write reinsurance treaties for professional liability programs, including directors and officers liability insurance and errors and omissions liability insurance. We expect that, in most circumstances, the underlying insurance products will be written on a claims-made form, which requires claims related to the liabilities insured under the policy to be submitted to the insurer while the policy is in force. We intend to employ underwriters and pricing actuaries who specialize in professional liability and we expect to seek to reinsure professional liability programs and lines of casualty business where and to the extent we believe past experience permits a reasonably accurate estimation of premium adequacy. We intend, however, to underwrite new exposures after a comprehensive evaluation of the capability of the ceding company, a clear understanding of the type of product, and establishment of underwriting and operating procedures.
- •
- Workers' Compensation. We intend that our workers' compensation coverages will provide flexible solutions that can help our clients manage their global workers' compensation risks. We expect to reinsure workers' compensation on a per-claimant basis as well as on a catastrophe occurrence basis. We expect that our workers' compensation reinsurance offerings will range from complete coverage of a full workers' compensation program to specific carve-out coverages that address a client's targeted concerns.
- •
- Accident and Health. We intend to provide accident and health reinsurance, typically in the form of self-insured aggregate medical stop-loss coverages, referred to as "employers stop loss covers". On a less frequent basis, we also expect to write medical providers stop-loss, first dollar health insurance and other reinsurance of health providers. We expect to rely principally on managing general underwriters as intermediaries in connection with this line of business.
- •
- Casualty Clash. We expect that our casualty clash coverages will cover losses arising from a single set of circumstances (an occurrence) covered by more than one cedent's insurance policy or multiple claimants on one policy. We expect to limit our exposure to a proportion of the cedent's loss in excess of a specified per occurrence retention up to a specified limit.
excess-of-loss basis. We may, however, consider selected accounts to be written on a proportional or pro rata basis to the extent that such business satisfies our profitability standards.
Finite Risk
The Finite Risk operating segment will include principally finite reinsurance solutions to cedents whose needs may not be met efficiently through traditional reinsurance products. We intend to focus on providing such clients with customized solutions for their risk management and other financial management needs. Whether working directly with the client or through a broker, we will seek to develop client-specific solutions after spending time with the client to understand its business needs. We intend to take a uniform risk assessment approach throughout our worldwide operations as the classes of risks underwritten through finite products will generally be consistent with the classes covered using traditional products. See "—Underwriting and Risk Management". The four main categories of finite products that we intend to sell are described below:
- •
- Multi-year excess of loss.These reinsurance contracts often complement cedents' traditional excess-of-loss reinsurance programs. They may involve any type of risk, but most often they cover property and marine. In general, these contracts are designed so that the cedent funds the normal level of loss activity over a multi-year period. The reinsurer charges an additional margin to provide a profit margin and to cover its costs and the risk that losses are worse than normal. This type of product will often carry an up-front premium plus additional premiums which are dependent on the magnitude of losses claimed by the ceding company under the contract. The ceding company generally also participates in a profit
76
- •
- Aggregate stop loss. Aggregate stop loss reinsurance contracts provide broad protection against a wide range of contingencies that are difficult to address with traditional reinsurance. They can be offered on a single or multi-year basis, and provide either catastrophic or attritional loss protection.
- •
- Finite quota share. Finite quota share reinsurance contracts limit the reinsurer's underwriting exposure while allowing the cedent surplus and expense ratio relief.
- •
- Loss portfolio transfer and adverse loss development. These types of reinsurance contracts are considered retroactive reinsurance as they cover past periods for which the loss events have already occurred, but where all claims have not yet been made or paid. Retroactive finite reinsurance products remain an attractive solution for certain clients, who may, for example, wish to exit a particular line of business, facilitate a business acquisition (where the reinsurance contract effectively replaces the seller's requirement to provide a loss reserve guarantee to the purchaser), or stabilize statutory capital. Typically, a loss portfolio transfer will transfer to the reinsurer all risks underwritten, subject to an aggregate loss limit established in the contract. Adverse loss development products provide reinsurance coverage for losses in excess of the carried loss reserves of the ceding company at the transaction date, or in some cases at a mutually agreed attachment point, in excess of existing loss reserves.
sharing arrangement under this type of reinsurance contract if the business covered does not generate excessive losses.
Marketing
We intend to market our reinsurance products worldwide through our underwriting offices and non-exclusive relationships with more than 50 of the leading reinsurance brokers active in the U.S. and non-U.S. markets for property catastrophe reinsurance and other categories of reinsurance in which we will be active.
On a pro forma basis, based on net premiums written during the three months ended March 31, 2002, the five brokers from which St. Paul Re derived the largest portions of its business (with the approximate percentage of St. Paul Re's business derived from such brokers and their affiliates) are Aon Corporation (25.7%), Marsh & McLennan Companies (18.6%), Benfield Blanch Inc. (18.5%), Willis Group Holdings (9.7%) and Clayton Denis M. & Co. (4.5%). The loss of any of these top five brokers could have a material effect on the amount of reinsurance business that we obtain and consequently the reinsurance premiums that we receive. On a pro forma basis, during the year ended December 31, 2001, St. Paul Re had in force reinsurance contracts with 146 ceding companies that were not derived from a reinsurance broker; otherwise, products are marketed exclusively through brokers. All brokerage transactions are entered into on an arm's-length basis. During 2001, on a pro forma basis, one ceding insurer accounted for more than 6% of St. Paul Re's premiums written and no other single ceding insurer accounted for more than 3%. Based on the Company's strategy, which includes our intention to employ key St. Paul Re personnel and to maintain our presence in our existing lines of business, management expects to maintain strong relationships with these brokers.
We expect that brokers will perform data collection, contract preparation and other administrative tasks, enabling us to market our reinsurance products cost effectively by maintaining a small staff. We intend to rely largely on reinsurance brokers to market our products. We believe that by relying largely on reinsurance brokers, we will be able to avoid the expense and regulatory complications of worldwide offices, thereby minimizing fixed costs associated with marketing activities. We believe that by maintaining close relationships with brokers, we will be able to obtain access to a broad range of potential reinsureds.
77
The following table sets forth, on a pro forma basis, net premiums written and the percentage of St. Paul Re's premiums allocated to the geographic location of the ceding company for St. Paul Re's aggregate operations. For a more detailed discussion of the pro forma results of underwriting, see "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Pro Forma Financial Condition and Underwriting Results".
| Three Months Ended | | | |||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Year Ended December 31, 2001 | |||||||||||||||
| March 2002 | March 2001 | ||||||||||||||
$ | % | $ | % | $ | % | |||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||||||||
North America (ex Caribbean) | $ | 299 | 72 | % | $ | 215 | 63 | % | $ | 968 | 70 | % | ||||
Caribbean | 17 | 4 | 20 | 6 | 83 | 6 | ||||||||||
Latin America | 4 | 1 | 3 | 1 | 14 | 1 | ||||||||||
Far East | 12 | 3 | 14 | 4 | 55 | 4 | ||||||||||
Continental Europe | 21 | 5 | 41 | 12 | 110 | 8 | ||||||||||
United Kingdom | 58 | 14 | 45 | 13 | 138 | 10 | ||||||||||
Other | 4 | 1 | % | 3 | 1 | % | 14 | 1 | % | |||||||
$ | 415 | 100 | % | $ | 341 | 100 | % | $ | 1,382 | 100 | % | |||||
Underwriting and Risk Management
We intend to have a disciplined approach to underwriting and risk management that emphasizes a profit orientation rather than a premium volume or market-share oriented approach. In addition to geographic zones, we intend to seek to limit our overall exposure to risk by limiting the amount of reinsurance we will supply in accordance with a particular program or contract, so as to achieve diversification within and across geographic zones.
We expect our risk management to use a variety of means, including the use of contract terms, diversification criteria and probability analysis and the analysis of comparable historical loss experience. We will monitor concentrations of casualty risk by industry and classes of risk. We intend to estimate the impact of certain catastrophic events using catastrophe modeling software and contract information to evaluate our exposure to losses from individual contracts and in the aggregate. For example, we expect that the majority of the natural catastrophe reinsurance we will write will relate to exposures within the United States, Europe and Japan. Accordingly, we will monitor our exposure to natural catastrophic events that affect these regions, such as U.S. hurricane, California earthquake, European windstorm and Japanese typhoon or earthquake events.
We will seek to limit our potential loss, pre tax, but after reinstatement and other premiums received due to the loss, from a single one-in-250-year catastrophe on a probable maximum loss basis, after giving effect to our retrocessional programs, to no more than 30% of our shareholder's equity. There can be no assurance that our underwriting risk management procedures and our retrocessional programs will successfully limit actual losses to such amount and losses from a single catastrophe may materially exceed such amount. The intended limitation in probable maximum loss exposure will rely significantly on our retrocessional programs and the availability of retrocessional coverage in the future. There have been, and in the future may be, periods when retrocessional coverage is not available at all or at rates and levels which would be acceptable. Loss of all or portions of our retrocessional coverage could subject us to increased exposure, which could be material. A limited number of the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts do not contain loss cap ratios, which means that there is no contractual limit to the losses that we may be required to pay pursuant to such Assumed Reinsurance Contracts.
78
Substantially all property reinsurance business with natural peril catastrophe exposure will have occurrence limits. Substantially all high layer property, casualty and marine excess-of-loss business will also contain aggregate limits in the contracts, with limited reinstatements of an occurrence limit, which restore the original limit under the contract after the limit has been depleted by losses incurred on that treaty by the reinsurer. We intend to use our proprietary models to assess the pricing adequacy, underwriting profitability and investment returns to be expected from our reinsurance underwriting. We expect that our actuarial and underwriting departments will work together to establish an accurate pricing model for these purposes.
In addition, we will have available for our use the historical loss experience of St. Paul Re to assist us in pricing individual treaties and overall lines of business. We believe that this information provides us with a significant benefit in the underwriting of future contracts and in the renewal thereof. We expect to maintain the normal maximum program limits described under "—Geographic Diversification" below. We will also attempt to distribute our exposure across a range of attachment points, or the amount of claims that have to be borne by the ceding insurer before our reinsurance coverage applies. Attachment points will vary and will be based upon an assessment of the ceding insurer's market share of property perils in any given geographic zone to which the contract relates, as well as the capital needs of the ceding insurer.
Before we review any program proposal, we intend to consider the appropriateness of the cedent, including the quality of its management and its capital and risk management strategy. In addition, we intend to require that each proposed reinsurance program include information on the nature of the perils to be included and detailed aggregate information as to the location or locations of the risks covered under the catastrophe contract. We would also expect to request information on the cedent's loss history for the perils being reinsured, together with relevant underwriting considerations, which would impact exposures to catastrophe reinsurers. We expect to first evaluate exposures on new programs in light of the overall zone limits in any given catastrophe zone, together with program limits and contract limits, to ensure a balanced and disciplined underwriting approach. If the program meets all these initial underwriting criteria, we expect to then evaluate the proposal in terms of its risk/reward profile to assess the adequacy of the proposed pricing and its potential impact on our overall return on capital.
We plan to extensively use sophisticated modeling and other technology in our underwriting process. We expect that each submission received will be registered on the reinsurance data system that we will use for both underwriting and aggregate control purposes. This system will enable both management and underwriters to have on-line information regarding both individual exposures and zonal aggregate concentrations. We expect that submissions will be recorded to determine and monitor their status as being pending, authorized, or bound.
In addition to the reinsurance data system, we expect to use computer modeling to measure and estimate loss exposure under both simulated and actual loss scenarios and in comparing exposure portfolios to both single and multiple events. We expect to contract with Applied Insurance Research for the use of Cattrader and EQE for the use of Equecat, and we also plan to use RMS models as part of our modeling approach. We expect to take an active role in the evaluation of these commercial catastrophe pricing models, providing feedback to the modeling companies to improve the efficiencies of these models. These computer-based loss modeling systems utilize Best's data and direct exposure information obtained from our clients to assess each client's catastrophe management approach and adequacy of their program's protection. We believe that modeling is a very important part of the underwriting criteria for catastrophe exposure pricing. We expect to apply proprietary analysis of the catastrophe exposure to supplement the model output in certain territories. The majority of our expected client base also use one or more of the various modeling consulting firms in their exposure management analysis. In addition, we intend to sometimes perform or contract for additional modeling analysis when reviewing our global
79
commitments. We expect that the combination of reinsurance system information, together with the various commercial models we expect to employ, will enable us to monitor and control our acceptance of exposure on a global basis. We also intend to use proprietary risk modeling systems to measure expected losses for perils other than hurricane and earthquake and that include allowances for expenses and profit in pricing.
We expect to seek to limit our overall exposure to risk by pursuing a disciplined underwriting strategy which will limit the amount of reinsurance we will supply in accordance with a particular program or contract so as to achieve diversification within and across geographical zones. Commencing January 2002, St. Paul Re has maintained normal maximum program limits of $5 million on risk programs, $6 million on casualty clash programs and $20 million on property catastrophe programs. In a small number of instances, we may exceed these limits. A limited number of the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts do not contain loss cap ratios, which means that there is no contractual limit to the losses that we may be required to pay pursuant to such Assumed Reinsurance Contracts.
We intend to establish a procedure for underwriting control to ensure that all acceptances are made in accordance with our underwriting policy and aggregate control. We expect that each underwriting individual will be given an underwriting authority limit, and that underwriting amounts above those limits will have to be submitted for approval to the chief underwriting officer.
Generally, about 50% of premiums we write each year are expected to be for contracts which have effective dates in January, about 20% in April, about 20% in July and the remainder at other times throughout the year. Premiums are generally due in installments over the contract term, with each installment generally received within 30 days after the due date.
Geographic Diversification
We intend to seek, based on the location of the risk, to diversify our exposure across geographic zones around the world in order to obtain a favorable spread of risk. We intend to limit the coverage we provide for risks located in particular zones, so as to maintain our aggregate loss exposure from all contracts covering risks believed to be located in that zone, to a predetermined level. We intend to monitor concentrations of risk in any particular geographic area, and to seek to avoid accumulations of property risks located in areas considered to have a higher probability of natural catastrophes, such as the West Coast states, the Gulf Coast and Southeastern United States, as well as the Caribbean, Japan, Northern Europe and other exposed international territories.
We expect to establish the predetermined levels referred to in the prior paragraph annually on the basis of, and as a proportion of, shareholders' equity. If a proposed reinsurance program would cause the limit then in effect to be exceeded, we would expect to decline the program, regardless of its desirability, unless we utilize retrocessional coverage, thereby reducing the net aggregate exposure to the maximum limit permitted, or less. If we were to suffer a net financial loss in any fiscal year, thus reducing shareholders' equity, we would attempt to reduce the limits per zone in the following year, with the possible effect that we would thereafter reduce existing business in a zone exceeding such limit.
We intend to track our catastrophe exposures in all significant countries around the world. We intend to maintain a database of our exposures in each country and to conservatively estimate our probable maximum loss in each country for the perils to which that country is subject (e.g., earthquakes, hurricanes, and floods.) We expect to base our estimates on catastrophe models and underwriting assessments. In addition, we expect to use catastrophe modeling to review exposures on events that cross country borders such as wind events that may affect the Caribbean and
80
Florida or the U.K. and Continental Europe. The largest exposures are expected to be in the U.S. for earthquake and hurricane, in the U.K. for flood and wind, and in Japan for earthquake and wind.
We recognize that events may affect more than one zone, and to the extent we intend to reinsure a ceding insurer with a loss exposure in more than one zone, we intend to consider such potential loss in testing its limits in all such affected zones. For example, a program with worldwide exposure may be subject to limits in the North America zones as well as other zones around the world, as applicable. This results in very substantial "double-counting" of exposures in determining utilization of an aggregate within a given zone. Consequently, the total sum insured may be less than the sums of utilized aggregates for all of the zones.
Retrocessional Reinsurance
We expect to obtain retrocessional reinsurance to, among other things, reduce volatility in general, and to increase our capacity offered on individual reinsurance programs.
The major types of retrocessional coverage we expect to purchase will include the following:
- •
- specific coverage for certain property, marine and casualty exposures,
- •
- catastrophe coverage for property business, and
- •
- corporate level coverage for the potential accumulation or aggregation of exposures across some or all of our operations.
We may purchase further retrocessional coverage on an opportunistic basis.
We expect that our decisions with respect to purchasing retrocessional coverage will consider both the potential coverage and market conditions with respect to the pricing, terms, conditions and availability of such coverage, with the aim of securing cost-effective protection. We expect that the level of retrocessional coverage will vary over time, reflecting the underwriter's and/or our view of the changing dynamics of both the underlying exposure and the reinsurance markets.
We expect that, prior to entering into a retrocessional agreement, we will analyze the financial strength and rating of each retrocessionaire. We expect that retrocessional coverage will generally be derived from companies rated "A" or better by Best's. Afterwards, the financial performance and rating status of all material retrocessionaires will be monitored. Retrocession agreements do not relieve us from our obligations to the insurers and reinsurers from whom we assume business. The failure of retrocessionaires to honor their obligations could result in losses to us.
For 2002, St. Paul Re purchased an accident year aggregate excess-of-loss retrocession agreement which provides up to $200 million of coverage if the accident year loss ratio exceeds a specified loss ratio attachment point for the 2002 accident year. This retrocessional agreement will cover risks retained by St. Paul Re and risks underwritten by Platinum with respect to the 2002 accident year. The attachment point is net of inuring retrocessions and includes adjustable premium provisions that effectively cause the Company to pay to the retrocessionaire, on a pre-tax income basis, up to 50% of such ceded losses, through additional premiums.
Platinum Bermuda expects to reinsure up to approximately 70% of each of Platinum US's and Platinum UK's reinsurance written by each of them after the Public Offering excluding business subject to the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements. St. Paul will write reinsurance in the U.K. and reinsure it 100% to us for a period of one year following the completion of the Public Offering.
Claims Administration
With respect to the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts, claims will be managed by St. Paul's claims department, with our supervision and management, pursuant to a Run-off Services
81
Agreement described below under "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Run-off Services Agreements". We will reimburse St. Paul for costs of managing these claims. Platinum may, at its discretion and expense, take over administration of any specific claims. Our own claims department will administer claims arising under our contracts other than the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts.
The responsibilities of the claims department will include reviewing initial loss reports, monitoring claims handling activities of clients, requesting additional information where appropriate, establishing initial case reserves and approving payment of individual claims. We expect that authority for payment and establishing reserves will always be established in levels, depending upon rank and experience.
In addition to managing reported claims and conferring with ceding companies on claims matters, we expect that the claims department will conduct periodic audits of specific claims and the overall claims procedures of our clients at the offices of ceding companies. We expect to rely on the ability to monitor effectively the claims handling and claims reserving practices of ceding companies in order to establish the proper reinsurance premium for reinsurance agreements and to establish proper loss reserves. Moreover, prior to accepting certain risks, we expect that our underwriters will often request that the claims department conduct pre-underwriting claims audits of prospective ceding companies. Through these audits, we intend to attempt to evaluate the ceding company's claims-handling practices, including the organization of their claims department, their fact-finding and investigation techniques, their loss notifications, the adequacy of their reserves, their negotiation and settlement practices and their adherence to claims-handling guidelines. Following these audits, we expect that the claims department will provide feedback to the ceding company, including an assessment of the claims operation and, if appropriate, recommendations regarding procedures, processing and personnel.
Reserves
We are required by applicable insurance laws and regulations and U.S. GAAP to establish reserves for payment of losses and loss adjustment expenses that will arise from our products. These reserves will be balance sheet liabilities representing estimates of future amounts required to pay losses and loss adjustment expenses for insured claims which have occurred at or before the balance sheet date, whether already known to us or not yet reported. Significant periods of time can elapse between the occurrence of an insured claim, its reporting by the insured to the primary insurance company and from the insurance company to its reinsurance company. Loss reserves fall into two categories: reserves for reported losses and loss adjustment expenses and reserves for incurred but not reported, or IBNR, losses and loss adjustment expenses.
Upon receipt of a notice of claim from a ceding company, we will establish a case reserve for the estimated amount of the ultimate settlement. Case reserves are usually based upon the amount of reserves reported by the primary insurance company and may subsequently be supplemented or reduced as deemed necessary by our claims department. We will also establish reserves for loss amounts incurred but not yet reported, including expected development of reported claims. These IBNR reserves will include estimated legal and other loss adjustment expenses. We will calculate IBNR reserves by using generally accepted actuarial techniques. We will utilize actuarial tools that rely on historical and pricing information and statistical models as well as our pricing analyses. We will revise these reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses as additional information becomes available and as claims are reported and paid.
Loss reserves will represent our estimates, at a given point in time, of the ultimate settlement and administration costs of claims incurred, and it is possible that the ultimate liability may exceed or be less than such estimates. Such estimates will not be precise because, among other things,
82
they are based on predictions of future developments and estimates of future trends in claim severity and frequency and other variable factors such as inflation and currency exchange rates. During the claim settlement period, it will often become necessary to refine and adjust the estimates of liability on a claim either upward or downward, and any such adjustment would affect our results of operations in the period when the adjustment is determined. Even after such adjustments, ultimate liability may materially exceed or be less than the revised estimates. In contrast to casualty losses, which frequently can be determined only through lengthy, unpredictable litigation, property losses tend to be reported promptly and settled within a shorter period of time.
Our estimates of reserves from reported and unreported losses and related reinsurance recoverable assets will be reviewed and updated. Adjustments resulting from changes in our estimates will be reflected in current income. The analysis relies upon the basic assumption that past experience, adjusted for the effect of current developments and likely trends, is an appropriate basis to estimate our current loss and loss adjustment expense liabilities. Because estimation of loss reserves is an inherently uncertain process, quantitative techniques frequently have to be supplemented by professional and managerial judgment. In addition, trends that have affected development of reserves in the past may not necessarily occur or affect reserve development to the same degree in the future.
The uncertainty inherent in loss estimation is particularly pronounced for long-tail lines such as umbrella, general and professional liability and automobile liability, where information, such as required medical treatment and costs for bodily injury claims, will only emerge over time. In the overall reserve setting process, provisions for economic inflation and changes in the social and legal environment are considered. The uncertainty inherent in the reserving process for primary insurance companies is even greater for the reinsurer. This is because of, but not limited to, the time lag inherent in reporting information from the insurer to the reinsurer and differing reserving practices among ceding companies. As a result, actual losses and loss adjustment expenses may deviate, perhaps materially, from expected ultimate costs reflected in our current reserves.
In setting reserves, we expect to utilize the same integrated, multi-disciplinary approach that we expect to use to establish our reinsurance prices. We expect that, after an initial analysis by members of our actuarial staff, preliminary results will be shared with appropriate underwriters, pricing actuaries, claims and finance professionals and, as appropriate, senior management. Final actuarial recommendations will incorporate feedback from these professionals. To the extent reserves prove to be insufficient to cover actual losses and loss adjustment expenses after taking into account available retrocessional coverage, we would have to augment such reserves and incur a charge to earnings in the period during which such reserves are augmented that could be material.
Under U.S. GAAP, we will not be permitted to establish loss reserves until the occurrence of an event which may give rise to a loss. Once such an event occurs, we will establish reserves based upon estimates of total losses incurred by the ceding insurers as a result of the event and our estimate of the portion of such loss we have reinsured. As a result, only loss reserves applicable to losses incurred up to the reporting date may be set aside, with no allowance for the provision of a contingency reserve to account for expected future losses. Losses arising from future events will be estimated and recognized at the time the loss is incurred and could be substantial.
Generally, reserves are established without regard to whether we may subsequently contest the loss. We expect our policy to be to establish reserves for reported losses based upon reports received from ceding companies, supplemented by our reserve estimates.
83
Investments
General Guidelines. We intend to develop investment guidelines for the management of our investment portfolio by third party investment managers. Although these guidelines are expected to stress diversification of risk, preservation of capital and market liquidity, investments will be subject to market-wide risks and fluctuations, as well as risks inherent in particular securities. The primary objective of the portfolio, to be set forth in the guidelines, will be to maximize investment returns consistent with appropriate safety, diversification, tax and regulatory considerations and to provide sufficient liquidity to enable us to meet our obligations on a timely basis. These guidelines will be subject to oversight and change at the discretion of our Board of Directors.
Our investment strategy will take into consideration the risks inherent in property catastrophe and other reinsurance. For this reason management expects that our investment policy will be conservative with a strong emphasis on high quality, fixed maturity investments. We expect that the guidelines will include limitations with respect to the maximum effective maturity. The duration of the portfolio will vary according to decisions taken by the investment advisors on the outlook for interest rate movements, subject to limitations set forth in the guidelines. The duration limitations set forth in the guidelines are expected to take into consideration the estimated duration of the reinsurance liabilities in the business.
Initially, we expect to invest only in investment grade securities. We do not currently intend to invest any of our portfolio in equity securities, although we may do so in the future. We do not intend to invest in real estate or other classes of alternative investments. We expect that our investment guidelines will contain restrictions and limitations designed to provide diversification across our portfolio, including limitations on the portion of the portfolio that may be invested in the securities of any single issue or issuer, with the exception of sovereign governments or agencies, including supernational agencies, with prescribed minimum ratings. Our investment managers may be instructed to invest some of the investment portfolio in currencies other than U.S. dollars based upon the business we anticipate writing, the exposures and loss reserves on our books, or regulatory requirements. We expect that our investment guidelines will provide that financial futures and options and foreign exchange contracts may not be used in a speculative manner but may be used, subject to certain numerical restrictions set by the Board of Directors, only as part of a defensive strategy to protect the market value of investments.
Insurance company investments must comply with applicable laws and regulations which prescribe the kind, quality and concentration of investments. In general, these laws and regulations permit investments, within specified limits and subject to some qualifications, in federal, state and municipal obligations, corporate bonds, preferred and common equity securities, mortgage loans, real estate and some other investments.
84
Investment Agreements. We intend to enter into several investment management agreements, effective upon completion of the Public Offering, with a nationally recognized third party investment manager that will provide specific investment advisory services to Platinum Holdings, Platinum US, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda. We expect that such investment manager will be experienced in managing assets for insurance and reinsurance companies. We expect that these agreements will have terms consistent with market standards.
Valuation. We expect to classify our entire investment portfolio as available-for-sale. All of our fixed income securities will be carried at their estimated fair value, with the difference between amortized cost and the fair value, net of any deferred taxes, to be charged or credited directly to our shareholders' equity. We will calculate the fair value based on quoted market prices, as reported by reputable market data providers such as Bloomberg, Reuters or Telerate. If quoted market prices are not available, fair values will be estimated either based on values obtained from independent pricing services or on a cash flow estimate. Cash equivalents and short-term investments will be carried at cost, which we expect will approximate fair value. Realized gains and losses on disposal of investments will be determined based upon specific identification of the cost of investments sold and will be recorded in our statements of operations. We will monitor the unrealized difference between the cost and the estimated fair value of the securities in our portfolio. If the value of any of our investments declines in a manner that we believe is other than temporary, we will write down that investment and will record a realized loss on our statement of operations.
Competition
The property and casualty reinsurance industry is highly competitive and, except for regulatory considerations, there are relatively few barriers to entry. We will compete with insurers and reinsurers worldwide, many of which have greater financial, marketing and management resources than ours. Some of our competitors are large financial institutions who have reinsurance divisions, while others are specialty reinsurance companies. Financial institutions have also created alternative capital market products that compete with reinsurance products, such as reinsurance securitization. Our principal competitors vary by type of business. Bermuda-based reinsurers are significant competitors on property catastrophe business. Lloyd's of London syndicates are significant competitors on marine business. On international business, the large European reinsurers are significant competitors. Large U.S. direct reinsurers, as well as lead U.S.-based broker market reinsurers, are significant competitors on U.S. casualty business. On an overall basis, we expect that our most significant competitors will be General Re, Munich Re, Swiss Re, Employers Re, Lloyd's of London, XL Capital, ACE, Transatlantic Holdings, Converium Holding, Everest Re, and Renaissance Re.
Recently, several individuals and companies in the reinsurance industry have established new, well-capitalized Bermuda-based reinsurers to benefit from improved market conditions following the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack, and several existing competitors have raised additional capital or have announced plans to do so. Many of the reinsurers who have entered the reinsurance markets have or could have more capital than we will have. In addition, there may be established companies or new companies of which we are not aware that may be planning to commit capital to this market. Competition in the types of reinsurance business that we underwrite is based on many factors, including premium charges and other terms and conditions offered, services provided, ratings assigned by independent rating agencies, speed of claims payment, claims experience, perceived financial strength and experience and reputation of the reinsurer in the line of reinsurance to be written. The full effect of this additional capital on the reinsurance market and on the terms and conditions of the reinsurance contracts of the types we expect to write may not be known for some time.
The reinsurance industry is highly concentrated. We estimate that, based on 2000 net premiums written, the four largest reinsurers currently have a market share of approximately 49%,
85
and the next ten largest property and casualty reinsurers currently have a market share of approximately 30%. Reinsurance companies have sought in recent years to expand their existing markets, obtain critical mass in new markets, including life reinsurance, and further diversify risk. At the same time, consolidation in the worldwide insurance industry has created a smaller group of large ceding companies that are retaining an increasing proportion of their business.
We are aware of a number of initiatives by traditional as well as new capital market participants to produce alternative products (such as reinsurance securitizations, catastrophe bonds and various derivatives such as swaps) that may compete with certain types of reinsurance, such as property catastrophe. Over time, these numerous initiatives could significantly affect supply, pricing and competition in our industry.
Ratings
Best's is generally considered to be a significant rating agency with respect to the evaluation of insurance and reinsurance companies. Best's ratings are based on a quantitative evaluation of performance with respect to profitability, leverage and liquidity and a qualitative evaluation of spread of risk, reinsurance program, investments, reserves and management. Insurance ratings are used by insurers and reinsurance intermediaries as an important means of assessing the financial strength and quality of reinsurers. In addition, a ceding company's own rating may be adversely affected by the lack of a rating of its reinsurer. Therefore, the lack of a rating may dissuade a ceding company from reinsuring with us and may influence a ceding company to reinsure with a competitor of ours that has an insurance rating.
Our management has met with Best's, which has advised us that it expects to assign an initial financial strength rating of "A" (Excellent) to our operating subsidiaries upon the completion of the Public Offering and the receipt of the offering proceeds in line with representations we made to Best's. In addition, the rating assignment is contingent upon the funding of our operating subsidiaries to the levels indicated by our management as well as the execution of all pertinent transactions as detailed by this prospectus. The rating assignment further contemplates the initiation of certain capital support agreements between Platinum Holdings and its operating subsidiaries.
Employees
Currently, we employ Jerome T. Fadden, our President and Chief Executive Officer. None of our employees is expected to be subject to collective bargaining agreements. We expect to offer employment to approximately 180 employees of St. Paul Re from a total of 398 employees who were employed by St. Paul Re as of January 1, 2001.
We will seek work permits for Jerome T. Fadden and other employees of Platinum Holdings, as well as all employees of Platinum Bermuda who are not Bermuda citizens, from Bermuda authorities on a temporary basis prior to the completion of the Public Offering and on a long-term basis thereafter. Permits obtained will expire at various times over the next several years. We have no reason to believe that these permits would not be extended upon request at their respective expirations. However, the Bermuda government recently announced a new policy that places a six-year term limit on individuals with work permits, subject to certain exceptions for key employees.
Subsidiaries
Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda are wholly owned operating subsidiaries of Platinum Holdings. Platinum UK was formed as a U.K. company on April 10, 2002, and Platinum Bermuda was formed as a Bermuda company on May 9, 2002. Platinum US was formed as a Maryland company in 1995 and is a wholly owned subsidiary of St. Paul. We own Platinum UK and, upon completion of the Public Offering, will own Platinum US through Platinum Ireland, our wholly owned
86
intermediate holding subsidiary. Platinum Ireland was formed as an Irish company on May 3, 2002. Platinum Holdings may enter into a capital support agreement for the benefit of one or more of our operating company subsidiaries, the effect of which is to assure that, at all times, those subsidiaries will have adequate capital and surplus.
Our Facilities
Platinum Holdings' registered office is located at Clarendon House, 2 Church Street, Hamilton HM 11, Bermuda. We expect to enter into a lease agreement in Bermuda for approximately 5,000 to 10,000 square feet of office space. We will sublet a portion of the office space at that location to Platinum Bermuda for use as its principal offices.
The principal offices of Platinum US will be located at 195 Broadway, New York, New York, where Platinum US will sub-lease from St. Paul approximately 50,000 square feet of office space. The term of the lease ends January 1, 2003. We are currently exploring options to replace the office space at 195 Broadway with a new facility.
The principal offices of Platinum UK will be located at 52 Lime Street, London, where St. Paul will assign to Platinum UK several leases with respect to approximately 9,000 square feet of office space. The terms of the several leases will end between 2004 and 2009, respectively.
Platinum US will enter into sub-lease agreements with St. Paul with respect to approximately 4,000 square feet of office space in Chicago, 6,300 square feet of office space in Miami and 600 square feet in Tokyo. The terms of these leases will end in 2005, 2006 and 2003 respectively.
Legal Proceedings
In the normal course of business, we may become involved in various claims and legal proceedings. We are not currently aware of any pending or threatened material litigation.
Regulation
General
The business of reinsurance is regulated in most countries, although the degree and type of regulation varies significantly from one jurisdiction to another. Reinsurers are generally subject to less direct regulation than primary insurers. In Bermuda, we operate under relatively less intensive regulatory regimes. However, in the United States and in the United Kingdom licensed reinsurers must comply with financial supervision standards comparable to those governing primary insurers. Accordingly, Platinum US and Platinum UK are subject to extensive regulation under applicable statutes. In the United States, those statutes delegate regulatory, supervisory and administrative powers to state insurance commissioners.
Potential Legislative and Industry Changes
We are aware of a number of new, proposed or potential legislative or industry changes that may impact upon the worldwide demand for reinsurance.
- •
- Following the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack, various proposed legislation was introduced in the U.S. Congress designed to ensure the availability of insurance coverage for terrorist acts. Legislation has been adopted in the U.S. House of Representatives designed, among other things, to provide federal government loans over a short-term period to commercial insurers and reinsurers for funding losses arising from terrorist acts against U.S. properties, which loans would be repaid through industry assessments and, if losses exceed a threshold, policyholder assessments. Alternative proposed legislation has been introduced in the U.S. Senate, including legislation providing for the direct payment by the U.S. government for losses arising from terrorist acts to the insureds of insurers who continue to write such coverage, legislation which would provide direct government assistance to
87
- •
- Over the last few years capital markets participants, including exchanges and financial intermediaries, have developed financial products such as risk securitizations, intended to compete with traditional reinsurance. We are also aware of many potential initiatives by capital market participants to produce additional alternative products that may compete with the existing catastrophe reinsurance markets.
insurers and legislation which would require insurers to write coverage for terrorist acts and establish a mandatory reinsurance pool. This legislation may also provide insurance and reinsurance capacity in the markets and to the customers we expect to target and regulate the terms of insurance and reinsurance capacity and reinsurance policies in a manner which could materially adversely affect us, directly or indirectly, by requiring coverage for terrorist acts to be offered by insurers and/or reinsurers, benefiting our competitors, reducing the demand for reinsurance or benefiting insurers as compared to reinsurers such as us, providing sources of liquidity to U.S.-based companies, or disproportionately benefiting U.S. or other foreign countries' companies over Bermuda-based companies such as ourselves. Legislation may be introduced in other jurisdictions.
We are unable to predict the extent to which the foregoing new, proposed or potential initiatives may affect the demand for our products or the risks which may be available for us to consider underwriting.
Bermuda
As a holding company, Platinum Holdings is not subject to Bermuda insurance regulations.
The Insurance Act, which regulates the insurance business of Platinum Bermuda, provides that no person may carry on any insurance business in or from within Bermuda unless registered as an insurer under the Insurance Act by the Bermuda Monetary Authority, which is responsible for the day-to-day supervision of insurers. Under the Insurance Act, insurance business includes reinsurance business. The Authority, in deciding whether to grant registration, has broad discretion to act as the Authority thinks fit in the public interest. The Authority is required by the Insurance Act to determine whether the applicant is a fit and proper body to be engaged in the insurance business and, in particular, whether it has, or has available to it, adequate knowledge and expertise. The registration of an applicant as an insurer is subject to its complying with the terms of its registration and such other conditions as the Authority may impose from time to time.
An Insurance Advisory Committee appointed by the Bermuda Minister of Finance advises the Authority on matters connected with the discharge of the Authority's functions and sub-committees thereof supervise and review the law and practice of insurance in Bermuda, including reviews of accounting and administrative procedures. The day-to-day supervision of insurers is the responsibility of the Bermuda Registrar of Companies.
The Insurance Act imposes on Bermuda insurance companies solvency and liquidity standards and auditing and reporting requirements and grants to the Authority powers to supervise, investigate and intervene in the affairs of insurance companies. Certain significant aspects of the Bermuda insurance regulatory framework are set forth below.
Classification of Insurers. The Insurance Act distinguishes between insurers carrying on long-term business and insurers carrying on general business. There are four classifications of insurers carrying on general business with Class 4 insurers subject to the strictest regulation. Platinum Bermuda will be registered as a Class 4 insurer and is regulated as such under the Insurance Act.
Cancellation of Insurer's Registration. An insurer's registration may be canceled by the Authority on certain grounds specified in the Insurance Act, including failure of the insurer to
88
comply with its obligations under the Insurance Act or if, in the opinion of the Authority, the insurer has not been carrying on business in accordance with sound insurance principles.
Principal Representative. An insurer is required to maintain a principal office in Bermuda and to appoint and maintain a principal representative in Bermuda. For the purpose of the Insurance Act, the principal office of Platinum Bermuda is at our principal executive offices in Bermuda, and Platinum Bermuda's principal representative will be our President and Chief Executive Officer. Without a reason acceptable to the Authority, an insurer may not terminate the appointment of its principal representative, and the principal representative may not cease to act as such, unless 30 days' notice in writing to the Authority is given of the intention to do so. It is the duty of the principal representative, within 30 days of reaching the view that there is a likelihood of the insurer for which the principal representative acts becoming insolvent or that a reportable "event" has, to the principal representative's knowledge, occurred or is believed to have occurred, to make a report in writing to the Authority setting out all the particulars of the case that are available to the principal representative. Examples of such a reportable "event" include failure by the insurer to comply substantially with a condition imposed upon the insurer by the Authority relating to a solvency margin or liquidity or other ratio.
Independent Approved Auditor. Every registered insurer must appoint an independent auditor who will annually audit and report on the statutory financial statements and the statutory financial return of the insurer, both of which, in the case of Platinum Bermuda, are required to be filed annually with the Authority. The independent auditor of Platinum Bermuda must be approved by the Authority and may be the same person or firm which audits Platinum Bermuda's financial statements and reports for presentation to its shareholders. Platinum Bermuda's independent auditor will initially be KPMG LLP.
Loss Reserve Specialist. As a registered Class 4 insurer, Platinum Bermuda will be required to submit an opinion of its approved loss reserve specialist with its statutory financial return in respect of its loss and loss adjustment expense provisions. The loss reserve specialist, who will normally be a qualified casualty actuary, must be approved by the Authority.
Statutory Financial Statements. An insurer must prepare annual statutory financial statements. The Insurance Act prescribes rules for the preparation and substance of such statutory financial statements (which include, in statutory form, a balance sheet, an income statement, a statement of capital and surplus and notes thereto). The insurer is required to give detailed information and analyses regarding premiums, claims, reinsurance and investments. The statutory financial statements are not prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP and are distinct from the financial statements prepared for presentation to the insurer's shareholders under the Companies Act, which financial statements will be prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP. Platinum Bermuda, as a general business insurer, will be required to submit the annual statutory financial statements as part of the annual statutory financial return. The statutory financial statements and the statutory financial return do not form part of the public records maintained by the Authority.
Annual Statutory Financial Return. Platinum Bermuda is required to file with the Authority a statutory financial return no later than four months after its financial year end (unless specifically extended). The statutory financial return for an insurer includes, among other matters, a report of the approved independent auditor on the statutory financial statements of such insurer, solvency certificates, the statutory financial statements themselves, the opinion of the loss reserve specialist and a schedule of reinsurance ceded. The solvency certificates must be signed by the principal representative and at least two directors of the insurer who are required to certify, among other matters, whether the minimum solvency margin has been met and whether the insurer complied with the conditions attached to its certificate of registration. The independent approved auditor is required to state whether in its opinion it was reasonable for the directors to so certify. Where an
89
insurer's accounts have been audited for any purpose other than compliance with the Insurance Act, a statement to that effect must be filed with the statutory financial return.
Minimum Solvency Margin and Restrictions on Dividends and Distributions. Under the Insurance Act, the value of the general business assets of a Class 4 insurer, such as Platinum Bermuda, must exceed the amount of its general business liabilities by an amount greater than the prescribed minimum solvency margin. Platinum Bermuda:
- (1)
- is required, with respect to its general business, to maintain a minimum solvency margin equal to the greatest of:
- (A)
- $100,000,000;
- (B)
- 50% of net premiums written (being gross premiums written less any premiums ceded by Platinum Bermuda, but Platinum Bermuda may not deduct more than 25% of gross premiums when computing net premiums written); and
- (C)
- 15% of loss and other insurance reserves;
- (2)
- is prohibited from declaring or paying any dividends during any financial year if it is in breach of its minimum solvency margin or minimum liquidity ratio or if the declaration or payment of such dividends would cause it to fail to meet such margin or ratio (and if it has failed to meet its minimum solvency margin or minimum liquidity ratio on the last day of any financial year, Platinum Bermuda is prohibited, without the approval of the Authority, from declaring or paying any dividends during the next financial year);
- (3)
- is prohibited from declaring or paying in any financial year dividends of more than 25% of its total statutory capital and surplus (as shown on its previous financial year's statutory balance sheet) unless it files with the Authority (at least 7 days before payment of such dividends) an affidavit stating that it will continue to meet the required margins;
- (4)
- is prohibited, without the approval of the Authority, from reducing by 15% or more its total statutory capital as set out in its previous year's financial statements, and any application for such approval must include an affidavit stating that it will continue to meet the required margins; and
- (5)
- is required, at any time it fails to meet its solvency margin, within 30 days (45 days where total statutory capital and surplus falls to $75 million or less) after becoming aware of that failure or having reason to believe that such failure has occurred, to file with the Authority a written report containing certain information.
Additionally, under the Companies Act, Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda may declare or pay a dividend only if Platinum Holdings or Platinum Bermuda, as the case may be, has no reasonable grounds for believing that it is, or would after the payment be, unable to pay its liabilities as they become due, or that the realizable value of its assets would thereby be less than the aggregate of its liabilities and its issued share capital and share premium accounts.
Minimum Liquidity Ratio. The Insurance Act provides a minimum liquidity ratio for general business insurers. An insurer engaged in general business is required to maintain the value of its relevant assets at not less than 75% of the amount of its relevant liabilities. Relevant assets include cash and time deposits, quoted investments, unquoted bonds and debentures, first liens on real estate, investment income due and accrued, accounts and premiums receivable and reinsurance balances receivable. There are certain categories of assets which, unless specifically permitted by the Authority, do not automatically qualify as relevant assets, such as unquoted equity securities, investments in and advances to affiliates and real estate and collateral loans. The relevant liabilities are total general business insurance reserves and total other liabilities less deferred income tax and sundry liabilities (by interpretation, those not specifically defined).
90
Supervision, Investigation and Intervention. The Authority may appoint an inspector with extensive powers to investigate the affairs of an insurer if the Authority believes that an investigation is required in the interest of the insurer's policyholders or persons who may become policyholders. In order to verify or supplement information otherwise provided to the Authority, the Authority may direct an insurer to produce documents or information relating to matters connected with the insurer's business.
If it appears to the Authority that there is a risk of the insurer becoming insolvent, or that it is in breach of the Insurance Act or any conditions imposed upon its registration, the Authority may, among other things, direct the insurer (1) not to take on any new insurance business, (2) not to vary any insurance contract if the effect would be to increase the insurer's liabilities, (3) not to make certain investments, (4) to realize certain investments, (5) to maintain in, or transfer to the custody of, a specified bank, certain assets, (6) not to declare or pay any dividends or other distributions or to restrict the making of such payments and/or (7) to limit its premium income.
Disclosure of Information. In addition to powers under the Insurance Act to investigate the affairs of an insurer, the Authority may require certain information from an insurer (or certain other persons) to be produced to it. Further, the Authority has been given powers to assist other regulatory authorities, including foreign insurance regulatory authorities, with their investigations involving insurance and reinsurance companies in Bermuda but subject to restrictions. For example, the Authority must be satisfied that the assistance being requested is in connection with the discharge of regulatory responsibilities of the foreign regulatory authority. Further, the Supervisor must consider whether to cooperate is in the public interest. The grounds for disclosure are limited and the Insurance Act provides sanctions for breach of the statutory duty of confidentiality.
Certain Other Considerations. Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda will each also need to comply with the provisions of the Companies Act regulating the payment of dividends and making of distributions from contributed surplus. A company is prohibited from declaring or paying a dividend, or making a distribution out of contributed surplus, if there are reasonable grounds for believing that: (a) the company is, or would after the payment be, unable to pay its liabilities as they become due, or (b) the realizable value of the company's assets would thereby be less than the aggregate of its liabilities and its issued share capital and share premium accounts.
Although Platinum Bermuda is incorporated in Bermuda, it is classified as a non-resident of Bermuda for exchange control purposes by the Authority. Pursuant to its non-resident status, Platinum Bermuda may hold any currency other than Bermuda Dollars and convert that currency into any other currency (other than Bermuda Dollars) without restriction.
As "exempted" companies, Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda may not, without the express authorization of the Bermuda legislature or under a license granted by the Minister of Finance, participate in certain business transactions, including: (1) the acquisition or holding of land in Bermuda (except that held by way of lease or tenancy agreement which is required for its business and held for a term not exceeding 50 years, or which is used to provide accommodation or recreational facilities for its officers and employees and held with the consent of the Bermuda Minister of Finance, for a term not exceeding 21 years); (2) the taking of mortgages on land in Bermuda in excess of $50,000; or (3) the carrying on of business of any kind for which it is not licensed in Bermuda, except in certain limited circumstances such as doing business with another exempted undertaking in furtherance of our business or Platinum Bermuda's business (as the case may be) carried on outside Bermuda. Platinum Bermuda will be a licensed reinsurer in Bermuda, and so may carry on activities in Bermuda that are related to and in support of its reinsurance business.
91
The Bermuda government actively encourages foreign investment in "exempted" entities like Platinum Holdings that are based in Bermuda, but do not operate in competition with local businesses. As well as having no restrictions on the degree of foreign ownership, Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda are not currently subject to taxes on income or dividends or to any foreign exchange controls in Bermuda. In addition, there currently is no capital gains tax in Bermuda.
Under Bermuda law, non-Bermudians (other than spouses of Bermudians) may not engage in any gainful occupation in Bermuda without the specific permission of the appropriate governmental authority. Such permission may be granted or extended upon showing that, after proper public advertisement, no Bermudian (or spouse of a Bermudian) is available who meets the minimum standards for the advertised position. None of our executive officers is a Bermudian, and all such officers will be working in Bermuda under work permits. The Bermuda government recently announced a new policy that places a six-year term limit on individuals with work permits, subject to certain exceptions for key employees.
U.S. Regulation
Platinum US is organized and domiciled in the State of Maryland and licensed, authorized or accredited to write reinsurance in 21 states of the United States and is seeking licenses in eleven additional states. State insurance laws regulate many aspects of its reinsurance business and state insurance departments in the licensure states will supervise its insurance operations. Its principal insurance regulatory authority will be the Maryland Insurance Administration.
U.S. Insurance Holding Company Regulation of Platinum Holdings
As the indirect parent of Platinum US, Platinum Holdings will be subject to the insurance holding company laws of Maryland, where Platinum US is organized and domiciled. This law generally requires the insurance holding company and each insurance company directly or indirectly owned by the holding company to register with the insurance department of the state of Maryland in the insurance company's state of domicile and to furnish annually financial and other information about the operations of companies within the holding company system. Generally, all transactions affecting the insurers in the holding company system, including sales, loans, reinsurance agreements, service agreements and dividend payments, must be fair and, if material or of a specified category, require prior notice and approval or non-disapproval by the state's insurance department.
The insurance law of Maryland prevents any person from acquiring control of Platinum Holdings or of Platinum US unless that person has filed a notification with specified information with the Maryland Insurance Commissioner and has obtained his prior approval. Under the Maryland statute, acquiring 10% or more of the voting stock of an insurance company or its parent company is presumptively considered a change of control, although such presumption may be rebutted. Accordingly, any person who acquires, directly or indirectly, 10% or more of the voting securities of Platinum Holdings without the prior approval of the Maryland Insurance Commissioner will be in violation of this law and may be subject to injunctive action requiring the disposition or seizure of those securities by the Maryland Insurance Commissioner or prohibiting the voting of those securities and to other actions determined by the Maryland Insurance Commissioner. In addition, many U.S. state insurance laws require prior notification of state insurance departments of a change in control of a non-domiciliary insurance company doing business in that state. While these pre- notification statutes do not authorize the state insurance departments to disapprove the change in control, they authorize regulatory action in the affected state if particular conditions exist such as undue market concentration. Any future transactions that would constitute a change in control of Platinum Holdings may require prior notification in those states that have adopted pre-acquisition notification laws.
92
These laws may discourage potential acquisition proposals and may delay, deter or prevent a change of control of Platinum Holdings, including through transactions, and in particular unsolicited transactions, that some or all of the shareholders of Platinum Holdings might consider to be desirable.
State Insurance Regulation of Platinum US
The terms and conditions of reinsurance agreements generally are not subject to regulation by any U.S. state insurance department with respect to rates or policy terms. This contrasts with primary insurance agreements, the rates and policy terms of which are generally closely regulated by state insurance departments. As a practical matter, however, the rates charged by primary insurers do have an effect on the rates that can be charged by reinsurers.
State insurance authorities have broad administrative powers with respect to various aspects of the reinsurance business, including: licensing to transact business, admittance of assets to statutory surplus, regulating unfair trade and claims practices, establishing reserve requirements and solvency standards, and regulating investments and dividends. State insurance laws and regulations require Platinum US to file financial statements with insurance departments everywhere it is licensed or authorized to do or accredited to do business, and the operations of Platinum US are subject to examination by those departments at any time. Platinum US will prepare statutory financial statements in accordance with accounting practices and procedures prescribed or permitted by these departments. State insurance departments conduct periodic examinations of the books and records, financial reporting, policy filings and market conduct of insurance companies domiciled in their states, generally once every three to five years. Examinations are generally carried out in cooperation with the insurance departments of other states under guidelines promulgated by the NAIC.
Under Maryland insurance law, Platinum US may pay dividends out of surplus, provided it must give the Maryland Insurance Commissioner at least thirty days' prior notice before paying an "extraordinary dividend" or making an "extraordinary distribution". Extraordinary dividends and extraordinary distributions are dividends or distributions which, together with any other dividends and distributions paid during the immediately preceding twelve-month period, would exceed the lesser of
- (1)
- ten percent of Platinum US's statutory policyholders' surplus (as determined under statutory accounting principles) as of December 31 of the prior year; and
- (2)
- Platinum US's net investment income excluding realized capital gains (as determined under statutory accounting principles) for the twelve-month period ending on December 31 of the prior year, plus any amounts of net investment income (excluding realized capital gains) in the three preceding years which have not been distributed.
These statutory limitations are subject to change. Platinum US may not pay extraordinary dividends or make extraordinary distributions until either the thirty-day notice period has expired (without the Maryland Insurance Commissioner disapproving such payment) or the Maryland Insurance Commissioner has approved the payment within that period. Extraordinary dividends and extraordinary distributions may only be paid out of earned surplus.
In addition, Platinum US must give ten days' prior notice to the Maryland Insurance Commissioner of its intention to pay any dividend or make any distribution other than an extraordinary dividend or extraordinary distribution. The Maryland Insurance Commissioner has the right to prevent payment of such a dividend or such a distribution if he determines, in his discretion, that after the payment thereof, Platinum US's policyholders' surplus would be inadequate or could cause Platinum US to be in a hazardous financial condition.
93
In order to enhance the regulation of insurers' solvency, the NAIC adopted a model law to implement risk-based capital ("RBC") requirements for life, health, and property and casualty insurance companies. Maryland has adopted the NAIC's model law. The RBC calculation, which regulators use to assess the sufficiency of an insurer's capital, measures the risk characteristics of a company's assets, liabilities and certain off-balance sheet items. RBC is calculated by applying factors to various asset, premium and liability items. Within a given risk category, these factors are higher for those items with greater underlying risk and lower for items with lower underlying risk. Insurers that have less statutory capital than the RBC calculation requires are considered to have inadequate capital and are subject to varying degrees of regulatory action depending upon the level of capital inadequacy. The RBC ratios of Platinum US are intended to be well above the ranges that would require any regulatory or corrective action.
The NAIC assists state insurance supervisory officials in achieving insurance regulatory objectives, including the maintenance and improvement of state regulation. From time to time various regulatory and legislative changes have been proposed in the insurance industry, some of which could have an effect on reinsurers. The NAIC has instituted its Financial Regulatory Accreditation Standards Program ("FRASP") in response to federal initiatives to regulate the business of insurance. FRASP provides a set of standards designed to establish effective state regulation of the financial condition of insurance companies. Under FRASP, a state must adopt certain laws and regulations, institute required regulatory practices and procedures, and have adequate insurance department personnel to enforce such items in order to become an "accredited" state. The NAIC determines whether individual states should be accredited, and each state's accreditation is determined by the NAIC periodically. If a state is not accredited or loses its accreditation, accredited states are not able to accept certain financial examination reports of insurers prepared solely by the regulatory agency in such unaccredited state. The state of Maryland is currently accredited under FRASP.
Operations of Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda
Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda are not admitted to do business in the U.S. However, the insurance laws of each state of the United States and of many other countries regulate the sale of insurance and reinsurance within their jurisdictions by non-domestic insurers and reinsurers such as Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda, which are not admitted to do business within such jurisdictions. Such sale of insurance or reinsurance within a jurisdiction where the insurer is not admitted to do business is generally prohibited. We do not intend that Platinum Bermuda maintain an office or solicit, advertise, settle claims or conduct other insurance activities in any jurisdiction other than Bermuda—or, in the case of Platinum UK, London—where the conduct of such activities would require Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda to be so admitted.
In addition to the regulatory requirements imposed by the jurisdictions in which they are licensed, reinsurers' business operations are affected by regulatory requirements in various states of the United States governing "credit for reinsurance" which are imposed on their ceding companies. In general, a ceding company which obtains reinsurance from a reinsurer that is licensed, accredited or approved by the jurisdiction or state in which the reinsurer files statutory financial statements is permitted to reflect in its statutory financial statements a credit in an aggregate amount equal to the liability for unearned premiums (which are that portion of premiums written which applies to the unexpired portion of the policy period) and loss reserves and loss expense reserves ceded to the reinsurer. Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda are not licensed, accredited or approved in any state in the U.S. The great majority of states, however, permit a credit to statutory surplus resulting from reinsurance obtained from a non-licensed or non-accredited reinsurer to be offset to the extent that the reinsurer provides a letter of credit or other acceptable security arrangement. A few states do not allow credit for reinsurance ceded to non-licensed
94
reinsurers except in certain limited circumstances and others impose additional requirements that make it difficult to become accredited. Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda may be subject to reinsurance premium excise taxes in the US (1%) and certain other jurisdictions.
We do not believe that Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda are in violation of insurance laws of any jurisdiction in the U.S. There can be no assurance, however, that inquiries or challenges to Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's reinsurance activities will not be raised in the future.
U.K. Regulation
General
The framework for supervision of insurance companies in the U.K. is largely formed by EU Directives which are required to be implemented in member states through national legislation. Directives aim to harmonize insurance regulation and supervision throughout the EU by laying down minimum standards in key areas, and requiring member states to give mutual recognition to each other's standards of prudential supervision.
On December 1, 2001, the FSA assumed its full powers and responsibilities under the FSMA. The FSA is now the single statutory regulator responsible for regulating deposit taking, insurance, investment and most other financial services business. It is a criminal offense for any person to carry on a regulated activity in the U.K. unless that person is authorized by the FSA or falls under an exemption.
Insurance business (which includes reinsurance business) is authorized and supervised by the FSA. Insurance business in the U.K. is divided between two main categories: long-term insurance (which is primarily investment-related) and general insurance (for example, building and contents cover and motor (automobile) insurance). Under FSMA, effecting or carrying out any contract of insurance, whether general or long-term, is a regulated activity requiring authorization.
Platinum UK has applied to the Financial Services Authority ("FSA") to write the business conducted by St. Paul Re in the United Kingdom. Platinum UK may not be licensed by the FSA at the time of the completion of the Public Offering. Any license, when obtained, may contain restrictions which could be material to our results of operations. St. Paul has agreed that it will continue to write reinsurance in the United Kingdom until the first anniversary of the date of completion of the Public Offering, and that Platinum US will reinsure such business.
Supervision
In its role as supervisor of insurance companies, the primary objective of the FSA is to fulfill its responsibilities under the FSMA regime relating to the safety and soundness of insurance companies with the aim of strengthening, but not guaranteeing, the protection of insureds. The FSA carries out this prudential supervision of insurance companies through the collection of information from statistical returns, through review of accountants' reports, by visits to insurance companies and through regular formal interviews.
The FSA has adopted a risk-based approach to the supervision of insurance companies. Under this approach the FSA performs a formal risk assessment of every insurance company or group carrying on business in the U.K. during each supervisory period, which varies in length according to the risk profile of the insurer. The FSA performs the risk assessment by analyzing information which it receives during the normal course of its supervision, such as regular prudential returns on the financial position of the insurance company, or which it acquires through a series of meetings with senior management of the insurance company. After each risk assessment, the FSA will inform the insurer of its views on the insurer's risk profile. This will include details of any remedial action which the FSA requires and the likely consequences if this action is not taken.
95
Solvency Requirements
The Interim Prudential Sourcebook for Insurers requires that insurance companies maintain a margin of solvency at all times in respect of any general insurance undertaken by the insurance company, the calculation of which in any particular case depends on the type and amount of insurance business a company writes. The method of calculation of the solvency margin is set out in the Interim Prudential Sourcebook for Insurers, and for these purposes, an insurer's assets and its liabilities are subject to specific valuation rules set out in the Interim Prudential Sourcebook for Insurers. Failure to maintain the required solvency margin is one of the grounds on which wide powers of intervention conferred upon FSA may be exercised.
Restrictions on Dividend Payments
While the United Kingdom insurance regulatory laws impose no statutory restrictions on an insurer's ability to declare a dividend, the FSA strictly controls the maintenance of each insurance company's solvency margin within its jurisdiction and may restrict Platinum UK from declaring a dividend beyond a level which the FSA determines would adversely affect Platinum UK's solvency requirements. It is common practice in the United Kingdom to notify the FSA in advance of any significant dividend payment.
Reporting Requirements
U.K. insurance companies must prepare their financial statements under the Companies Act 1985 (as amended), which requires the filing with Companies House of audited financial statements and related reports. Under the Interim Prudential Sourcebook for Insurers, audited accounts must be filed with the FSA within 2 months and 15 days (or 3 months where the delivery of accounts is made electronically).
Equalization Reserves
Each insurance company writing property, aviation, marine, business interruption or nuclear insurance or reinsurance business is required by the Interim Prudential Sourcebook for Insurers to maintain an equalization reserve in respect of business written in the financial years ending on or after December 23, 1996 calculated in accordance with the provisions of the Interim Prudential Sourcebook for Insurers.
Insurance companies writing credit insurance business must maintain equalization reserves calculated in accordance with certain provisions of the Interim Prudential Sourcebook for Insurers as related specifically to credit insurance business.
Supervision of Management
The FSA closely supervises the management of insurance companies through the approved persons regime, by which any appointment of persons to a position of significant influence within an authorized person must be approved by the FSA.
Change of Control
FSMA regulates the acquisition of "control" of any U.K. insurance company authorized under FSMA. Any company or individual that (together with its or his associates) directly or indirectly acquires 10% or more of the shares in the parent company of a U.K. authorized insurance company, or is entitled to exercise or control the exercise of 10% or more of the voting power in such a parent company, would be considered to have acquired "control" for the purposes of the relevant legislation, as would a person who had significant influence over the management of such
96
parent company by virtue of his shareholding in it. A purchaser of more than 10% of the Common Shares would therefore be considered to have acquired "control" of Platinum UK.
Under FSMA, any person proposing to acquire "control" over a U.K. authorized insurance company must give prior notification to the FSA of his intention to do so. The FSA would then have three months to consider that person's application to acquire "control". In considering whether to approve such application, the FSA must be satisfied that both the acquirer is a fit and proper person to have such "control" and that the interests of consumers would not be threatened by such acquisition of "control". Failure to make the relevant prior application would constitute a criminal offense.
Intervention and Enforcement
The FSA has extensive powers to intervene in the affairs of an authorized person. FSMA imposes on the FSA statutory obligations to monitor compliance with the requirements imposed by FSMA, and to enforce the provisions of FSMA and its related secondary legislation. The FSA has power, among other things, to enforce—and take disciplinary measures in respect of—breaches of both the Interim Prudential Sourcebook for Insurers and breaches of the conduct of business rules generally applicable to authorized persons.
FSMA permits the FSA to refer matters directly to its enforcement division in order to implement disciplinary or regulatory action, but more commonly enforcement action is preceded by the exercise of the FSA's interventionist supervisory powers.
The FSA has a general power on giving notice to require information and documents from authorized persons that the FSA reasonably requires in connection with the exercise of its functions under the regulatory regime. The FSA also has two distinct statutory powers to appoint investigators.
Under section 167 of FSMA, the FSA or the Secretary of State may appoint suitably competent persons to conduct an investigation on its behalf into the nature, conduct or state of the business of an authorized person, a particular aspect of that business or the ownership or control of an authorized person where there is general concern about an authorized person but the circumstances of the case do not suggest a specific breach or contravention of the regulatory regime.
By contrast, under section 168 of FSMA, the FSA or the Secretary of State may order an investigation if there appear to be circumstances suggesting that certain specified breaches or offenses under the regulatory regime have occurred (for example, breach of the general prohibition on performing regulated activities without suitable permission or misconduct by an approved person). Investigators appointed under section 168 have significantly wider powers than investigators appointed under section 167.
The FSA may also require an authorized person to provide a report prepared by certain skilled professionals to be approved by the FSA on any matter which the FSA has or could require the provision of documents.
The FSA has many enforcement powers available to use against an authorized or approved person. These include public censure, unlimited fines and, in serious cases, the power to revoke or vary permission to carry on regulated activities or an individual's approval. A serious case is one involving, among other things, the failure of an authorized person to satisfy the threshold conditions or the FSA considering that an approved person is no longer fit and proper to perform the function in question. In addition, the FSA may revoke an authorized person's permission if it is necessary to protect the interests of consumers or potential consumers.
97
The FSA has further powers to obtain injunctions against authorized persons and to impose or seek restitution orders where persons have suffered loss. Once the FSA has made a decision to take enforcement action (other than in the case of an application to the court for an injunction or restitution order) against an authorized or approved person, the person affected may refer the matter to the Financial Services Tribunal, a quasi-judicial entity staffed and operated independently of the FSA and administered by the Lord Chancellor's Department. Appeal from the Tribunal on a matter of law lies to the Court of Appeal provided that either the Tribunal or the Court of Appeal grants permission.
Finally, the FSA is granted the power to prosecute criminal offenses arising under FSMA, and to prosecute insider dealing under Part V of the Criminal Justice Act 1993, and breaches of money laundering regulations. The FSA's stated policy is to pursue criminal prosecution in all appropriate cases.
Ireland Regulation
As a holding company, Platinum Ireland is not subject to Irish insurance regulation. Platinum Ireland will initially function as a holding company. In the future, it may be used to carry out reinsurance activities in Ireland or the European Union outside of the United Kingdom, provided that the necessary regulatory approvals are first obtained.
98
Our Directors and Executive Officers
Upon commencement of our operations, we will have a new management team of experienced insurance industry professionals led by Steven H. Newman, who will be Chairman of the Board, and Jerome T. Fadden, who is President and Chief Executive Officer. The following table provides information regarding those persons who are expected to be directors and executive officers of Platinum Holdings upon completion of the Public Offering:
Name | Age | Expected Position at Platinum Holdings | ||
---|---|---|---|---|
Steven H. Newman | 59 | Chairman of the Board of Directors | ||
Jerome T. Fadden | 45 | President, Chief Executive Officer and Director | ||
Michael D. Price | 35 | Chief Underwriting Officer, Platinum US | ||
Neal J. Schmidt | 45 | Chief Actuary, Platinum US | ||
H. Furlong Baldwin | 70 | Director | ||
Jonathan F. Bank | 59 | Director | ||
Dan R. Carmichael | 57 | Director | ||
Jay S. Fishman | 49 | Director | ||
Peter T. Pruitt | 69 | Director |
Currently, only Mr. Fadden is a member of our Board of Directors. All of the other board members identified above have consented to serve as directors and will be elected as such prior to the completion of the Public Offering. We have not yet completed assembling our management team, including our chief financial officer.
Biographical information about the foregoing persons for at least the last five years is as follows:
Steven H. Newman was Chairman of the Board of Directors of Swiss Re America from May 2000 to October 2000, and Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer of Underwriters Re Group from 1987 to 2000. Prior to joining Underwriters Re, Mr. Newman served as Executive Vice President and then President of the Home Insurance Company from 1983 to 1986, and Vice President and Casualty Actuary at American International Group from 1969 to 1982. Mr. Newman also served as Chairman of the Board of GCR Holdings, a Bermuda catastrophe insurer, from 1995 to 1997 and as a Director of Capital Re from 1995 to 1998. Mr. Newman currently is an Advisory Director for HCC Insurance Holdings, Inc., a position he has held since November 2000. Mr. Newman has served as President of the Casualty Actuarial Society and Chairman of the Reinsurance Association of America. He has represented the United States at United Nations conferences dealing with international insurance and reinsurance issues.
Jerome T. Fadden has been the President, Chief Executive Officer, Acting Chief Financial Officer and Acting Chief Accounting Officer of Platinum Holdings since April 2002. In addition, he has been the President and Chief Executive Officer of St. Paul Re since March 2002. Prior to joining St. Paul Re, Mr. Fadden had been employed by UBS PaineWebber where he served as Chief Financial Officer from November 1999 through March 2001, and then Director of Strategic Development in the Office of the Chairman. Prior to joining UBS PaineWebber, from November 1998 to August 1999, Mr. Fadden was Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Equus Re, a start up reinsurance operation sponsored by Kemper Insurance. Mr. Fadden served as Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of NAC Re Corp. from July 1996 through
99
September 1998. Mr. Fadden served in a variety of senior management positions at The Travelers Group, including Treasurer as well as Chief Financial Officer of The Travelers Group's property and casualty insurance unit, The Gulf Insurance Group.
Michael D. Price has been Chief Underwriting Officer of St. Paul Re since June 2002. Mr. Price served as Chief Operating Officer of Associated Aviation Underwriters Incorporated, which is a subsidiary of Global Aerospace Underwriting Managers Ltd. specializing in aerospace insurance, from March 2001 through May 2002. He was Senior Vice President and Chief Underwriting Officer of Underwriters Re Group, Inc. from May 1998 until the acquisition of Underwriters Re Group, Inc. by Swiss Re America Holding Corporation in May 2000; thereafter, Mr. Price held the position of Chief Underwriting Officer at Swiss Re America Holding Corporation until September 2000. From July 1995 through May 1998, Mr. Price was employed by London Life and Casualty Reinsurance Corporation, most recently as President, and prior thereto he was a project manager at Milliman and Robertson, Inc. He is a fellow of the Casualty Actuarial Society and a member of the American Academy of Actuaries.
Neal J. Schmidt has been an Executive Vice President and Chief Actuary of St. Paul Re since 1998 and will serve as Executive Vice President and Chief Actuary of Platinum US upon completion of the Public Offering. Mr. Schmidt served as the Senior Vice President-Specialty Lines Underwriting of St. Paul Re from 1995 through 1998 and as Chief Actuary from 1986 through 1995. Prior to joining St. Paul Re, he held positions in reinsurance and insurance with the Home Insurance Company. Mr Schmidt is a fellow of the Casualty Actuarial Society and a Member of the American Academy of Actuaries.
H. Furlong Baldwin is the Chairman of Mercantile Bankshares Corporation, which is a bank holding corporation. Mr. Baldwin began his career with Mercantile in 1956 when it was known as the Mercantile-Safe Deposit & Trust Company, eventually becoming President and then Chief Executive Officer of the company, a position he held from 1976 until 2001. He is a Governor of the National Association of Securities Dealers, a past chairman of the Association of Bank Holding Companies and a past president of the Maryland Bankers Association. Mr. Baldwin is a trustee of the Marine Corps Heritage Foundation, the Marine Corps University and the Virginia Historical Society and is a member of the Council on Foreign Relations. From May 1998 to May 2002, Mr. Baldwin was a director of St. Paul and from 1968 to 1998, he was a director of USF&G Corporation, which was acquired by St. Paul in 1998.
Jonathan F. Bank has been Senior Vice President of Tawa Associates Ltd., which is engaged in the acquisition, restructuring and management of property and casualty companies in run off, since May 2001. From September 1999 through May 2001, he was the Insurance Practice Leader of PricewaterhouseCoopers' U.S. insurance/reinsurance regulatory and restructuring practice group. Prior thereto, Mr. Bank was a partner at the law firm of Chadbourne & Parke LLP, where he specialized in insurance and reinsurance dispute resolution and related regulatory matters. Mr. Bank is a member of the state bars of California, New York and Nebraska. He also served on the Advisory Committee on Reinsurance for the National Association of Insurance Commissioners.
Dan R. Carmichael has been President, Chief Executive Officer and a director of Ohio Casualty Corporation, a property and casualty insurance company, since December 2000. From 1995 through 2000, Mr. Carmichael served as President and Chief Executive Officer of IVANS, Inc., an industry-owned organization that provides electronic communications services to insurance, healthcare and related organizations. Prior thereto, he served as Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer of Anthem Casualty Insurance Group. Mr. Carmichael is also a director of Alleghany Corporation, a holding company engaged through its subsidiaries in the insurance, industrial minerals and steel fasteners businesses, and he serves as a trustee of the American
100
Institute for Chartered Property Casualty Underwriters, the Insurance Institute of America and the Griffith Foundation for Insurance Education.
Jay S. Fishman has been the Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President of The St. Paul Companies, Inc., and director of The John Nuveen Company, since October 2001. Prior to that date, Mr. Fishman was employed as Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer of The Travelers Insurance Group and as Chief Operating Officer—Finance and Risk of Citigroup, Inc. Mr. Fishman held various executive positions with Citigroup and its predecessor since 1989 and with Travelers since 1993.
Peter T. Pruitt was Chairman of Willis Re Inc., a reinsurance intermediary, from June 1995 until his retirement in December 2001. He also served as Chief Executive Officer of Willis Re Inc. from June 1995 through September 1999, and as Executive Vice President of Willis Corroon Corporation from November 1993 through June 1995. Prior thereto, Mr. Pruitt held various positions at Frank B. Hall & Co., an insurance brokerage firm, including President and Chief Operating Officer from August 1985 through November 1992. Mr. Pruitt served as a trustee of the College of Insurance (now St. John's University School of Risk Management) from 1986 until his retirement in 2001. He also served as a trustee of the Insurance Institute of America and the American Institute for Property and Liability Underwriters.
Number and Terms of Directors
Upon completion of the Public Offering our Board of Directors will consist of seven members, each of whose term of office will expire at the annual shareholders' meeting in 2003. Under our bye-laws, directors will be elected at each annual general meeting of shareholders, in each case by an ordinary resolution of the shareholders. Candidates for election will be nominated by the Board.
Directors may take action by a majority of the votes cast at a duly called and held meeting at which a quorum is present. A majority of directors in office at any time, or such greater number as the shareholders may from time to time determine, constitutes a quorum for all purposes.
The foregoing summarizes certain provisions of our bye-laws, which are subject to Bermuda law. See "Description of Our Common Shares".
Committees of the Board of Directors
Upon completion of the Public Offering, our Board of Directors will establish an Executive Committee, a Compensation Committee and an Audit Committee, each of which will report to the Board. The Executive Committee will have the authority to oversee our general business and affairs to the fullest extent permitted by Bermuda law. The Compensation Committee will have the authority to establish compensation policies and recommend compensation programs to the Board of Directors. The Audit Committee will be responsible for meeting with our independent accountants regarding, among other issues, audits and adequacy of our accounting and control systems. The Compensation Committee and the Audit Committee will consist entirely of independent directors.
Compensation of Directors
The Company will compensate each director (other than any director who is an employee of the Company) in the amount of $25,000 per year as a retainer fee and an additional $2,500 per meeting of the Board of Directors if the director attends in person, or an additional $1,000 per meeting if the director attends by telephone. The Company will compensate directors in the amount of $1,500 per meeting of any Board committee attended by such director and an additional $5,000 per year for each committee chairperson. Fees for the Chairman of the Board and proposed stock option grants for non-employee directors are described below.
101
Platinum Share Unit Plan for Nonemployee Directors
Effective upon the completion of the Public Offering, Platinum will adopt a Share Unit Plan for Nonemployee Directors. Under the Share Unit Plan, 50% of all fees earned by a nonemployee director (including retainer fees, meeting fees and committee fees) during each calendar quarter are automatically converted into the number of "Share Units" that have a value at the end of such calendar quarter equal to the amount of fees earned. Each Share Unit is a non-voting unit of measurement which is valued at the public trading price of the Common Shares. In addition to the 50% mandatory deferral, each nonemployee director may elect to have up to a total of 100% of his directors' fees converted into Share Units, provided the election is made before the end of the calendar year prior to the year in which the fees are earned. A nonemployee director will receive distributions under the Share Unit Plan following the expiration of 5 calendar years following the year in which his fees were originally converted into Share Units, or following termination of his service on the Board of Directors, if earlier. Each distribution under the Share Unit Plan will be made, at the discretion of the Board, either in cash or in Common Shares or some combination thereof.
Non-qualified Share Options for Nonemployee Directors
Under Platinum's 2002 Share Incentive Plan described below, an initial non-qualified share option covering 25,000 Common Shares will be granted to each of the nonemployee directors upon the completion of the Public Offering at the initial public offering price. The options will have a ten-year term and will vest in equal annual installments on each of the first three anniversaries of the date of grant, subject to accelerated vesting in the event of a "Change in Control" (as defined in the Share Incentive Plan). Following the Public Offering, outside directors will be eligible to receive option grants under the Share Incentive Plan in the sole discretion of the Compensation Committee.
Arrangements with the Chairman of the Board
Mr. Newman has entered into a letter agreement with St. Paul (which will be assigned to Platinum Holdings upon completion of the Public Offering), pursuant to which he agreed to serve as Chairman of Platinum Holdings' Board of Directors upon completion of the Public Offering. As Chairman of the Board, he will be entitled to receive an annual fee of $60,000 and a fee of $5,000 for each meeting of the Board of Directors that he attends (not to exceed $20,000 per year). Mr. Newman will receive a stock option grant to purchase 1.5% of the outstanding Common Shares on a fully diluted basis immediately following the Public Offering at a price not greater than the initial public offering price. The option will have a ten-year term and will vest in equal annual installments on each of the first three anniversaries of the date of grant. Under the agreement, Platinum Holdings will indemnify Mr. Newman, to the fullest extent permitted by law, if he is made or threatened to be made a party to a proceeding by reason of his being or having been a director of Platinum Holdings.
Mr. Newman also has entered into a letter agreement with St. Paul (which will be assigned to Platinum US upon completion of the Public Offering), pursuant to which he will provide consulting services to Platinum US through February 28, 2005 (which date may be automatically extended from year to year). During the consulting term, Mr. Newman will perform services as reasonably requested, including assisting with the establishment and development of the reinsurance business of Platinum US. During the consulting term, Mr. Newman will receive an annual consulting fee of $270,000 and will be eligible to receive an annual incentive equal to $440,000 at target, and a maximum incentive equal to 200% of target following the Public Offering; provided that he will receive no later than February 28, 2003 a minimum incentive for calendar year 2002 of $366,670. The objectives for Mr. Newman's annual incentive following the Public Offering will be determined
102
by the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors of Platinum Holdings in consultation with Mr. Newman. On April 15, 2002, Mr. Newman received a one-time incentive payment of $100,000 from St. Paul. Mr. Newman is subject to certain confidentiality, non-compete and non-solicitation provisions under the agreement. Mr. Newman's consulting services for Platinum US will be performed through SHN Enterprises, Inc., which he has established for estate planning purposes and of which he is the sole shareholder.
Our Executive Officers
The following information is a summary of the employment arrangements that we expect to be applicable to our President and Chief Executive Officer and our other executive officers, and a description of the incentive plans that we expect to be in place, upon completion of the Public Offering:
Jerome T. Fadden.Mr. Fadden has an employment agreement with St. Paul for a five-year term that began March 4, 2002, subject to one-year renewal terms thereafter. Upon the completion of the Public Offering, St. Paul will assign all of its rights and obligations under the employment agreement to the Company. Assuming completion of the Public Offering, Mr. Fadden will serve as our President and Chief Executive Officer following the Public Offering. Mr. Fadden will also serve as a member of our Board of Directors upon the completion of the Public Offering. Mr. Fadden will receive a base salary of at least $650,000 following the Public Offering, and he will be eligible to receive an annual target bonus of 125% of base salary (and a maximum bonus of 200% of the target bonus following the Public Offering). The objectives for Mr. Fadden's annual bonus will be determined by the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors, in consultation with Mr. Fadden. On June 1, 2002, Mr. Fadden received a sign-on bonus of $250,000 from St. Paul. Mr. Fadden also received an initial grant of stock options to purchase up to 100,000 shares of St. Paul common stock, which are subject to the terms of the St. Paul stock option plan and which vest in four equal annual installments on the first four anniversaries of the date of grant. Upon completion of the Public Offering, Mr. Fadden will forfeit such St. Paul stock options to the extent they are unvested and will receive a stock option grant to purchase 1.5% of the outstanding Common Shares on a fully diluted basis immediately following the Public Offering at a price not greater than the initial public offering price. Such options will have a ten-year term and will vest in equal annual installments on each of the first three anniversaries of the date of grant.
If Mr. Fadden's employment is terminated by us without "cause" or by Mr. Fadden for "good reason" (each as defined in the agreement), he will receive a payment equal to three times the sum of his base salary and the greater of his target bonus and his bonus for the preceding year, provided that Mr. Fadden executes a release of claims, and up to three years of medical and dental coverage and immediate vesting of all outstanding stock options. In addition, all outstanding stock options will remain exercisable for the lesser of five years and the remainder of their term. If Mr. Fadden's employment is terminated by us for cause or by Mr. Fadden other than for good reason, he will receive no further payments, compensation or benefits under the agreement (other than amounts accrued prior to termination of employment) and all vested options will remain exercisable for 30 days after termination. In the event his employment is terminated due to death or "disability" (as defined in the agreement), he will receive his base salary through the date of termination and an annual bonus (at target level), prorated through the date of termination. In addition, all outstanding stock options will immediately vest and will remain exercisable (but not beyond their term) for three years, in the case of a disability termination, and one year, in the case of death. In the event Mr. Fadden's employment is terminated under circumstances described in the agreement within two years after a change in control of the Company, Mr. Fadden will be entitled to certain severance benefits. In the event Mr. Fadden is subject to excise tax on any severance payments made to him under the agreement, we will make a gross-up payment to compensate him
103
for such tax liability. Mr. Fadden is subject to certain confidentiality, non-compete and non-solicitation provisions under the agreement.
Michael D. Price. Mr. Price has an employment agreement with St. Paul Re for a three-year term beginning June 3, 2002. Upon the completion of the Public Offering, St. Paul Re will assign all of its rights and obligations under the employment agreement to Platinum US. Assuming completion of the Public Offering, Mr. Price will serve as the Chief Underwriting Officer of Platinum US following the Public Offering. Mr. Price will receive a base salary of at least $400,000 following the Public Offering, and he will be eligible to receive a minimum annual bonus of 50% of base salary. On June 3, 2002, Mr. Price received a sign-on bonus of $100,000 from St. Paul Re. Upon completion of the Public Offering, Mr. Price will receive a grant of stock options to purchase that number of Common Shares having an aggregate market value equal to $5,000,000 at a price not greater than the initial offering price. Such options will have a ten-year term and will vest, subject to continued employment, in three equal annual installments on each of the first two anniversaries of the completion of the Public Offering and on June 3, 2005.
If Mr. Price's employment is terminated by Platinum US without "cause" or by Mr. Price for "good reason" (each as defined in the agreement), he will receive a payment equal to any bonus payments to which he would have been entitled during the term of the agreement which have not been previously paid, 50% of his then current base salary and any base salary or other amounts accrued and owing through the date of termination, provided that Mr. Price executes a release of claims. If Mr. Price's employment is terminated by Platinum US for cause or by Mr. Price other than for good reason, he will receive no further payments, compensation or benefits under the agreement (other than amounts accrued prior to termination of employment). Mr. Price is subject to certain confidentiality and non-solicitation provisions under the agreement.
Platinum 2002 Share Incentive Plan
Platinum will adopt the 2002 Share Incentive Plan effective upon completion of the Public Offering. The Plan provides for the grant of share options, share appreciation rights, share units and restricted shares. The material features of the Plan are summarized below.
Purpose. The purpose of the Plan is to advance the interests of the Company and its shareholders by attracting, retaining and motivating key personnel upon whose judgment, initiative and effort the successful conduct of the Company's operations is largely dependent. The Plan is also intended to further the align the interests of employees, officers and directors with those of the shareholders by promoting the ownership of Common Shares by these individuals.
Reservation of Shares. A total of 10% of the Common Shares outstanding (on a fully diluted basis) upon completion of the Public Offering are reserved for issuance under the Plan (including Common Shares reserved for issuance to our directors and executive officers set forth in any employment or consulting agreement), which will be made available from authorized but unissued shares or from treasury shares. If any shares that are the subject of an award are not issued and cease to be issuable for any reason, these shares will no longer be charged against the maximum share limitations and may again be made subject to awards. In addition, the number of Common Shares exchanged by a participant as payment to Platinum Holdings of the exercise price or tax withholding upon exercise of an option will be added to the share reserve. The maximum number of Common Shares that may be made subject of restricted share awards shall be limited to 10% of the Common Shares reserved under the Plan. In the event of recapitalizations, reclassifications or other specified events affecting Platinum or the Common Shares, appropriate and equitable adjustments may be made to the number and kind of shares available for grant, as well as to other maximum limitations, under the Plan, and the number and kind of shares or other rights and prices under outstanding awards.
104
Administration. The Plan will be administered by the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors of Platinum Holdings. It is expected that the Compensation Committee will be constituted so as to comply with the "non-employee director" requirements of Rule 16b-3 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act") and the "outside director" requirements of Section 162(m) of the Code. Subject to the limitations set forth in the Plan, the Compensation Committee has the authority to determine the persons to whom awards are granted, the types of awards to be granted, the time at which awards will be granted, the number of shares, units or other rights subject to each award, the exercise, base or purchase price of an award, the time or times at which the award will become vested, exercisable or payable, and the duration of the award. The Compensation Committee will have the right, from time to time, to delegate to one or more officers of the Company the authority of the Committee to grant and determine the terms and conditions of awards, subject to certain limitations.
Eligibility. Awards under the Plan may be granted to any employee, officer, director, consultant or advisor of Platinum Holdings or any of its subsidiaries. Recipients of awards will be selected from time to time by the Compensation Committee in its sole discretion.
Share Options. Share options granted under the Plan may be issued as either incentive options (within the meaning of Section 422 of the Code), or as non-qualified options. The exercise price of an option will be determined by the Compensation Committee, provided that the exercise price per share will not be less than the fair market value of a Common Share on the date of the grant of the option. The Compensation Committee will determine the vesting requirements and the term of exercise of each option, including the effect of termination of employment or service of a participant. The maximum term of a share option will be ten years from the date of grant. To exercise an option, the participant must pay the exercise price, subject to specified conditions, in cash or in Common Shares, through a broker-assisted "cashless exercise", by combination of any of the above methods or other method approved by the Compensation Committee, and must pay any required tax withholding amounts. The Compensation Committee may also grant "reload options" for the number of Common Shares tendered by a participant to cover the exercise price or withholding tax upon the exercise of a share option under the Plan. Under the Code, the maximum value of Common Shares (determined at the time of grant) that may be subject to incentive options that become exercisable by an employee in any one year is limited to $100,000. The maximum number of Common Shares that may be covered under options granted to any individual in any calendar year is 10% of the Common Shares reserved under the Plan for options granted after the date of completion of the Public Offering.
Share Appreciation Rights. A share appreciation right may be granted either in tandem with an option or without a related option. A share appreciation right entitles the participant, upon exercise, to receive a payment based on the excess of the fair market value of a Common Share on the date of exercise over the base price of the right (which may not be less than the fair market value of a Common Share on the date of grant), multiplied by the number of shares as to which the right is being exercised. The maximum term of a share appreciation right will be ten years from the date of grant. No more than 10% of the Common Shares reserved under the Plan may be subject to share appreciation rights granted to any one participant during any calendar year. Share appreciation rights may be payable in cash or in Common Shares or in a combination of both. Share appreciation rights may also be granted together with related dividend equivalent rights.
Share Units. An award of share units gives the participant the right to receive payment at the end of a vesting period based on the value of the Common Share at the time of vesting. Share units are subject to vesting requirements, restrictions and conditions to payment as the Compensation Committee determines are appropriate. Such vesting requirements may be based on the continued employment of the participant for a specified time period or on the attainment of
105
specified business performance goals established by the Committee. Share unit awards are payable in cash or in Common Shares or in a combination of both. Share units may also be granted together with related dividend equivalent rights.
Restricted Share Awards. A restricted share award represents Common Shares that are issued subject to restrictions on transfer and vesting requirements as determined by the Compensation Committee. Vesting requirements may be based on the continued employment of the participant for specified time periods and on the attainment of specified business performance goals established by the Compensation Committee. Subject to the transfer and vesting restrictions of the award, the participant will have the rights of a shareholder of Platinum Holdings, including all voting and dividend rights, during the restriction period, unless the Committee determines otherwise at the time of the grant.
Change In Control. The Compensation Committee may, in an award agreement, provide for the effect of a change in control on an award. These provisions may include the acceleration of vesting of an award, the elimination or modification of performance or other conditions, the extension of the time for exercise or realizing gain from an award, the acceleration of payment, cash settlement of an award or other adjustments that the Compensation Committee considers appropriate.
Term; Amendment and Termination. The term of the Plan is 10 years. The Board may terminate or amend the Plan at any time, subject to shareholder approval under certain circumstances provided in the Plan. However, no amendment of the Plan will adversely affect the rights under any previously granted award.
Upon completion of the Public Offering, each of Messrs. Newman and Fadden will be granted options to purchase 1.5% of the outstanding Common Shares on a fully diluted basis, and Mr. Price will be granted options to purchase that number of Common Shares having an aggregate market value equal to $5,000,000, in each case at a price not greater than the initial public offering price. In addition, options to purchase 25,000 Common Shares at the public offering price will be granted to each of the nonemployee directors of the Company at a price not greater than the initial public offering price. Additional options to purchase Common Shares may be granted to other employees upon completion of the Public Offering.
Platinum Capital Accumulation Plan
Platinum will adopt the Capital Accumulation Plan (the "CAP Plan") effective upon completion of the Public Offering. The CAP Plan provides for the payment of a portion of a participant's annual bonus compensation in the form of restricted shares or in share options. The material features of the CAP Plan are summarized below.
Purpose. The purpose of the CAP Plan is to advance the interests of Platinum Holdings and its shareholders by attracting, retaining and motivating key personnel upon whose judgment, initiative and effort the successful conduct of Platinum Holdings' operations is largely dependent. The CAP Plan is also intended to further the align the interests of officers and employees with those of the shareholders by promoting the ownership of Common Shares by these individuals.
Available Shares. No Common Shares are separately authorized for issuance under the CAP Plan. All Common Shares subject to awards under the CAP Plan shall be taken from the Common Shares reserved under the 2002 Share Incentive Plan, as adjusted under the terms thereof.
Administration. The CAP Plan will be administered by a committee (the "Committee") of the Board of Directors of Platinum Holdings. It is expected that the Committee will be constituted so as to comply with the "non-employee director" requirements of Rule 16b-3 under the Exchange Act
106
and the "outside director" requirements of Section 162(m) of the Code. Subject to the limitations set forth in the CAP Plan, the Committee has the authority to determine which employees are eligible to participate in the CAP Plan, the number of restricted shares or share options to be awarded, the vesting schedule of the share awards and the other terms and conditions of participation. The Committee will have the right, from time to time, to delegate to one or more officers of Platinum Holdings the authority of the Committee to grant and determine the terms and conditions of awards, subject to certain limitations.
Eligibility. Awards under the CAP Plan may generally be granted to any officer or other employee of Platinum Holdings or its subsidiaries who is entitled to bonus or incentive awards and is designated by the Committee to participate based on such criteria as the Committee deems appropriate. Upon designation by the Committee, participation in the CAP Plan is generally mandatory, although the Committee may in certain circumstances make participation elective.
Restricted Shares. A portion of each participant's annual bonus compensation, determined in the discretion of the Committee, will be paid in the form of restricted shares. The price of the restricted shares for purposes of determining the number of shares to be issued may be discounted from fair market value (as defined in the CAP Plan) at the discretion of the Committee (to a maximum of 25%) in order to reflect the impact of the restricted nature and potential forfeiture of the shares. The participant is not able to sell, pledge or otherwise dispose of the restricted shares, except by will or the laws of descent and distribution, for a period of two years, or such other period, and subject to such conditions, as may be determined by the Committee. In the event that the participant has been continuously employed by Platinum Holdings or its subsidiaries upon expiration of the restricted period, the participant shall obtain full dispositive power over his or her shares. The Committee may provide, in its discretion, that the restrictions on the restricted shares immediately lapse upon certain termination of the participant's employment or upon the death, disability or retirement of a participant.
Share Options. The Committee may in its discretion permit a participant to elect to receive up to one-third of his or her award in the form of a grant of non-qualified options. The Committee will determine the number of options to be awarded in lieu of each share of restricted shares. The exercise price of an option will be determined by the Committee, provided that the exercise price per share will not be less than the fair market value of a Common Share on the date of the grant of the option. The Committee will determine the vesting requirements and the term of exercise of each option, including the effect of termination of employment or service of a participant, provided, that unless the Committee provides otherwise, the option will become vested and exercisable on the second anniversary of the date of grant if the participant has been continuously employed by Platinum Holdings or its subsidiaries. The term of a share option will be ten years from the date of grant unless otherwise provided by the Committee. To exercise an option, the participant must pay the exercise price, subject to specified conditions in cash or in Common Shares, through a broker-assisted "cashless exercise," or by combination of any of the above methods approved by the Committee and must pay any required tax withholding amounts.
Change In Control. The Committee may, in an award agreement, provide for the effect of a change in control on an award of restricted shares or share options. These provisions may include the lapse of restrictions or the acceleration of vesting of an award, the elimination or modification of any conditions, the extension of the time for exercise, provision for cash settlement of an award or other adjustments that the Committee considers appropriate.
Term, Amendment and Termination. The term of the CAP Plan is ten years. The Board may amend the CAP Plan at any time, subject to shareholder approval under certain circumstances provided in the CAP Plan or terminate the CAP Plan at any time, in each case, except as would
107
adversely affect outstanding awards without participant consent. However, no amendment of the CAP Plan will adversely affect the rights under any previously granted award.
ST. PAUL INVESTMENT AND PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS
We expect to enter into a Formation and Separation Agreement relating to, among other things, the St. Paul Investment, which is the issuance of an aggregate of up to 13,262,300 Common Shares, or up to approximately 24.9% of the outstanding Common Shares, to St. Paul in return for St. Paul's contribution of the Transferred Business and its agreement to enter into various agreements with us. St. Paul will obtain the approximate 24.9% interest if the initial public offering price equals or exceeds $25 per share. In the event the initial public offering price is less than $25 per share, St. Paul's interest will be reduced pro rata so that St. Paul would obtain 10,062,300 Common Shares or approximately 20.1% of the Common Shares to be outstanding following the Public Offering at an initial public offering price of $23 per share. If the underwriters exercise their option to purchase up to an additional 6,000,000 Common Shares in the Public Offering in whole or in part, St. Paul will be issued such additional Common Shares as permit it to retain the proportionate interest it would have obtained without such exercise. In order to maintain such ownership levels, the total number of Common Shares to be sold to St. Paul is subject to proportionate adjustment if the number of Common Shares sold in the Public Offering is adjusted.
In addition, in the event the initial public offering price is less than $25 per share, we will grant St. Paul a ten-year option to purchase at the initial offering price the number of shares which it did not obtain as a result of the foregoing reduction. At an initial public offering price of $23 per share, the option would cover 3,200,000 shares, or 3,680,000 shares if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional Common Shares in full. Regardless of the level of the initial public offering price, we will grant St. Paul a ten-year option to acquire in specified circumstances up to 2 million shares at an exercise price per share equal to 130% of the initial public offering price.
The principal terms of these options are described under "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Option Agreement—St. Paul Ownership Option" and "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—St. Paul Participation Option".
The following table shows St. Paul's ownership following the Public Offering and St. Paul Investment at various initial public offering prices, reflecting no exercise and full exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares:
IPO Price Per Share | Shares Issued to St. Paul with No Over-Allotment Option Exercised | Shares Issued to St. Paul If Underwriters' Over-Allotment Option Exercised in Full | Ownership of Common Shares by St. Paul following the Public Offering and St. Paul Investment | ||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
$23 | 10,062,300 | 11,571,600 | 20.1 | % | |||
$24 | 11,612,300 | 13,354,100 | 22.5 | ||||
$25 | 13,262,300 | 15,251,600 | 24.9 | ||||
$26 | 13,262,300 | 15,251,600 | 24.9 |
St. Paul's address is 385 Washington Street, St. Paul, Minnesota 55102. The Company is not aware of any potential 5% beneficial owner of Common Shares other than St. Paul.
108
The following table shows the Common Shares issuable to St. Paul under the St. Paul Ownership Option at various initial public offering prices:
IPO Price Per Share | Shares Issuable under St. Paul Ownership Option | Shares Issuable Under St. Paul Ownership Option If Underwriters' Over-Allotment Option Exercised in Full | Ownership of Common Shares following the Public Offering and St. Paul Investment and Exercise in Full of St. Paul Ownership Option | ||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
$23 | 3,200,000 | 3,680,000 | 24.9 | % | |||
$24 | 1,650,000 | 1,897,500 | 24.9 | ||||
$25 | — | — | 24.9 | ||||
$26 | — | — | 24.9 |
The completion of the St. Paul Investment under the Formation and Separation Agreement is conditioned upon completion of the Public Offering. The closing of the St. Paul Investment will occur simultaneously with the completion of the Public Offering.
St. Paul has been granted rights to require the Company to register all of the Common Shares St. Paul acquires pursuant to the St. Paul Investment, the St. Paul Participation Option, the St. Paul Ownership Option or otherwise as provided under the Formation and Separation Agreement. See "Shares Eligible For Future Sale" and "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions".
None of our directors and executive officers is expected to beneficially own any Common Shares upon completion of the Public Offering. However, our directors and executive officers will be granted stock options at the time of completion of the Public Offering. The following table sets forth the number of Common Shares subject to the options presently intended to be granted to our directors and executive officers.
Name of Beneficial Owner | Number of Common Shares subject to Stock Options expected to be granted upon completion of the Public Offering | Percent on a Fully Diluted Basis | ||
---|---|---|---|---|
Steven H. Newman(1) | 798,935 | 1.5% | ||
Jerome T. Fadden(1) | 798,935 | 1.5% | ||
Michael D. Price(2) | 200,000 | * | ||
Neal J. Schmidt | ||||
H. Furlong Baldwin | 25,000 | * | ||
Dan R. Carmichael | 25,000 | * | ||
Jonathan F. Bank | 25,000 | * | ||
Jay S. Fishman | 25,000 | * | ||
Peter T. Pruitt | 25,000 | * | ||
Directors and executive officers as a group(1) | 1,922,470 | 3.5% |
- (1)
- Assuming that 53,262,300 Common Shares will be outstanding upon completion of the Public Offering, which excludes (i) Common Shares which may be issued pursuant to the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares, (ii) Common Shares which may be issued pursuant to the St. Paul Ownership option and (iii) Common Shares which may be issued pursuant to the St. Paul Participation Option.
- (2)
- Assuming a price per share equal to $25.
- *
- Less than 1%
109
CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS
The following summarizes the material terms of the agreements between St. Paul and Platinum listed below. This summary is subject to, and is qualified in its entirety by reference to, all of the provisions of the relevant agreements. A copy of each agreement is filed as an exhibit to this registration statement of which this prospectus is a part.
Prior to completion of the Public Offering, we and St. Paul and certain of St. Paul's subsidiaries will enter into a number of agreements with respect to our formation and operations. The terms of these agreements have been negotiated by Platinum and St. Paul but do not necessarily reflect terms that Platinum or St. Paul would agree to with an independent third party.
Formation and Separation Agreement
General. Prior to the completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, we will enter into the Formation and Separation Agreement with St. Paul which will set forth the terms of our establishment and organization, certain actions that will be required to be taken prior to the completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, termination of certain relationships with St. Paul and certain continuing relationships with St. Paul following the completion of the Public Offering. Under the Formation and Separation Agreement, we will, among other things, reimburse St. Paul for certain specified expenses incurred in connection with our formation, the registration of the Common Shares and the St. Paul Investment. The Formation and Separation Agreement will provide for St. Paul to contribute to us and our affiliates the Transferred Business, which consists of certain tangible and intangible assets required for the operation of our business, including renewal rights in respect of reinsurance contracts underwritten by St. Paul, systems, records, assignments of leases and furniture and fixtures, as well as all of the outstanding capital stock of Platinum US. It will also provide for St. Paul and us to enter into various agreements, including the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements by which we will reinsure the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts. As consideration for St. Paul's contribution of the Transferred Business and its agreement to enter into various agreements with us, if the initial public offering price in the Public Offering equals or exceeds $25 per share, we will issue to St. Paul 13,262,300 Common Shares pursuant to the St. Paul Investment, or approximately 24.9% of the Common Shares to be outstanding following the Public Offering. In the event the initial public offering price is less than $25 per share, St. Paul's interest will be reduced pro rata so that St. Paul would obtain 10,062,300 Common Shares or approximately 20.1% of the Common Shares to be outstanding following the Public Offering at an initial public offering price of $23 per share. If the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional Common Shares, St. Paul will be issued such additional Common Shares as permit it to retain the proportionate interest it would have obtained without such exercise. The range of the number of Common Shares to be issued to St. Paul for the contribution of the Transferred Business was determined by St. Paul and Platinum Holdings, based on the nature of the business transferred, including the contractual arrangements between the parties, and the expected valuation of Platinum Holdings in the Public Offering.
General Cross Indemnification. The Formation and Separation Agreement provides that, except as otherwise set forth in any provision of the Formation and Separation Agreement or any other agreement between St. Paul and us provided for therein:
- •
- St. Paul generally shall indemnify Platinum Holdings, Platinum Ireland, Platinum US, Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda and their respective officers, directors, employees, representatives and agents (the "Platinum Indemnitees") from and against any and all losses, liabilities, claims, damages, obligations, payments, costs and expenses ("Liabilities") of any such Platinum Indemnitee that arise out of any act, omission, event or condition occurring or arising prior to the completion of the Public Offering relating to (1) (A) the ownership, operation or use of the reinsurance business of St. Paul Re or the assets transferred to us by
110
- •
- Platinum Holdings shall indemnify St. Paul, its subsidiaries and their respective officers, directors, employees, representatives and agents (the "St. Paul Indemnitees") from and against any and all Liabilities of any such St. Paul Indemnitee that arise out of any act, omission, event or condition occurring or arising at or after the completion of the Public Offering relating to (1) the ownership, operation or use of the business of Platinum or the related assets by Platinum on or after the completion of the Public Offering; (2) any breach by Platinum Holdings, any of its subsidiaries or any person acting on behalf of Platinum Holdings or any such subsidiary of any representation,
warranty, covenant or undertaking contained in any agreement between St. Paul and us provided for in the Formation and Separation Agreement; and (3) any and all taxes that are not Pre-Closing Taxes. Platinum's Liabilities include all Liabilities relating to the employment agreements with Jerome T. Fadden, Steven M. Newman and Michael D. Price irrespective of whether occurring or arising prior to, on or after the completion of the Public Offering and all Liabilities relating to the obligations of St. Paul and its subsidiaries to write or renew certain reinsurance agreements incepting on or after January 1, 2002.
St. Paul or any of its subsidiaries, and (B) Platinum US; (2) any breach by St. Paul, any of its subsidiaries, or any person acting on behalf of St. Paul or any such subsidiary of any representation, warranty, covenant or undertaking contained in the Formation and Separation Agreement or any other agreement between St. Paul and us provided for thereby; and (3) any and all taxes (the "Pre-closing Taxes") (A) imposed on St. Paul and its "affiliated group" as defined in Section 1504(a) of the Code, (B) relating to Platinum US or for which Platinum US could be liable, or (C) directly relating to the assets transferred with the Transferred Business for any taxable periods ending on or before the date of the completion of the Public Offering, subject to certain exceptions. St. Paul will not be obligated to so indemnify any Platinum Indemnitee for any Liabilities arising out of any act or omission occurring or arising prior to the completion of the Public Offering of any of Steven Newman, Jerome Fadden or Michael Price taken in furtherance of the organization of Platinum Holdings or its subsidiaries, the Public Offering, the registration statement of which this prospectus is a part, the agreements between St. Paul and us provided for in the Formation and Separation Agreement, or the transactions related thereto but otherwise do include Liabilities arising out of any act or omission occurring or arising prior to the completion of the Public Offering of any of such individuals in their capacities as officers of St. Paul Re.
This general indemnification under the Formation and Separation Agreement does not cover any Liabilities relating to the Public Offering under the federal or any state securities laws.
Securities Indemnification by Platinum Holdings. The Formation and Separation Agreement provides that Platinum Holdings shall indemnify (including reimbursement for expenses) to the full extent permitted by law, St. Paul, its subsidiaries and their respective officers, directors, employees and agents, and each person who controls any of them and the officers, directors, employees and agents of each such controlling person (each, a "St. Paul Registration Indemnitee"), from and against any and all Liabilities arising out of or based upon any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact in the "Platinum Information", being the information (other than the St. Paul Information and Shared Information (each as defined below)) contained in the registration statement, or arising out of or based upon any omission or alleged omission to state a material fact required to be stated or necessary to make the statements in the Platinum Information not misleading.
Securities Indemnification by St. Paul. The Formation and Separation Agreement provides that St. Paul shall indemnify (including reimbursement for expenses), to the full extent permitted by law, Platinum Holdings, its subsidiaries and their respective officers, directors, employees and agents and each person who controls any of them and the officers, directors, employees, and
111
agents of each such controlling person (each, a "Platinum Registration Indemnitee") from and against any and all Liabilities arising out of or based upon any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact in the "St. Paul Information" contained in the registration statement, or arising out of or based upon any omission or alleged omission to state a material fact required to be stated or necessary to make the statements in the St. Paul Information not misleading. St. Paul Information is generally the information in this prospectus set forth under the caption "The Predecessor Business" and in the financial statements of "The St. Paul Companies, Inc. Reinsurance Underwriting Segment (Predecessor)".
Indemnification for Shared Information. Notwithstanding the indemnification provisions in the two preceding paragraphs, St. Paul and Platinum shall indemnify (including reimbursement for expenses), to the full extent permitted by law, each Platinum Registration Indemnitee and each St. Paul Registration Indemnitee, respectively, for 50% of any and all Liabilities arising out of or based upon any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact in the Shared Information contained in the registration statement, or arising out of or based upon any omission or alleged omission to state a material fact required to be stated or necessary to make the statements in the Shared Information not misleading. "Shared Information" means any numerical, financial, narrative or other information contained in the Platinum Information that is based on or related to any pro forma financial information or disclosure with respect to the Transferred Business described in the registration statement.
Securities Contributions. If for any reason the foregoing securities indemnifications are unavailable to, or are insufficient to hold harmless, any registration indemnitee, the indemnifying party shall contribute to the amount paid or payable by such registration indemnitee in a proportion to reflect the parties' relative benefits and relative faults. For the avoidance of doubt, St. Paul may not require any contribution from Platinum for any Liabilities arising out of or based upon any St. Paul Information, and Platinum may not require any contribution from St. Paul for any Liabilities arising out of or based upon any Platinum Information. Furthermore, any contribution with respect to any Liabilities arising out of or related to any Shared Information are limited to 50% of the amount of such Liabilities.
Limitations on Securities Indemnification by St. Paul. St. Paul's aggregate liability to the Platinum Registration Indemnitees is limited to a duration of two years following the completion of the Public Offering and covers only the excess of (1) $400 million over (2) any amounts directly paid or payable by St. Paul (x) to investors in the Public Offering in respect of claims against St. Paul arising under the registration statement and/or (y) the underwriters of the Public Offering pursuant to an obligation of St. Paul under the underwriting agreement for the Public Offering to pay certain indemnification, contribution and expense reimbursement obligations of Platinum to the underwriters if Platinum fails to pay in defined circumstances.
If Platinum Registration Indemnitees make a claim for the indemnification, contribution or reimbursement of expenses against St. Paul, St. Paul's obligation to indemnify, contribute to, or reimburse the Platinum Registration Indemnitees with respect to such claim is conditioned on, and only payable upon, the concurrent settlement or resolution of all claims then outstanding at the time of such settlement or resolution against St. Paul (other than claims by the underwriters of the Public Offering) which are then subject to the limitation on liability set forth in the immediately preceding paragraph provided St. Paul continues in good faith to seek and assist in the resolution or settlement of all such claims.
Non-Competition. The Formation and Separation Agreement generally provides that, for a period of two years after the completion of the Public Offering, neither St. Paul nor any of its subsidiaries or any of their respective directors, officers or agents may
112
- (1)
- offer, issue, sell, refer or promote, directly or indirectly, any contracts of reinsurance of the same type as the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts and for which St. Paul has granted to Platinum the rights to seek renewal, provided that Platinum continues to provide, during the two-year
non-competition period, reinsurance coverage of such types to third parties subject to certain exceptions;
- (2)
- employ, offer to employ or solicit with a view to employment specified key employees or employees in specified positions of Platinum; or
- (3)
- use or disclose to any person other than St. Paul or Platinum Holdings, any of their subsidiaries or any of their respective directors, officers and agents any information relating to the Transferred Business of a confidential nature except in connection with the administration of (1) the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts and the run-off business of St. Paul or (2) any liabilities retained by St. Paul. St. Paul, its subsidiaries and their respective directors, officers and agents may disclose such confidential information relating to the Transferred Business only in the ordinary course of business, consistent with past practice and shall use reasonable efforts to avoid providing such confidential information relating to the Transferred Business to a competitor of Platinum under circumstances reasonably likely to materially impair the value of Platinum's right to seek such renewals of any reinsurance agreements underwritten by St. Paul Re and in effect as of the date of completion of the Public Offering.
In addition, for two years after the completion of the Public Offering, neither St. Paul nor any of its subsidiaries may sponsor or assist, directly or indirectly, in the sponsorship of a newly formed property or casualty reinsurer for so long as St. Paul continues to own 10% or more of the outstanding Common Shares.
The non-competition agreements in clauses (1) and (2) above are not binding upon a subsidiary of St. Paul after the time such person ceases to be a subsidiary. With certain exceptions, the non-competition agreement in clause (1) above does not apply to any affiliate of St. Paul that is not a subsidiary of St. Paul, including any person which acquires all or substantially all of the capital stock or assets of St. Paul through merger, consolidation, tender offer, acquisition of assets or otherwise, but the non-competition agreements in clauses (2) and (3) shall apply to such affiliates of St. Paul.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, neither St. Paul nor any of its subsidiaries is prohibited from
- (1)
- engaging in any line of business in which it is engaged immediately after the completion of the Public Offering and for which St. Paul has not transferred to Platinum the right and any obligations to seek renewals, including, without limitation, the run-off business (but not including any renewals thereof) of St. Paul, purchasing reinsurance for its own account, the reinsurance business written through Discover Re and Lloyd's of London operations and property catastrophe facultative business written by St. Paul's CATrisk Property division;
- (2)
- acquiring any person or any interest in any person engaged in any line of business except for an acquisition of an interest of more than 49% of a person that generated 50% or more of its gross revenues, excluding investment income and realized investment gains and losses, in the most recent fiscal year for which financial statements are available by writing property or casualty reinsurance (a "Permitted Acquiree"), provided that such an acquired person is not allowed to use the name "St. Paul", "USF&G" or "F&G" or any derivative thereof or any logo or mark identified with such names in connection with its reinsurance business, provided further, however, that St. Paul and any of its subsidiaries may acquire an interest of more than 49% of a person that is not a Permitted Acquiree if St. Paul or such subsidiary promptly divests the property or casualty reinsurance operations of such person; or
113
- (3)
- from soliciting, offering, issuing, selling, purchasing or referring any contracts of reinsurance of any type (A) with any of St. Paul's affiliates, (B) in connection with St. Paul's run-off business or renewals thereof or (C) in connection with finite business covered by any of the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements or which Platinum and its subsidiaries declines to reinsure.
Transfer Restrictions. The Formation and Separation Agreement provides that, except in connection with any tender or exchange offer made to all holders of Common Shares and certain other situations, St. Paul may not transfer more than 9.9% of all of the outstanding Common Shares owned by St. Paul to any person that generated 50% or more of its gross revenues in the most recent fiscal year for which financial statements are available by writing property or casualty insurance or reinsurance.
Pre-Emptive Rights. The Formation and Separation Agreement provides that if Platinum Holdings proposes to issue (a "Dilutive Transaction") any Common Shares or any securities convertible into, exchangeable for or carrying in any way the right to acquire Common Shares, St. Paul will have the right to subscribe for up to such number of new securities of Platinum Holdings as is necessary to maintain St. Paul's beneficial ownership interest in Platinum Holdings at the same percentage owned immediately prior to the Dilutive Transaction. The precise number of New Securities to be issued to St. Paul will be rounded up to the nearest round lot number. St. Paul has the right to register any Common Shares acquired by it pursuant to such pre-emptive rights in accordance with the provisions of the Registration Rights Agreement described under "—Registration Rights Agreement with St. Paul".
St. Paul will have no preemptive rights with respect to any new securities issued pursuant to any director or employee benefit plans of Platinum Holdings or any acquisition transaction engaged in by Platinum Holdings. St. Paul's pre-emptive rights to subscribe for new securities will terminate at the time St. Paul beneficially owns less than 10% of Platinum Holdings' outstanding Common Shares. Furthermore, St. Paul will have no pre-emptive rights with respect to any proposed Dilutive Transaction if (1) in an underwritten public offering, the underwriters request a reduction of the number of new securities to be issued; (2) a nationally recognized investment bank mutually agreed by Platinum Holdings and St. Paul advises St. Paul and Platinum Holdings in writing to the effect that exercising St. Paul's pre-emptive rights would materially hinder or interfere with the proposed Dilutive Transaction. In addition, St. Paul will have no pre-emptive rights in the event of an issuance of Common Shares upon the conversion or exchange of new securities with respect to the issuance which St. Paul had pre-emptive rights. In addition, St. Paul will have no preemptive rights to subscribe for new securities if the ownership thereof would cause St. Paul to be a "United States 25% Shareholder". See "Description of our Common Shares—Restrictions on Transfer".
Share Buy-Back Programs. The Formation and Separation Agreement provides that if Platinum Holdings repurchases its Common Shares (and if applicable, new securities as specified above under "—Pre-Emptive Rights") in accordance with a repurchase program approved by Platinum Holdings' board of directors, then St. Paul must sell to Platinum Holdings, on each day on which any Common Shares are so repurchased at a price equal to the average price of repurchases by Platinum Holdings on such day, that number of Common Shares which is necessary to limit St. Paul's beneficial ownership interest in Platinum Holdings to no more than 24.9% of the outstanding Common Shares after all such repurchases. St. Paul may require that any repurchases from it by Platinum Holdings must be at the average purchase price of any repurchases effected by Platinum Holdings on such day pursuant to Rule 10b-18 under the Exchange Act.
114
Quota Share Retrocession Agreements
Subject to the completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, St. Paul and its subsidiaries will transfer the benefits and risks under the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts to our insurance company subsidiaries through several 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreements. All the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements will take effect as of 12:01 a.m. on the later of the business day immediately following the date of the completion of the Public Offering or July 1, 2002. Accordingly, while St. Paul will be contractually committed to effect the transfer, the effective time of the transfer of the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts will occur after the investors purchase Common Shares in this offering. The transfer of all other assets will take place on the date of completion of the Public Offering.
The Quota Share Retrocession Agreements will provide for certain insurance subsidiaries of St. Paul to transfer to us a negotiated amount of all of the existing loss and allocated loss adjustment expense, unearned premium and other related reserves as of the date of the transfer and 100% of future premiums (less any ceding commission) associated with the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts relating to periods after the date of the transfer. With respect to certain non-traditional contracts of reinsurance, a portion of the future premium will be applied to settle balances related to prior year experience for the benefit of St. Paul. Also with respect to certain other non-traditional contracts of reinsurance, St. Paul will cede losses in excess of profit balances related to prior year experience. We will indemnify St. Paul for any unpaid losses, loss adjustment expenses and other payment obligations incurred by St. Paul under the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts on or after January 1, 2002 and prior to the date of the transfer. We will also assume liability for 100% of all future loss, loss adjustment expense and other payment obligations that arise under the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts on and after the date of the transfer. St. Paul will retain all of its reinsurance exposure not being transferred to us including any related punitive damages. The Quota Share Retrocession Agreements provide, with limited exceptions, that retrocessional reinsurance purchased by St. Paul Re in respect of the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts shall inure to our benefit and shall be at our expense.
Underwriting Management Agreements
For the period of one year following the completion of the Public Offering, we will have the right to underwrite specified reinsurance business on behalf of St. Paul, and in the case of business written in the U.K. St. Paul will continue to write such business, and we will reinsure such business pursuant to the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements. This will allow us to participate in reinsurance business which is bound after the completion of the Public Offering without any delay occasioned by the start-up of our operations, including the lack of required licenses, and facilitate the transition of St. Paul Re's business to us.
For a period of three years following the completion of the Public Offering, we will underwrite on behalf of St. Paul Re renewals of in-force contracts of finite reinsurance. St. Paul Re will retrocede to us 100% of the unpaid losses under currently in-force contracts and we will have the option to reinsure losses under renewed contracts for a retrocession premium pursuant to the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements. Under the Quota Share Retrocession Agreements, a portion of future premiums will be applied to settle balances related to prior year experience. St. Paul will have an option to renew this arrangement with us for a subsequent period of two years.
UK Business Transfer Agreement
Subject to the completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, St. Paul Reinsurance Company Limited ("St. Paul Re UK") and Platinum UK will enter into a UK Business Transfer Agreement under which Platinum UK will, as of the date of completion of the Public Offering, acquire the requisite infrastructure and take over the relevant personnel of St. Paul Re UK in order to act as the underwriting agent of St. Paul Re UK for a period of one year after the
115
completion of the Public Offering. The agreement also provides that, as and when Platinum UK is authorized to carry on insurance business in the United Kingdom, Platinum UK will be entitled to assume and carry on the continuing reinsurance business of St. Paul Re UK.
Master Services Agreements
Effective as of the completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, we expect to enter into Master Services Agreements with St. Paul and certain of its subsidiaries for the provision by St. Paul of certain services for a transitional period of time. The principal services to be covered by these agreements include accounting, payroll administration, human resources management and systems support. The services will be provided as long as we deem necessary, but no later than March 31, 2003, although the provision of particular services may be extended on a case-by-case basis. The services are to be provided at St. Paul's cost.
Run-off Services Agreements
Effective as of the completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, we will enter into Run-off Services Agreements with St. Paul and certain of its subsidiaries under which we will, for a period of up to two years following completion of the Public Offering, provide St. Paul with specified services in administering the run-off of the reinsurance contracts entered into by St. Paul's insurance subsidiaries prior to January 1, 2002 and not reinsured by us and of the Assumed Reinsurance Contracts. The services are to be provided at our cost.
Employee Benefits and Compensation Matters Agreements
Effective upon the completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, Platinum US will enter into an Employee Benefits and Compensation Matters Agreement with St. Paul that provides for the transfer of our employees from St. Paul and provides for the allocation of assets and liabilities and certain other agreements with respect to employee compensation and benefits plans. Pursuant to the agreement, all eligible employees of Platinum US will continue to participate, through December 31, 2002 in certain St. Paul welfare and fringe benefit plans on the same basis as if they had remained St. Paul employees, after which the employees will participate in employee benefit plans established and maintained by Platinum US. Platinum US will be responsible for the costs of providing this continuation coverage to eligible Platinum US employees under the welfare and fringe benefit plans in accordance with the terms of a letter agreement to be entered into between St. Paul and Platinum US.
Each Platinum US employee who participated in the St. Paul 401(k) plan or the St. Paul Stock Ownership Plan prior to the completion of the Public Offering will receive employer matching contributions under each plan through June 30, 2002 and all matching contributions, as well as performance share awards under The St. Paul Stock Ownership Plan, will be fully vested as of the completion of the Public Offering. Following the completion of the Public Offering, the Platinum US defined contribution plan will accept the rollover of eligible rollover distributions from the St. Paul 401(k) plan and the St. Paul Stock Ownership Plan.
For purposes of the St. Paul stock option plans, transfer of an employee's employment from St. Paul to Platinum US will be deemed to be a termination of employment. All St. Paul stock options held by Platinum US employees that are vested as of the completion of the Public Offering will be exercisable in accordance with their terms and the relevant stock option plan. All stock options held by Platinum US employees that are unvested as of the completion of the Public Offering will terminate as of the completion of the Public Offering; and each such Platinum US employee will be entitled to receive, for each unvested stock option that otherwise would have vested during the period from the date of completion of the Public Offering through the second anniversary of such date, a cash payment from us (to be reimbursed to us by St. Paul) on each date an option otherwise would have vested equal to the number of shares subject to the employee's options that
116
otherwise would have vested on such vesting date, multiplied by the spread between the exercise price per share and the closing price per share of the common stock of St. Paul on the date of completion of the Public Offering, provided the employee is still employed by Platinum US as of each such date. All unvested St. Paul restricted stock held by Platinum US employees that otherwise would have vested during the period from the date of completion of the Public Offering through the first anniversary of such date, will vest immediately prior to the date of completion of the Public Offering. All other St. Paul restricted stock that is unvested as of the date of completion of the Public Offering will terminate as of such date and be of no further force and effect.
Each Platinum US employee who is a participant in the St. Paul tax-qualified defined benefit pension plan or is a participant in the St. Paul retiree health plan as of the date of completion of the Public Offering and who is (i) within two years of satisfying the minimum retirement eligibility requirements of the pension plan (or the minimum requirement to receive retiree health or life insurance benefits in the case of the retiree health plan) or (ii) is at least 50 years old and has a minimum of 20 years of credited service under the plan, will receive additional age and service credit under the corresponding plan for service provided to Platinum US and its affiliates following the date of completion of the Public Offering as if such service had been with St. Paul in an amount equal to only the amount of additional age and service credit each such employee needs to meet the minimum retirement eligibility requirements under the pension plan (and the minimum requirement to receive retiree health and life insurance benefits under the retiree health plan). The Platinum US defined contribution plan will accept the rollover of eligible rollover distributions from the St. Paul defined benefit pension plan, including amounts credited for retiree medical under the cash balance portion of the St. Paul defined benefit pension plan.
Each Platinum US employee who, as of the date of completion of the Public Offering, is a participant in the portion of the St. Paul Benefit Equalization Plan (the "BEP") that provides benefits that otherwise would have been provided under the St. Paul defined benefit plan if not for limitations of the Internal Revenue Code and who is (i) within two years of satisfying the minimum retirement eligibility requirements of the BEP or (ii) is at least 50 years old and has a minimum of 20 years of credited service under the BEP will receive additional age and service credit under the BEP for service provided to Platinum US and its affiliates following the date of completion of the Public Offering as if such service had been with St. Paul in an amount equal to only the amount of additional age and service credit each such employee needs to meet the minimum retirement eligibility requirements under the BEP.
In addition, St. Paul will reimburse Platinum US for the annual bonus each of the eligible Platinum US employees would have been eligible to receive based on actual St. Paul performance based on 100% of 2001 bonus targets and prorated for the period from January 1, 2002 through the date of completion of the Public Offering, provided that each such employee is employed by Platinum US on the date that 2002 annual bonuses are paid. Platinum US will also adopt the St. Paul's Enhanced Severance Program and will keep the program in effect for St. Paul Re employees transferred to Platinum US for 90 days following the date of completion and St. Paul will remain liable for the expense of each eligible Platinum US employee who is terminated during the 90-day period based on such employee's accrued service and salary through the date of completion of the Public Offering. St. Paul has also agreed to continue in effect its Enhanced Severance Program for 90 days following the Public Offering for all St. Paul Re employees whose employment is not transferred to Platinum US. St. Paul also agrees to honor and remain liable for all existing retention obligations entered into between St. Paul Re employees and to recognize for purposes of the retention obligations, service provided to Platinum US following the date of completion of the Public Offering.
St. Paul shall generally retain all liabilities with respect to any employee benefit plan, program, policy or arrangement maintained by St. Paul for the benefit of St. Paul Re employees (including St. Paul Re employees who become employees of Platinum US), any other liabilities of any nature
117
whatsoever relating to such persons that relate to the periods on or prior to the completion of the Public Offering or any other liabilities of any nature whatsoever relating to St. Paul Re employees who do not become Platinum US employees that relate to any period before or after such date.
Transitional Trademark License Agreements
Effective as of the completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, we will enter into several Transitional Trademark License Agreements with St. Paul (or subsidiaries of St. Paul) under which we will be granted a royalty-free, limited, non-sublicensable (except to our operating subsidiaries), non-transferable, exclusive license to use certain St. Paul trademarks and service marks in connection with our reinsurance business for one year after completion of the Public Offering. Under these agreements, St. Paul will retain exclusive ownership of these marks, and we will be permitted to sublicense our operating subsidiaries to use them.
Registration Rights Agreement with St. Paul
Effective as of the completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, Platinum Holdings will enter into a registration rights agreement with St. Paul. Under this agreement, commencing one year after the completion of the Public Offering, St. Paul will have the right to require us, subject to specified exceptions, on four occasions, to register under the 1933 Act any Common Shares owned by St. Paul or its affiliates for sale in a public offering. From and after the fifth anniversary after the completion of the Public Offering, St. Paul will have the right to an additional two demand registrations if St. Paul beneficially owns more than 9.9% of the Common Shares then outstanding.
St. Paul may not require Platinum Holdings to effect more than one demand registration per 12-month period, and St. Paul must include a number of Common Shares in each demand registration that is equal to an amount of at least $50 million, except that this limitation shall not apply to St. Paul's last demand registration. If we propose to file a registration statement covering Common Shares at any time, St. Paul will have the right to include Common Shares held by it or its affiliates (including shares obtainable pursuant to the St. Paul Ownership Option or the St. Paul Participation Option) in the registration, in each case on a second-priority basis pro-rata with any shareholders with Platinum Holdings including its shares on a first-priority basis.
Sublease Agreements
Effective as of the completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, we will enter into various sublease agreements or assignments of lease with St. Paul or one of its subsidiaries under which we will rent office space in New York (until January 30, 2003), London (until September 30, 2009), Chicago (until August 31, 2005), Miami (until November 30, 2006) and Tokyo (until June 30, 2003). See "Business—Our Business—Our Facilities".
Option Agreement
Effective as of the completion of the Public Offering, Platinum Holdings will enter into an option agreement with St. Paul, which will give St. Paul two separate options to purchase additional Common Shares under the circumstances described below.
The St. Paul Ownership Option
If the initial public offering price per Common Share is equal to or greater than $25 per Common Share, St. Paul will acquire 13,262,300 Common Shares pursuant to the St. Paul Investment. St. Paul's ownership interest in Platinum Holdings will then represent approximately 24.9% of the Common Shares outstanding after the completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment. If the initial public offering price of the Common Shares is less than $25 per
118
Common Share, the number of Common Shares issued to St. Paul in the St. Paul Investment will be reduced pro rata so that St. Paul would obtain 10,062,300 Common Shares or approximately 20.1% of the Common Shares outstanding after the completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment at an initial public offering price of $23 per share. In the event the underwriters' option to purchase an additional 6,000,000 Common Shares is exercised, St. Paul will be issued (as part of the consideration for the Transferred Business) in the aggregate up to an additional 1,989,300 shares in order to maintain the proportionate initial share ownership in the Company it obtained prior to the underwriters exercising their option.
The St. Paul Ownership Option will be issued to St. Paul only if and to the extent St. Paul acquires less than an approximate 24.9% of the Common Shares outstanding after the completion of the Offering. This option is intended to provide St. Paul the right to acquire such number of Common Shares, as resulted from the reduction in the number of Common Shares issued to St. Paul at the time of the Public Offering as described in the previous paragraph. At an assumed initial public offering price of $23 per share, the option would cover 3,200,000 Common Shares, or 3,680,000 Common Shares if the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares is exercised in full. The exercise price per share under the St. Paul Ownership Option is the initial public offering price per share.
The St. Paul Ownership Option is exercisable, at an exercise price equal to the initial public offering price for the Common Shares, in whole or in part at any time prior to the tenth anniversary of the completion of the Public Offering.
St. Paul has agreed with Platinum Holdings that prior to any exercise of the St. Paul Ownership Option, it will dispose of a sufficient number of Common Shares so that, immediately after exercise of the St. Paul Ownership Option, St. Paul will not be a "United States 25% Shareholder". See "Description of our Common Shares—Restrictions on Transfer".
The St. Paul Ownership Option provides that it may be transferred by St. Paul (1) in the event of an amalgamation of Platinum Holdings with or merger of Platinum Holdings into another person, or a sale, transfer or lease of all or substantially all the assets of Platinum Holdings to another person; provided, that such transfer is to a person which is a shareholder, partner or other affiliated person of the person entering into such transaction with Platinum Holdings or (2) at any time on or after the second anniversary of the date of completion of the Public Offering to up to three institutional investors, subject to certain conditions set forth therein.
The St. Paul Participation Option
The St. Paul Participation Option entitles St. Paul to purchase up to 2 million Common Shares at an exercise price of 130% of the initial public offering price for the Common Shares. The St. Paul Participation Option is exercisable in whole or in part at any time after the second, and prior to the tenth, anniversary of the completion of the Public Offering.
St. Paul has agreed with Platinum Holdings that prior to any exercise of the St. Paul Participation Option, it will dispose of a sufficient number of Common Shares so that, immediately after exercise of the St. Paul Participation Option, St. Paul will not be a "United States 25% Shareholder". See "Description of our Common Shares—Restrictions on Transfer".
The St. Paul Participation Option provides that it may be transferred by St. Paul (1) in the event of an amalgamation of Platinum Holdings with or merger of Platinum Holdings into another person, or a sale, transfer or lease of all or substantially all the assets of Platinum Holdings to another person; provided, that such transfer is to a person which is a shareholder, partner or other affiliated person of the person entering into such transaction with Platinum Holdings or (2) at any time on or after the second anniversary of the date of completion of the Public Offering to up to three institutional investors, subject to certain conditions set forth therein.
119
Transactions in Ordinary Course of Business with St. Paul
At present St. Paul Re does not provide a meaningful amount of reinsurance to St. Paul. After completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, we expect to compete for business from St. Paul on the same basis as other reinsurance companies, but only to the extent that we are able to conclude that securing that business would not cause us to be subject to the rules regarding "RPII" under the Code. For a discussion of those rules, see "Certain Tax Considerations—Taxation of Shareholders—United States Taxation of U.S. and Non-U.S. Shareholders—United States Shareholders—RPII Companies" below.
120
DESCRIPTION OF OUR COMMON SHARES
The following description of the share capital of Platinum Holdings summarizes certain provisions of Platinum Holdings' bye-laws. A copy of Platinum Holdings' bye-laws is filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of which this prospectus is a part. All references in this description to "we", "us", "our" and the "Company" refer to Platinum Holdings unless the context otherwise requires.
General
At the completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, our authorized share capital will consist of: (i) 135,000,000 Common Shares, par value $0.01 per share, of which up to 53,262,300 Common Shares will be outstanding (assuming the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares is not exercised and the initial public offering price is $25 per Common Share) and (ii) 25,000,000 preferred shares, par value $0.01 per share, none of which will be outstanding.
Common Shares
Holders of Common Shares have no pre-emptive, redemption, conversion or sinking fund rights, provided, however, that pursuant to the Formation and Separation Agreement, Platinum Holdings has granted St. Paul the pre-emptive rights specified therein. See "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Formation and Separation Agreement." Subject to the limitation on voting rights described below, holders of Common Shares are entitled to one vote per share on all matters submitted to a vote of holders of Common Shares. Most matters to be approved by holders of Common Shares require approval by a simple majority vote. The holders of at least 75% of the Common Shares voting in person or by proxy at a meeting must generally approve an amalgamation with another company. In addition, a resolution to remove our auditor before the expiration of his term of office must be approved by at least two-thirds of the votes cast at a meeting of the shareholders of the Company. The quorum for any meeting of our shareholders is two or more persons holding or representing more than 50% of the outstanding Common Shares. Our Board of Directors has the power to approve our discontinuation from Bermuda to another jurisdiction. The rights attached to any class of shares, common or preferred, may be varied with the consent in writing of the holders of at least three-fourths of the issued shares of that class or with the sanction of a resolution passed by a majority of the votes cast at a separate general meeting of the holders of the shares of the class in accordance with the Bermuda Companies Act.
In the event of a liquidation, dissolution or winding-up of the Company, the holders of Common Shares are entitled to share equally and ratably in the assets of the Company, if any, remaining after the payment of all debts and liabilities of the Company and the liquidation preference of any outstanding preferred shares. All outstanding Common Shares are fully paid and nonassessable. Authorized but unissued shares may, subject to any rights attaching to existing shares, be issued at any time and at the discretion of the Board of Directors without the approval of the shareholders of the Company with such rights, preferences and limitations as the Board may determine.
Limitation on Voting Rights
Each Common Share has one vote on a poll of the shareholders, except that, if and for as long as the number of issued Controlled Shares (as defined below) of any person would constitute 10% or more of the combined voting power of the issued Common Shares of the Company (after giving effect to any prior reduction in voting power as described below), each issued Controlled Share,
121
regardless of the identity of the registered holder thereof, will confer a fraction of a vote as determined by the following formula:
(T - - C) ÷ (9.1 × C)
Where: | (1) | "T" is the aggregate number of votes conferred by all the issued Common Shares immediately prior to that application of the Formula with respect to such issued Controlled Shares adjusted to take into account any prior reduction taken with respect to any issued Controlled Shares pursuant to the "sequencing provision" described below; and | ||
(2) | "C" is the number of issued Controlled Shares attributable to that person. "Controlled Shares" of any person refers to all Common Shares owned by that person, whether (i) directly, (ii) with respect to persons who are U.S. persons, by application of the attribution and constructive ownership rules of Sections 958(a) and 958(b) of the Code or (iii) beneficially, directly or indirectly, within the meaning of Section 13(d)(3) of the Exchange Act, and the rules and regulations thereunder. |
The formula will be applied successively as many times as may be necessary to ensure that no person will be a 10% Shareholder (as defined below) at any time (the "sequencing provision"). For the purposes of determining the votes exercisable by shareholders as of any date, the formula will be applied to the Common Shares of each shareholder in declining order based on the respective numbers of total Controlled Shares attributable to each shareholder. Thus, the formula will be applied first to the votes of Common Shares held by the shareholder to whom the largest number of total Controlled Shares is attributable and thereafter sequentially with respect to the shareholder with the next largest number of total Controlled Shares. In each case, calculations are made on the basis of the aggregate number of votes conferred by the issued Common Shares as of such date, as reduced by the application of the formula to any issued Common Shares of any shareholder with a larger number of total Controlled Shares as of such date. "10% Shareholder" means a person who owns, in the aggregate, (i) directly, (ii) with respect to persons who are U.S. persons, by application of the attribution and constructive ownership rules of Sections 958(a) and 958(b) of the Code or (iii) beneficially, directly or indirectly, within the meaning of Section 13(d)(3) of the Exchange Act, issued Common Shares of the Company carrying 10% or more of the total combined voting rights attaching to all issued Common Shares.
Because of the voting limitation described in the preceding paragraph, the Common Shares owned by St. Paul will have reduced voting rights. Should St. Paul dispose of some or all of the Common Shares it owns, the reduced voting rights with respect to the Common Shares disposed of by St. Paul will be eliminated (except if the disposition is to any other person who holds, or who as a result of such transaction would hold, 10% or more of our total voting rights), and those Common Shares thereafter will be entitled to full voting rights, subject to future dilution to avoid creating a 10% shareholder. Therefore, the voting power of the Common Shares held by all of our shareholders other than St. Paul will be diluted upon any such disposition by St. Paul. Although St. Paul has informed us that it currently intends to continue its share ownership of up to approximately 24.9% in Platinum Holdings for the foreseeable future, there can be no assurance in this regard.
Our directors are empowered to require any shareholder to provide information as to that shareholder's beneficial ownership of Common Shares, the names of persons having beneficial ownership of the shareholder's Common Shares, relationships, associations or affiliations with other shareholders or any other facts the directors may deem relevant to a determination of the number of Controlled Shares attributable to any person. Our directors may disregard the votes attached to the Common Shares of any holder failing to respond to such a request or submitting incomplete or untrue information.
122
Our directors retain certain discretion to make such final adjustments to the aggregate number of votes attaching to the Common Shares of any shareholder that they consider fair and reasonable in all the circumstances to ensure that no person will be a 10% Shareholder at any time.
Restrictions on Transfer
Our bye-laws contain several provisions restricting the transferability of Common Shares. The directors are required to decline to register a transfer of Common Shares if they have reason to believe that the result of such transfer would be (i) that any person other than a St. Paul Person would become or continue to be a 10% Shareholder or (ii) that a St. Paul Person would become or continue to be a United States 25% Shareholder, in each case without giving effect to the limitation on voting rights described above. Similar restrictions apply to the Company's ability to issue or repurchase Common Shares. "St. Paul Person" means any of St. Paul and its affiliates following the completion of the Public Offering and "United States 25% Shareholder" means a U.S. person who owns, directly or by application of the constructive ownership rules of Sections 958(a) and 958(b) of the Code, 25% or more of either (i) the total combined voting rights attaching to the issued Common Shares and the issued shares of any other class of the Company or (ii) the total combined value of the issued Common Shares and any other issued shares of the Company, determined pursuant to Section 957 of the Code.
Our directors also may, in their absolute discretion, decline to register the transfer of any Common Shares if they have reason to believe (i) that the transfer may expose us, any of our subsidiaries, any shareholder or any person ceding insurance to any of our subsidiaries to adverse tax or regulatory treatment in any jurisdiction or (ii) that registration of the transfer under the 1933 Act or under any U.S. state securities laws or under the laws of any other jurisdiction is required and such registration has not been duly effected. In addition, our directors may decline to approve or register a transfer of shares unless all applicable consents, authorizations, permissions or approvals of any governmental body or agency in Bermuda, the United States or any other applicable jurisdiction required to be obtained prior to such transfer shall have been obtained.
We are authorized to request information from any holder or prospective acquiror of Common Shares as necessary to give effect to the transfer, issuance and repurchase restrictions described above, and may decline to effect any transaction if complete and accurate information is not received as requested.
Conyers, Dill & Pearman, our Bermuda counsel, has advised us that while the precise form of the restrictions on transfer contained in our bye-laws is untested, as a matter of general principle, restrictions on transfers are enforceable under Bermuda law and are not uncommon. A proposed transferee will be permitted to dispose of any Common Shares purchased that violate the restrictions and as to the transfer of which registration is refused. The proposed transferor of those Common Shares will be deemed to own those Common Shares for dividend, voting and reporting purposes until a transfer of such Common Shares has been registered on the register of shareholders of the Company.
If the directors refuse to register a transfer for any reason, they must notify the proposed transferor and transferee within thirty days of such refusal. Our bye-laws also provide that our Board of Directors may suspend the registration of transfers for any reason and for such periods as it may determine, provided that it may not suspend the registration of transfers for more than 45 days in any period of 365 consecutive days.
Our directors may designate our Chief Executive Officer to exercise their authority to decline to register transfers or to limit voting rights as described above, or to take any other action, for as long as the Chief Executive Officer is also a director.
The voting restrictions and restrictions on transfer described above may have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control of us.
123
Preferred Shares
Pursuant to our bye-laws and Bermuda law, our Board of Directors by resolution may establish one or more series of preferred shares having a number of shares, designations, relative voting rights, dividend rates, liquidation and other rights, preferences, limitations and powers as may be fixed by the Board of Directors without any further shareholder approval which, if any preferred shares are issued, will include restrictions on voting and transfer intended to avoid having us constitute a "controlled foreign corporation" for U.S. federal income tax purposes. If our Board of Directors issues preferred shares conferring any voting rights, it will amend our bye-laws to apply the limitations on the voting rights discussed above under "—Limitation on Voting Rights" to those preferred shares. Any rights, preferences, powers and limitations as may be established could also have the effect of discouraging an attempt to obtain control of the Company. The issuance of preferred shares could also adversely affect the voting power of the holders of our Common Shares, deny such holders the receipt of a premium on their Common shares in the event of a tender or other offer for the Common Shares and depress the market price of the Common Shares. We have no current plans to issue any preferred shares.
Bye-laws
Our bye-laws provide for our corporate governance, including the establishment of share rights, modification of those rights, issuance of share certificates, imposition of a lien over shares in respect of unpaid amounts on those shares, calls on shares which are not fully paid, forfeiture of shares, the transfer of shares, alterations of capital, the calling and conduct of general meetings, proxies, the appointment and removal of directors, conduct and power of directors, the payment of dividends, the appointment of an auditor and our winding-up.
Our bye-laws provide that our Board of Directors shall be elected annually and shall not be staggered. Shareholders may only remove a director for cause prior to the expiration of that director's term at a special meeting of shareholders at which a majority of the holders of shares voting thereon vote in favor of that action.
Our bye-laws also provide that if our Board of Directors in its absolute discretion determines that share ownership by any shareholder may result in adverse tax, regulatory or legal consequences to us, any of our subsidiaries or any other shareholder, then we will have the option, but not the obligation, to repurchase all or part of the shares held by such shareholder to the extent the Board of Directors determines it is necessary to avoid such adverse or potential adverse consequences. The price to be paid for such shares will be the fair market value of such shares.
Platinum Holdings' bye-laws and those of Platinum Bermuda and Platinum UK provide that matters required to be submitted to a vote of the shareholders of any of the direct or indirect non-U.S. subsidiaries of Platinum Holdings are required to be submitted to Platinum Holdings' shareholders and the shareholders of such subsidiaries are required to vote the subsidiaries' shares in accordance with and in proportion to the vote of Platinum Holdings' shareholders.
Transfer Agent
Our registrar and transfer agent for the Common Shares is Mellon Investor Services LLC.
Differences in Corporate Law
The Companies Act differs in certain material respects from laws generally applicable to U.S. corporations and their shareholders. Set forth below is a summary of certain significant provisions of the Companies Act (including modifications adopted pursuant to our bye-laws) applicable to us, which differ in certain respects from provisions of Delaware corporate law, which is the law that governs many U.S. public companies. The following statements are summaries, and do not purport to deal with all aspects of Bermuda law that may be relevant to us and our shareholders.
124
Interested Directors. Our bye-laws provide that transactions we enter into in which a director has an interest are not voidable by us, nor can the interested director be liable to us for any profit realized pursuant to such transactions, provided the nature of the interest is disclosed at the first opportunity at a meeting of directors, or in writing to the directors. Under Delaware law, such a transaction would not be voidable if (i) the material facts as to the interested director's relationship or interests are disclosed or are known to the board of directors and the board in good faith authorized the transaction by the affirmative vote of a majority of the disinterested directors, even though the disinterested directors constitute less than a quorum, (ii) the material facts as to the director's relationship or interest and as to the transaction are disclosed or are known to the shareholders entitled to vote on the transaction and the transaction is specifically approved in good faith by vote of the shareholders or (iii) the transaction is fair to the corporation as of the time it is authorized, approved or ratified by the board of directors, a committee of the board of directors or the shareholders. Under Delaware law, the interested director could he held liable for a transaction in which that director derived an improper personal benefit.
Mergers and Similar Arrangements. We may acquire the business of another Bermuda company or a company incorporated outside Bermuda and carry on such business when it is within the objects of our memorandum of association. In the case of an amalgamation, we may amalgamate with another Bermuda company or with an entity incorporated outside Bermuda. A shareholder who did not vote in favor of the amalgamation may apply to a Bermuda court for a proper valuation of his or her shares if he or she is not satisfied that fair value has been offered for those shares. The court ordinarily would not disapprove the transaction on that ground absent evidence of fraud or bad faith. Under Delaware law, with certain exceptions, a merger, consolidation or sale of all or substantially all the assets of a corporation must be approved by the board of directors and the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares entitled to vote thereon. Under Delaware law, a stockholder of a corporation participating in certain major corporate transactions may, under certain circumstances, be entitled to appraisal rights pursuant to which the stockholder may receive cash in the amount of the fair value of the shares held by that stockholder (as determined by a court) in lieu of the consideration that stockholder would otherwise receive in the transaction. Delaware law does not provide stockholders of a corporation with voting or appraisal rights when the corporation acquires another business through the issuance of its stock or other consideration (i) in exchange for the assets of the business to be acquired, (ii) in exchange for the outstanding stock of the corporation to be acquired; (iii) in a merger of the corporation to be acquired with a subsidiary of the acquiring corporation or (iv) in a merger in which the corporation's certificate of incorporation is not amended and the corporation issues less than 20% of its common stock outstanding prior to the merger.
Takeovers. Bermuda law provides that where an offer is made for shares of another company and, within four months of the offer, the holders of not less than 90% of the shares which are the subject of the offer (other than shares held by or for the offeror or its subsidiaries) accept, the offeror may by notice require the nontendering shareholders to transfer their shares on the terms of the offer. Dissenting shareholders may apply to the court within one month of the notice objecting to the transfer. The burden is on the dissenting shareholders to show that the court should exercise its discretion to enjoin the required transfer, which the court will be unlikely to do unless the offer is obviously and convincingly unfair. Delaware law provides that a parent corporation, by resolution of its board of directors and without any shareholder vote, may merge with any subsidiary of which it owns at least 90% of the outstanding shares of each class of stock that is entitled to vote on the transaction. Upon any such merger, dissenting stockholders of the subsidiary would have appraisal rights.
Shareholder's Suit. The rights of shareholders under Bermuda law are not as extensive as the rights of shareholders under legislation or judicial precedent in many U.S. jurisdictions. Class actions and derivative actions are generally not available to shareholders under the laws of
125
Bermuda. However, the Bermuda courts ordinarily would be expected to follow English case law precedent, which would permit a shareholder to commence an action in our name to remedy a wrong done to us where the act complained of is alleged to be beyond our corporate power or is illegal or would result in the violation of our memorandum of association or bye-laws. Furthermore, consideration would be given by the court to acts that are alleged to constitute a fraud against the minority shareholders or where an act requires the approval of a greater percentage of shareholders than actually approved it. The winning party in such an action generally would be able to recover a portion of attorneys' fees incurred in connection with such action. Class actions and derivative actions generally are available to stockholders under Delaware law for, among other things, breach of fiduciary duty, corporate waste and actions not taken in accordance with applicable law. In such actions, the court has discretion to permit the winning party to recover attorneys' fees incurred in connection with such action.
Indemnification of Directors. Our bye-laws indemnify our directors and officers in their capacity as such in respect of any loss arising or liability attaching to them by virtue of any rule of law in respect of any negligence, default, breach of duty or breach of trust of which a director or officer may be guilty in relation to us other than in respect of his own fraud or dishonesty. Under Delaware law, a corporation may indemnify a director or officer of the corporation against expenses (including attorneys' fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred in defense or an action, suit or proceeding by reason of such position if (i) the director or officer acted in good faith and in a manner he reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation and (ii) with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, if the director or officer had no reasonable cause to believe his conduct was unlawful.
Inspection of Corporate Records. Members of the general public have the right to inspect our public documents available at the office of the Registrar of Companies in Bermuda, which will include our memorandum of association (including our objects and powers) and alterations to our memorandum of association, including any increase or reduction of our authorized capital. Our shareholders have the additional right to inspect our bye-laws, minutes of general meetings and our audited financial statements, which must be presented to the annual general meeting of shareholders. Our register of shareholders is also open to inspection by shareholders without charge, and to members of the public for a fee. We are required to maintain a share register in Bermuda but may establish a branch register outside Bermuda. We are required to keep at our registered office a register of our directors and officers which is open for inspection by members of the public without charge. Bermuda law does not, however, provide a general right for shareholders to inspect or obtain copies of any other corporate records. Delaware law permits any stockholder to inspect or obtain copies of a corporation's stockholder list and its other books and records for any purpose reasonably related to such person's interest as a stockholder.
Enforcement of Judgments and Other Matters. We have been advised by Conyers, Dill & Pearman, our Bermuda counsel, that there is doubt as to whether the courts of Bermuda would enforce (1) judgments of United States courts obtained in actions against us or our directors and officers, as well as the experts named in this prospectus who reside outside the United States predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the United States federal securities laws and (2) original actions brought in Bermuda against us or our directors and officers, as well as the experts named in this prospectus who reside outside the United States predicated solely upon United States federal securities laws. There is no treaty in effect between the United States and Bermuda providing for such enforcement, and there are grounds upon which Bermuda courts may not enforce judgments of United States courts. Certain remedies available under the laws of U.S. jurisdictions, including certain remedies available under the U.S. federal securities laws, would not be allowed in Bermuda courts as contrary to Bermuda's public policy.
126
SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
Prior to the Public Offering, there has been no public market for the Common Shares, and no predictions can be made as to the effect, if any, that market sales of Common Shares or the availability of Common Shares for sale will have on the market price prevailing from time to time. Public or private sales of substantial amounts of Common Shares, or the perception that such sales could take place, may adversely affect prevailing market prices of the Common Shares as well as the ability of the Company to raise additional capital in the public equity markets at a desirable time and price.
Upon completion of the Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment, Platinum Holdings will have outstanding up to 53,262,300 Common Shares (assuming the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares is not exercised), 40,000,000 of which will have been sold in the Public Offering and up to 13,262,300 of which will have been issued in the St. Paul Investment as described under "St. Paul Investment and Principal Shareholders". In the event the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares is exercised in full, St. Paul will be issued (as part of the consideration for the Transferred Business) in the aggregate up to 1,989,300 Common Shares in order to maintain its proportionate initial share ownership in Platinum Holdings at the level it obtained prior to the underwriters exercising their option to purchase additional Common Shares. As a result, if the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares is exercised in full and St. Paul is issued these additional Common Shares, there would be outstanding up to an additional 7,989,300 Common Shares. The Common Shares sold in the Public Offering will be freely transferable without restriction or further registration under the 1933 Act, except for any of those Common Shares owned at any time by an "affiliate" of the Company within the meaning of Rule 144 under the 1933 Act (which sales will be subject to volume limitations and certain other restrictions). The Common Shares issued in the St. Paul Investment will be deemed "restricted securities" as defined in Rule 144 under the 1933 Act and may not be resold in the absence of registration under the 1933 Act or pursuant to an exemption from such registration, including the exemption provided by Rule 144 under the 1933 Act.
In connection with the St. Paul Investment, Platinum Holdings granted St. Paul the right to require the registration of its Common Shares under the 1933 Act. See "Certain Relationship and Related Transactions—Registration Rights Agreement with St. Paul".
Platinum Holdings, its officers and directors, and St. Paul have agreed with the underwriters not to dispose of or hedge any of their Common Shares or securities convertible into or exchangeable for Common Shares during the period from the date of this prospectus continuing through the date 180 days after the date of this prospectus, except with the prior written consent of Goldman, Sachs & Co. This agreement does not apply to any existing employee benefit plans.
The following discussion of the taxation of Platinum Holdings, Platinum US, Platinum UK, Platinum Bermuda and Platinum Ireland and the taxation of our shareholders is based upon current law. Legislative, judicial or administrative changes may occur which could affect this discussion, possibly on a retroactive basis. The discussion does not address special classes of shareholders, such as shareholders that own directly, or through the constructive ownership rules of the Code, 10% or more of the voting power or value of Platinum Holdings. Except for matters where it is explicitly stated that we will not receive an opinion of counsel, the statements as to United States federal income tax law set forth below represent the opinion of Sullivan & Cromwell, our U.S. counsel, as to such tax laws (subject to the qualifications and assumptions set forth in such statements). The statements as to Bermuda tax law set forth below represent the opinion of Conyers, Dill & Pearman, our Bermuda counsel, as to such tax laws (subject to the qualifications and assumptions set forth in such statements). The statements as to U.K. tax law set forth below
127
represent the opinion of Slaughter and May, our U.K. counsel, as to such tax laws (subject to the qualifications and assumptions set forth in such statements). The statements as to Irish tax law set forth below represent the opinion of A. & L. Goodbody, our Irish counsel, as to such tax laws (subject to the qualifications and assumptions set forth in such statements). You are urged to consult your tax advisor as to the tax consequences of ownership and disposition of your Common Shares.
Taxation of the Company, Platinum US, Platinum UK,
Platinum Bermuda and Platinum Ireland
Bermuda
Under current Bermuda law, there is no income tax, capital gains or withholding tax payable by us or Platinum Bermuda. We and Platinum Bermuda expect, by the time of completion of the Public Offering, to have received from the Bermuda Minister of Finance a standard assurance under Bermuda's Exempted Undertakings Tax Protection Act 1966, to the effect that in the event any legislation is enacted in Bermuda imposing any tax computed on profits or income, or computed on any capital asset, gain or appreciation, or any tax in the nature of estate duty or inheritance tax, then the imposition of any such tax shall not be applicable to us, Platinum Bermuda, or to any of their operations or the shares, debentures or our other obligations or those of Platinum Bermuda, until 2016, in the case of both Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda. This assurance is subject to the proviso that it is not construed so as to prevent the application of any tax or duty to such persons as are ordinarily resident in Bermuda (Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda are not currently so affected) or to prevent the application of any tax payable in accordance with the provisions of the Land Tax Act 1967 of Bermuda or otherwise payable in relation to the property leased to us or Platinum Bermuda. Upon completion of the Public Offering, Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda, under current rates, will pay annual Bermuda government fees of BD $27,825 and BD $3,635, respectively, and Platinum Bermuda currently pays annual insurance fees of BD $16,540.
United States Federal Income Taxation
We intend to structure and operate Platinum Holdings, Platinum UK, Platinum Bermuda and Platinum Ireland in such a manner that they will not be considered to be conducting business within the U.S. for purposes of U.S. federal income taxation. Whether business is being conducted in the U.S. is an inherently factual determination depending on such matters as (i) the size and substance of the offices of our non-U.S. subsidiaries, (ii) whether employees of non-U.S. subsidiaries make binding decisions while physically present in the U.S., (iii) the number of employees permanently located in the offices of our non-U.S. subsidiaries, and the levels of their managerial importance and (iv) the situs of meetings of the boards of directors of our non-U.S. subsidiaries. Because of the entirely factual nature of these matters and because definitive identification of activities which constitute being engaged in a trade or business in the U.S. is not provided by the Code or regulations or court decisions, counsel will not render an opinion regarding conducting business in the U.S. The IRS might successfully contend that Platinum Holdings, Platinum UK, Platinum Bermuda and/or Platinum Ireland is engaged in a trade or business in the U.S. A foreign corporation deemed to be engaged in a U.S. trade or business is subject to U.S. federal income tax, as well as branch profits tax in certain circumstances, on its income which is treated as effectively connected with the conduct of that trade or business unless the corporation is entitled to relief under the permanent establishment provision of an applicable tax treaty, as discussed below. Such income tax, if imposed, would be based on effectively connected income computed in a manner generally analogous to that applied to the income of a domestic corporation, except that a foreign corporation is entitled to deductions and credits only if it files a U.S. income tax return. Under regulations, the foreign corporation would be entitled to deductions
128
and credits for the taxable year only if the return for that year is timely filed under rules, set forth therein. Penalties may be assessed for failure to file tax returns. Platinum Holdings, Platinum UK, Platinum Bermuda and Platinum Ireland do intend to file protective U.S. federal income tax returns. The federal tax rates currently are a maximum of 35% for a corporation's effectively connected income and 30% for branch profits tax. The branch profits tax is imposed on net income after subtracting the regular corporate tax and making certain other adjustments.
Under the income tax treaty between Bermuda and the U.S., Platinum Bermuda is subject to United States income tax on any income found to be effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business only if that trade or business is conducted through a permanent establishment in the U.S. No regulations interpreting the Bermuda Treaty have been issued. While there can be no assurance, we expect that Platinum Bermuda will not have a permanent establishment in the U.S. Platinum Bermuda will not be entitled to the benefits of the Bermuda treaty if:
- •
- 50% or less of Platinum Bermuda's stock is beneficially owned, directly or indirectly, by Bermuda residents or U.S. citizens or residents, or
- •
- Platinum Bermuda's income is used in substantial part to make disproportionate distributions to, or to meet certain liabilities to, persons who are not Bermuda residents or U.S. citizens or residents.
While there can be no assurance, we expect that Platinum Bermuda will be entitled to the benefits of the Bermuda treaty after the sale of Common Shares in this offering.
Under the current income tax treaty between the United Kingdom and the U.S., Platinum UK, if entitled to the benefits of the current U.K. treaty, will be subject to United States income tax on any income found to be effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business only if that trade or business is conducted through a permanent establishment in the U.S. No regulations interpreting the current U.K. treaty have been issued. While there can be no assurance, we expect that Platinum UK will not have a permanent establishment in the U.S. Platinum UK will generally be entitled to the benefits of the current U.K. treaty if it is managed and controlled in the United Kingdom, which we expect to be the case.
The U.S. and the United Kingdom have signed a new income tax treaty which is not yet in force. As with the current U.K. treaty, under the provisions of the new U.K. treaty, Platinum UK, if entitled to the benefits of the new U.K. treaty, will be subject to United States income tax on any income found to be effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business only if that trade or business is conducted through a permanent establishment in the U.S. Platinum UK will be entitled to the benefits of the new U.K. treaty if:
- •
- During at least half of the days during the relevant taxable period, at least 50% or more of Platinum UK's stock is beneficially owned, directly or indirectly, by citizens or residents of the U.S. and the U.K., and Platinum UK's income is not used in substantial part to make certain payments, or to meet certain liabilities to, persons who are not U.S. or U.K. residents; or
- •
- with respect to specific items of income, profit or gain derived from the U.S., if such income, profit or gain is considered to be derived in connection with, or incidental to, Platinum UK's business conducted in the U.K.
The new U.K. treaty will enter into force upon the exchange of instruments of ratification and will apply with respect to U.S. income taxes for taxable periods beginning on or after the first day of January next following the date on which the new U.K. treaty enters into force.
Under the income tax treaty between Ireland and the United States, Platinum Ireland is subject to United States income tax on any income determined to be effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business only if that trade or business is conducted through a permanent establishment in the U.S. Platinum Ireland will generally be entitled to the benefits of the Irish treaty if at least 50 percent
129
of the shares of Platinum Holdings, measured by both vote and value, are owned by U.S. citizens or residents. We expect that Platinum Ireland will be entitled to the benefits of the Irish treaty.
Foreign corporations not engaged in a trade or business in the U.S. are nonetheless subject to U.S. withholding tax at a rate of 30% of the gross amount of certain "fixed or determinable annual or periodical gains, profits and income" derived from sources within the U.S. (such as dividends and certain interest on investments), subject to reduction by applicable treaties. Dividends paid by Platinum US to Platinum Ireland will generally be subject to withholding at a rate of 5%, provided that Platinum Ireland is entitled to the benefits of the Irish treaty and certain other requirements are met.
The U.S. also imposes an excise tax on insurance and reinsurance premiums paid to foreign insurers or reinsurers with respect to risks located in the U.S. The rate of tax applicable to premiums paid to Platinum Bermuda is 1% for reinsurance premiums. The excise tax may not apply to premiums paid to Platinum UK, provided that Platinum UK is entitled to the benefits of the Current UK Treaty (or to the benefits of the New UK Treaty once that treaty comes into force) and certain other requirements are met.
Platinum US is a U.S. corporation, and will be subject to taxation in the U.S. at regular corporate rates.
The United Kingdom
Platinum UK is a U.K. resident company which will be subject to corporation tax in the United Kingdom on its worldwide profits. The current rate of U.K. taxation applicable to U.K. resident corporations is generally 30%. Currently, no U.K. withholding tax applies to dividends paid by Platinum UK.
Ireland
Platinum Ireland will be resident for tax purposes in Ireland and therefore subject to Irish corporate tax on its worldwide income. Dividends received by Platinum Ireland from Platinum US and Platinum UK will be subject to Irish corporation tax (at the current applicable rate of 25%) subject to any available relief under the double tax treaties Ireland has with the United Kingdom and the United States. Platinum Ireland will generally be entitled to the benefits of the Irish Treaty if at least 50% of the shares of Platinum Holdings, measured by both vote and value, are owned by U.S. citizens or residents. We expect that Platinum Ireland will be entitled to the benefits of the Irish Treaty. Assuming that Platinum Ireland is entitled to the benefits of the Irish Treaty, it will be entitled to a credit, against Irish corporation tax imposed on dividends from Platinum US, in respect of U.S. tax imposed on the profits out of which the dividends are declared. Under the existing tax treaty between Ireland and the United Kingdom, Platinum Ireland will also be entitled to a credit, against Irish corporation tax imposed on dividends from Platinum UK, in respect of U.K. tax imposed on the profits out of which the dividends are declared.
Platinum Ireland will be subject to Irish corporate tax on any trading income at a rate of 16%, which will be reduced to 12.5% as of January 1, 2003.
Platinum Ireland will be exempt from the capital duty of 1% (on the value of share capital issued by it) because it is an unlimited liability company.
Bermuda Taxation
Currently, there is no Bermuda withholding tax on dividends paid by us or Platinum Bermuda.
130
United States Taxation of U.S. and Non-U.S. Shareholders
United States Shareholders
General. In the opinion of Sullivan & Cromwell, our U.S. tax counsel, the following discussion sets forth the material U.S. federal income tax consequences relating to the acquisition, ownership and disposition of Common Shares if you are a beneficial owner of Common Shares and you are:
- •
- a citizen or resident of the U.S.;
- •
- a domestic corporation;
- •
- an estate whose income is subject to U.S. federal income tax regardless of its source; or
- •
- a trust if a U.S. court can exercise primary supervision over the trust's administration and one or more U.S. persons are authorized to control all substantial decisions of the trust.
This discussion applies to you only if you purchase your Common Shares in this offering and hold your Common Shares as capital assets. This discussion does not deal with the tax consequences applicable to all categories of investors, some of which (such as broker-dealers, investors who hold Common Shares as part of hedging or conversion transactions and investors whose functional currency is not the U.S. dollar) may be subject to special rules. Prospective investors are advised to consult their own tax advisers with respect to their particular circumstances and with respect to the effects of U.S. federal, state, local or other laws to which they may be subject.
Dividends. Distributions with respect to your Common Shares will be treated as ordinary dividend income to the extent of the Company's current or accumulated earnings and profits as determined for U.S. federal income tax purposes, subject to the discussion below relating to the potential application of the "controlled foreign corporation", "related person insurance income", or "passive foreign investment company" rules. Such dividends will not be eligible for the dividends-received deduction allowed to U.S. corporations under the Code. The amount of any distribution in excess of our current and accumulated earnings and profits will first be applied to reduce your tax basis in the Common Shares, and any amount in excess of tax basis will be treated as gain from the sale or exchange of your Common Shares.
Classification of Platinum Holdings, Platinum UK, Platinum Bermuda or Platinum Ireland as a Controlled Foreign Corporation. Each "United States shareholder" of a foreign corporation that is a "controlled foreign corporation" ("CFC") for an uninterrupted period of 30 days or more during a taxable year, and who owns shares in the CFC directly or indirectly through foreign entities on the last day of the CFC's taxable year must include in its gross income for U.S. federal income tax purposes its pro rata share of the CFC's "subpart F income", even if the subpart F income is not distributed. If Platinum Holdings, Platinum Bermuda, Platinum Ireland and/or Platinum UK is deemed to be a CFC, we anticipate that substantially all of Platinum Holdings' income and that of each of Platinum Bermuda and Platinum Ireland will be subpart F income. We expect that at least some of the income of Platinum UK will qualify for exceptions from subpart F income. Any U.S. corporation, citizen, resident or other U.S. person who owns, directly or indirectly through foreign persons, or is considered to own (by application of the rules of constructive ownership set forth in Code section 958(b), generally applying to family members, partnerships, estates, trusts or controlled corporations or holders of certain options) 10% or more of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock of the foreign corporation will be considered to be a "United States shareholder". In general, a foreign insurance company such as Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda is treated as a CFC only if such "United States shareholders" collectively own more than 25% of the total combined voting power or total value of the corporation's stock. We expect that, because of the limitations on concentration of voting power of our Common Shares, the dispersion of our share ownership among holders other than St. Paul and its subsidiaries, the provisions for directed
131
voting on matters requiring action by the shareholders of Platinum Bermuda and Platinum UK, including the election of members of the board of directors, and the restrictions on transfer, issuance or repurchase of Common Shares, you will not be subject to treatment as a United States shareholder of a CFC. In addition, because our bye-laws provide that no single shareholder (including St. Paul) is permitted to hold as much as 10% of the total combined voting power of Platinum Holdings, shareholders of Platinum Holdings should not be viewed as United States shareholders of a CFC for purposes of these rules. There can be no assurance, however, that these ownership limitations will be effective. Assuming they are effective, however, neither the indirect foreign tax credit nor the intercompany dividends received deduction attributable to U.S. source income will be available to U.S. corporate holders of the Common Shares who, absent such provision, would qualify therefor.
RPII Companies. Different definitions of "United States shareholder" and "controlled foreign corporation" are applicable in the case of a foreign corporation which earns "related person insurance income" ("RPII"). RPII is defined in Code section 953(c)(2) as any "insurance income" attributable to policies of insurance or reinsurance with respect to which the person (directly or indirectly) insured is a "United States shareholder" or a "related person" to such a shareholder. In general, and subject to certain limitations, "insurance income" is income (including premium and investment income) attributable to the issuing of any insurance or reinsurance contract in connection with risks located in a country other than the country under the laws of which the controlled foreign corporation is created or organized and which would be taxed under the portions of the Code relating to insurance companies if the income were the income of a domestic insurance company.
The term "related person" for this purpose means someone who controls or is controlled by the United States shareholder or someone who is controlled by the same person or persons which control the United States shareholder. "Control" is measured by either more than 50% in value or more than 50% in voting power of stock, applying constructive ownership principles similar to the rules of section 958 of the Code. A corporation's pension plan is ordinarily not a "related person" with respect to the corporation unless the pension plan owns, directly or indirectly through the application of constructive ownership rules similar to those contained in section 958, more than 50%, measured by vote or value, of the stock of the corporation. For purposes of inclusion of Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's RPII in the income of United States shareholders, unless an exception applies, the term "United States shareholder" includes all U.S. persons who own, directly or indirectly, any amount (rather than 10% or more) of Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's stock. Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda will be treated as a controlled foreign corporation for RPII purposes if such persons collectively own directly, indirectly or constructively 25% or more of the stock of Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda by vote or value. St. Paul will own up to approximately 24.9% of the Common Shares of Platinum Holdings upon completion of the offering. Accordingly, unless an exception applies, it is likely that Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda will each be treated as a CFC for purposes of the RPII rules.
RPII Exceptions. The special RPII rules do not apply if:
- •
- direct or indirect insureds and persons related to such insureds, whether or not U.S. persons, are treated at all times during the taxable year as owning less than 20% of the voting power and less than 20% of the value of the stock of Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda, as applicable,
- •
- RPII, determined on a gross basis, is less than 20% of Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's gross insurance income for the taxable year, as applicable,
132
- •
- Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda elects to be taxed on its RPII as if the RPII were effectively connected with the conduct of a United States trade or business and to waive all treaty benefits with respect to RPII and meets certain other requirements, or
- •
- Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda elects to be treated as a United States corporation.
Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda have not and do not intend to make either of the elections described immediately above. Additionally, as subsidiaries of St. Paul will be reinsured by Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda in 2002, and will likely be reinsured by Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda in future years, persons related to insureds will indirectly own more than 20% of the value of the stock of Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda. Thus, only the second exception may be available. Although each of Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda intends to operate in a manner such that such second exception shall apply, no assurance can be given that we will successfully qualify for such exception.
Where none of these exceptions applies, each U.S. person who owns directly or indirectly shares in Platinum Holdings (and therefore, indirectly in Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda) at the end of any taxable year, will be required to include in its gross income for United States federal income tax purposes its share of RPII of Platinum UK and/or Platinum Bermuda for the entire taxable year. This inclusion will be determined as if such RPII were distributed proportionately only to such United States shareholders holding Common Shares at the end of the taxable year. The inclusion will be limited to the current-year earnings and profits of Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda, as applicable, reduced by the shareholder's pro rata share, if any, of certain prior-year deficits in earnings and profits.
Computation of RPII. In order to determine how much RPII each of Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda has earned in each taxable year, we will obtain and rely upon information from Platinum UK's and Platinum Bermuda's insureds and reinsureds to determine whether any of the insureds, reinsureds or other persons related to such insureds or reinsureds own our shares and are U.S. persons. Each year, each of Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda will send a letter after the most recent taxable year to each person who was a policyholder to represent whether it was a United States shareholder of the Company or related to a United States shareholder during the year. For any taxable year in which Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's gross RPII is 20% or more of its gross insurance income for the year, we may also seek information from our shareholders as to whether direct or indirect owners of our shares at the end of the year are U.S. persons so that the RPII may be determined and apportioned among such persons. To the extent we are unable to determine whether a direct or indirect owner of shares is a U.S. person, we may assume that such owner is not a U.S. person, thereby increasing the per share RPII amount for all United States shareholders.
Apportionment of RPII to United States Shareholders. If Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's RPII for any future taxable year is 20% or more of its gross insurance income, every U.S. person directly or indirectly owning Common Shares on the last day of that year will be required to include in gross income its share of Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's RPII for such year, whether or not distributed. A U.S. person owning Common Shares during our taxable year but not on the last day of the taxable year for which Platinum Bermuda and/or Platinum UK is a controlled foreign corporation within the meaning of the RPII provisions of the Code, which would normally be December 31, is not required to include in gross income any part of Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's RPII. Correspondingly, a U.S. person directly or indirectly owning Common Shares on the last day of the taxable year in which Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda is a controlled foreign corporation for purposes of these provisions is required to include in its income its pro rata share of the RPII for the entire year, even though it did not own the Common Shares for the entire year.
133
Information Reporting. Each U.S. person who is a direct or indirect shareholder of Platinum Holdings on the last day of our taxable year must attach to the income tax or information return it would normally file for the period which includes that date a Form 5471 if Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda is a CFC for RPII purposes for any continuous thirty-day period during its taxable year, whether or not any net RPII income is required to be reported. Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda, as the case may be, will not be considered to be a CFC for this purpose and, therefore, Form 5471 will not be required, for any taxable year in which Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's gross RPII constitutes less than 20% of its gross insurance income. For any year in which Platinum UK's or Platinum Bermuda's gross RPII constitutes 20% or more of its gross insurance income, we intend to provide Form 5471 to our direct or indirect United States shareholders for attachment to the returns of such shareholders. The amounts of the RPII inclusions may be subject to adjustment based upon subsequent IRS examination. A tax-exempt organization will be required to attach Form 5471 to its information return in the circumstances described above. Failure to file Form 5471 may result in penalties. In addition, U.S. persons who at any time own 5% or more of our shares may have an independent obligation to file certain information returns.
Tax-Exempt Shareholders. Tax-exempt entities are generally required to treat certain subpart F insurance income, including RPII, that is includible in income by the tax-exempt entity as unrelated business taxable income.
Distributions; Basis; Exclusion of Distributions from Gross Income. A United States shareholder's tax basis in its Common Shares will be increased by the amount of any RPII that the shareholder includes in income. The shareholder may exclude from income the amount of any distribution by us to the extent of the RPII included in income for the year in which the distribution was paid or for any prior year. The United States shareholder's tax basis in its Common Shares will be reduced by the amount of such distributions that are excluded from income. While, in certain circumstances, a United States shareholder may be able to exclude from income distributions with respect to RPII that a prior shareholder included in income, that exclusion will not generally be available to holders who purchase Common Shares in this offering or in the public trading markets and are therefore unable to identify the previous shareholder and demonstrate that such shareholder had previously included the RPII in income.
Dispositions of Common Shares. Subject to the discussion below relating to the potential application of Code section 1248 or the passive foreign investment company rules, you will recognize a gain or loss for United States federal income tax purposes upon the sale or exchange of any Common Shares equal to the difference between the amount realized upon such sale or exchange and your basis in the Common Shares. If your holding period for these Common Shares is more than one year, any gain will be subject to tax at a current maximum marginal tax rate of 20% (18% if your holding period is more than five years) for individuals and 35% for corporations.
Code section 1248 provides that if a U.S. person disposes of stock in a foreign corporation and such person owned directly, indirectly or constructively 10% or more of the voting shares of the corporation at any time during the five-year period ending on the date of disposition when the corporation was a CFC, any gain from the sale or exchange of the shares may be treated as ordinary income to the extent of the CFC's earnings and profits during the period that the shareholder held the shares (with certain adjustments). A 10% United States shareholder may in certain circumstances be required to report a disposition of shares of a CFC by attaching IRS Form 5471 to the United States income tax or information return that it would normally file for the taxable year in which the disposition occurs. Code section 953(c)(7) generally provides that section 1248 also will apply to the sale or exchange of shares in a foreign corporation if the foreign corporation would be taxed as an insurance company if it were a domestic corporation, regardless of whether the shareholder is a 10% shareholder or whether RPII constitutes 20% or more of the
134
corporation's gross insurance income. Existing Treasury regulations do not address whether Code section 1248 and the requirement to file Form 5471 would apply if the foreign corporation is not a CFC but the foreign corporation has a subsidiary that is a CFC or that would be taxed as an insurance company if it were a domestic corporation (although, as discussed above, shareholders of 5% or more of the shares of the Company may have an independent obligation to file Form 5471). Code section 1248 and the requirement to file Form 5471 should not apply to dispositions of Common Shares because (i) we should not have any U.S. shareholders that own directly, indirectly or constructively 10% or more of the voting power of the Common Shares, and (ii) we are not directly engaged in the insurance business and, under proposed regulations, Code sections 953 and 1248 appear to be applicable only in the case of shares of corporations that are directly engaged in the insurance business. However, the IRS might interpret the proposed regulations in a different manner and the proposed regulations may be amended or promulgated in final form so as to provide that Code section 1248 and the requirement to file Form 5471 will apply to dispositions of Common Shares. In that event, we would notify shareholders that Code section 1248 and the requirement to file Form 5471 will apply to dispositions of Common Shares. Thereafter, we will send a notice after the end of each calendar year to all persons who were shareholders during the year notifying them that Code section 1248 and the requirement to file Form 5471 apply to dispositions of Common Shares. We will attach to this notice a copy of Form 5471 completed with all our information and transactions for completing the shareholder information portion of Form 5471.
Foreign Tax Credit. Because it is anticipated that U.S. persons will own a majority of the Company's shares, only a portion of the current income inclusions under the CFC, RPII and passive foreign investment company rules, if any, and of dividends paid by us (including any gain from the sale of Common Shares that is treated as a dividend under section 1248 of the Code) will be treated as foreign source income for purposes of computing a shareholder's U.S. foreign tax credit limitation. We will consider providing shareholders with information regarding the portion of such amounts constituting foreign source income to the extent such information is reasonably available. It is likely that substantially all of the RPII and dividends that are foreign source income will constitute either "passive" or "financial services" income for foreign tax credit limitation purposes. Thus, it may not be possible for most U.S. shareholders to utilize excess foreign tax credits to reduce U.S. tax on such income.
Uncertainty as to Application of RPII. Regulations interpreting the RPII provisions of the Code exist only in proposed form. It is not certain whether these regulations will be adopted in their proposed form or what changes might ultimately be made or whether any such changes, as well as any interpretation or application of the RPII rules by the IRS, the courts or otherwise, might have retroactive effect. Accordingly, the meaning of the RPII provisions and their application to Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda is uncertain. These provisions include the grant of authority to the U.S. Treasury to prescribe "such regulations as may be necessary to carry out the purposes of this subsection, including . . . regulations preventing the avoidance of this subsection through cross insurance arrangements or otherwise". In addition, there can be no assurance that the IRS will not challenge any determinations by Platinum UK or Platinum Bermuda as to the amount, if any, of RPII that should be includible in your income or that the amounts of the RPII inclusions will not be subject to adjustment based upon subsequent IRS examination. Each U.S. person considering an investment in Common Shares should consult its tax advisor as to the effects of these uncertainties.
Passive Foreign Investment Companies. Sections 1291 through 1298 of the Code contain special rules applicable to foreign corporations that are "passive foreign investment companies" ("PFICs"). In general, a foreign corporation will be a PFIC during a given year if:
- •
- 75% or more of its income constitutes "passive income" or
135
- •
- 50% or more of its assets produce passive income.
If we were to be characterized as a PFIC during a given year, our United States shareholders would be subject to a penalty tax at the time of their sale at a gain of, or receipt of an "excess distribution" with respect to, their Common Shares, unless such shareholders elected to be taxed on their pro rata share of our earnings whether or not such earnings were distributed or elected to be taxed on the investment in Common Shares on a mark-to-market basis. In general, a shareholder receives an "excess distribution" if the amount of the distribution is more than 125% of the average distribution with respect to the stock during the three preceding taxable years (or shorter period during which the taxpayer held the stock). In general, the penalty tax is equivalent to an interest charge on taxes that are deemed due during the period the United States shareholder owned the shares, computed by assuming that the excess distribution or gain (in the case of a sale) with respect to the shares was taxed in equal portions at the highest applicable tax rate on ordinary income throughout the shareholder's period of ownership. The interest charge is equal to the applicable rate imposed on underpayments of United States federal income tax for such period.
For the above purposes, passive income is defined to include income of the kind which would be foreign personal holding company income under Code section 954(c), and generally includes interest, dividends, annuities and other investment income. The PFIC statutory provisions, however, contain an express exception for income "derived in the active conduct of an insurance business by a corporation which is predominantly engaged in an insurance business . . .".
This exception is intended to ensure that income derived by a bona fide insurance company is not treated as passive income, except to the extent such income is attributable to financial reserves in excess of the reasonable needs of the insurance business. We expect, for purposes of the PFIC rules, that each of Platinum UK and Platinum Bermuda will be predominantly engaged in an insurance business and is unlikely to have financial reserves in excess of the reasonable needs of its insurance business. The PFIC statutory provisions (unlike the RPII provisions of the Code) contain a look-through rule stating that, for purposes of determining whether a foreign corporation is a PFIC, such foreign corporation shall be treated as if it received "directly its proportionate share of the income . . ." and as if it "held its proportionate share of the assets . . ." of any other corporation in which it owns at least 25% by value of the stock. While no explicit guidance is provided by the statutory language, under this look-through rule we should be deemed to own the assets and to have received the income of our insurance subsidiaries directly for purposes of determining whether we qualify for the insurance exception. This interpretation of the look-through rule is consistent with the legislative intention generally to exclude bona fide insurance companies from the application of PFIC provisions; there can, of course, be no assurance as to what positions the IRS or a court might take in the future. Each U.S. person considering an investment in Common Shares should consult its tax advisor as to the effects of the PFIC rules.
Other. Except as discussed below with respect to backup withholding, dividends paid by us will not be subject to U.S. withholding tax.
Transfer Reporting Requirements
A U.S. person (including a tax exempt entity) that purchases our Common Shares in the Public Offering may be required to file a Form 926 or similar form with the IRS if the cost of such purchases, including the cost of certain related purchases and purchases by related persons, exceeds $100,000. In the event such person fails to file any such required form, such person could be required to pay a penalty equal to 10% of the gross amount paid for such Common Shares (subject to a maximum penalty of $100,000, except in cases involving intentional disregard). U.S. persons should consult their tax advisors with respect to this or any other reporting requirement which may apply with respect to their acquisition of our Common Shares.
136
Non-U.S. Shareholders
Subject to certain exceptions, non-U.S. persons will be subject to United States federal income tax on dividend distributions with respect to, and gain realized from the sale or exchange of, Common Shares only if such dividends or gains are effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business within the U.S. Nonresident alien individuals will not be subject to U.S. estate tax with respect to our Common Shares.
All Shareholders
Information reporting to the IRS by paying agents and custodians located in the United States will be required with respect to payments of dividends on the Common Shares to U.S. persons. Thus, you may be subject to backup withholding with respect to dividends paid by such persons, unless you:
- •
- are a corporation or come within certain other exempt categories and, when required, demonstrate this fact, or
- •
- provide a taxpayer identification number, certify as to no loss of exemption from backup withholding and otherwise comply with applicable requirements of the backup withholding rules.
Backup withholding is not an additional tax and may be credited against your regular federal income tax liability.
Proposed U.S. Tax Legislation
Recently proposed U.S. legislation, if enacted, would under certain circumstances treat a foreign corporation as a U.S. corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes and under other circumstances would require obtaining IRS approval of the terms of related-party transactions.
The Company and its subsidiaries would appear not to be subject to the proposed legislation as currently drafted. We cannot predict whether the proposed legislation (or any similar legislation) will be enacted or, if enacted, what the specific provisions or the effective date of any such legislation would be, or whether it would have any effect on the Company or its subsidiaries.
If such legislation were enacted and made applicable to the Company and its subsidiaries, we could be treated as a U.S. corporation. If we were treated as a U.S. corporation, we would be subject to taxation in the U.S. at regular corporate rates. The U.S. tax consequences to the U.S. and non-U.S. holders of Common Shares would be significantly different from those described in the preceding sections. Prospective investors should consult their tax advisors regarding the U.S. tax consequences to them, in their particular circumstances, if we were treated as a U.S. corporation.
United Kingdom Taxation
The following discussion applies only to U.K. resident individuals and U.K. resident companies who beneficially own shares in Platinum Holdings and who hold those shares as capital assets and not as dealers.
Such individuals will be liable to tax on dividends received, at a rate of 10% for those shareholders who are subject to tax only at the basic rate, and 32.5% for those shareholders who are liable to tax at the higher rate of tax. Individual shareholders who while resident in the U.K. are non-U.K. domiciled will be chargeable to tax in respect of dividends only if and to the extent that the dividends are remitted to or enjoyed in the United Kingdom in any way.
137
Individual shareholders are potentially liable to capital gains tax in respect of chargeable gains arising on any disposal of their shares. Once again, resident shareholders who are non-U.K. domiciled will be chargeable to capital gains tax on a disposal of their shares only as regards remittances made to the United Kingdom of the proceeds.
For U.K. inheritance tax purposes, the shares of Platinum Holdings will rank as non-U.K. assets which may have a bearing on the imposition of inheritance tax in relation to gifts or the passing of the shares on death, particularly where the donor or deceased was non-U.K. domiciled.
U.K. companies will be liable to corporation tax at the ordinary rate in relation to dividends received on the shares and gains arising on the disposal of the shares.
Were a U.K. company ever to hold shares that carried the entitlement (aggregated with shares held by certain connected persons) to at least 25% of the profits of Platinum, the U.K.'s Controlled Foreign Companies provisions could be material, with the result that in certain circumstances underlying profits of Platinum and its subsidiaries might be taxed in the hands of the U.K. shareholder.
Ireland Taxation
Dividends paid by Platinum Ireland to its 100% parent, Platinum Holdings, will be exempt from dividend withholding tax (current rate 20%) provided that Platinum Holdings is not resident in Ireland and the Common Shares are substantially and regularly traded on a recognized U.S. stock exchange. A declaration and an auditor's certificate is required in support of the claim for exemption.
Platinum Holdings will not be subject to Irish capital gains tax on a sale of shares of Platinum Ireland. However, Irish stamp duty of 1% would generally be imposed on a sale of Platinum Ireland shares.
The foregoing discussion is based upon current law. Your tax treatment may vary depending on your particular tax situation. Legislative, judicial or administrative changes or interpretations may be forthcoming that could be retroactive and could affect the tax consequences to you.
Prospective investors should consult their own tax advisors concerning any federal, state, local and non-U.S. tax consequences of ownership and disposition of the Common Shares which are particular to them.
138
Platinum Holdings and the underwriters named below (the "underwriters") have entered into an underwriting agreement with respect to the Common Shares being offered. Subject to certain conditions, each underwriter has severally agreed to purchase the number of Common Shares indicated in the following table. Goldman, Sachs & Co., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, Salomon Smith Barney Inc., Banc of America Securities LLC, Credit Suisse First Boston Corporation, and J.P. Morgan Securities Inc. are the representatives of the underwriters.
Underwriters | Number of Common Shares | ||
---|---|---|---|
Goldman, Sachs & Co. | |||
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated | |||
Salomon Smith Barney Inc. | |||
Banc of America Securities LLC | |||
Credit Suisse First Boston Corporation | |||
J.P. Morgan Securities Inc. | |||
Total | 40,000,000 | ||
The underwriters are committed to take and pay for all of the Common Shares being offered, if any are taken, other than the Common Shares covered by the option described below unless and until this option is exercised.
If the underwriters sell more Common Shares than the total number set forth in the table above, the underwriters have an option to buy up to an additional 6,000,000 Common Shares from Platinum Holdings to cover such sales. They may exercise that option for 30 days. If any Common Shares are purchased pursuant to this option, the underwriters will severally purchase Common Shares in approximately the same proportion as set forth in the table above.
The following table shows the per Common Share and total underwriting discounts and commissions to be paid to the underwriters by Platinum Holdings. Such amounts are shown assuming both no exercise and full exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase 6,000,000 additional Common Shares.
Paid by Platinum Holdings | No Exercise | Full Exercise | ||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
Per Share | $ | $ | ||||
Total | $ | $ |
Common Shares sold by the underwriters to the public will initially be offered at the initial public offering price set forth on the cover of this prospectus. Any Common Shares sold by the underwriters to securities dealers may be sold at a discount of up to $ per Common Share from the initial public offering price. Any such securities dealers may resell any Common Shares purchased from the underwriters to certain other brokers or dealers at a discount of up to $ per Common Share from the initial public offering price. If all the Common Shares are not sold at the initial offering price, the representatives may change the offering price and the other selling terms.
Platinum Holdings, its officers and directors, and St. Paul have agreed with the underwriters not to dispose of or hedge any of their Common Shares or securities convertible into or exchangeable for Common Shares during the period from the date of this prospectus continuing through the date 180 days after the date of this prospectus, except with the prior written consent of Goldman, Sachs & Co. This agreement does not apply to any existing employee benefit plans. See "Shares Eligible For Future Sale" for a discussion of certain transfer restrictions.
139
Prior to the Public Offering, there has been no public market for the Common Shares. The initial public offering price will be negotiated among Platinum Holdings and the representatives of the underwriters. Among the factors to be considered in determining the initial public offering price of the Common Shares, in addition to prevailing market conditions, will be Platinum Holdings' pro forma performance, estimates of the business potential and earnings prospects of Platinum Holdings, an assessment of Platinum Holdings' management and the consideration of the above factors in relation to market valuation of companies in related businesses.
The Common Shares have been approved for listing on the NYSE under the symbol "PTP" subject to notice of issuance. In order to meet one of the requirements for listing the Common Shares on the NYSE, the underwriters have undertaken to sell lots of 100 or more Common Shares to a minimum of 2,000 beneficial holders.
In connection with the Public Offering, the underwriters may purchase and sell Common Shares in the open market. These transactions may include short sales, stabilizing transactions and purchases to cover positions created by short sales. Short sales involve the sale by the underwriters of a greater number of Common Shares than they are required to purchase in the Public Offering. "Covered" short sales are sales made in an amount not greater than the underwriters' option to purchase additional Common Shares from Platinum Holdings in the Public Offering. The underwriters may close out any covered short position by either exercising their option to purchase additional Common Shares or purchasing Common Shares in the open market. In determining the source of Common Shares to close out the covered short position, the underwriters will consider, among other things, the price of Common Shares available for purchase in the open market as compared to the price at which they may purchase such Common Shares through their option to purchase additional Common Shares from Platinum Holdings. "Naked" short sales are any sales in excess of such option. The underwriters must close out any naked short position by purchasing Common Shares in the open market. A naked short position is more likely to be created if the underwriters are concerned that there may be downward pressure on the price of the Common Shares in the open market after pricing that could adversely affect investors who purchase in the offering. Stabilizing transactions consist of various bids for or purchases of Common Shares made by the underwriters in the open market prior to the completion of the offering.
The underwriters may also impose a penalty bid. This occurs when a particular underwriter repays to the underwriters a portion of the underwriting discount received by it because the representatives have repurchased Common Shares sold by or for the account of such underwriter in stabilizing or short covering transactions.
Purchases to cover a short position and stabilizing transactions may have the effect of preventing or retarding a decline in the market price of the Common Shares, and together with the imposition of the penalty bid, may stabilize, maintain or otherwise affect the market price of the Common Shares. As a result, the price of the Common Shares may be higher than the price that otherwise might exist in the open market. If these activities are commenced, they may be discontinued at any time. These transactions may be effected on the NYSE, in the over-the-counter market or otherwise.
Each underwriter has represented, warranted and agreed that: (i) it has not offered or sold and, prior to the expiry of a period of six months from the closing of the Public Offering, will not offer or sell any Common Shares to persons in the United Kingdom except to persons whose ordinary activities involve them in acquiring, holding, managing or disposing of investments (as principal or agent) for the purposes of their businesses or otherwise in circumstances which have not resulted and will not result in an offer to the public in the United Kingdom within the meaning of the Public Offers of Securities Regulations 1995; (ii) it has only communicated or caused to be communicated and will only communicate or cause to be communicated any invitation or inducement to engage in
140
investment activity (within the meaning of section 21 of the FSMA) received by it in connection with the issue or sale of any Common Shares in circumstances in which section 21(1) of the FSMA does not apply to Platinum Holdings; and (iii) it has complied and will comply with all applicable provisions of the FSMA with respect to anything done by it in relation to the Common Shares in, from or otherwise involving the United Kingdom.
The Common Shares may not be offered, sold, transferred or delivered in or from The Netherlands, as part of their initial distribution or as part of any re-offering, and neither this prospectus nor any other document in respect of the offering may be distributed or circulated in The Netherlands, other than to individuals or legal entities which include, but are not limited to, banks, brokers, dealers, institutional investors and undertakings with a treasury department, who or which trade or invest in securities in the conduct of a business or profession.
A prospectus in electronic format will be made available on the websites maintained by one or more of the lead managers of this offering and may also be made available on websites maintained by other underwriters. The underwriters may agree to allocate a number of Common Shares to underwriters for sale to their online brokerage account holders. Internet distributions will be allocated by the lead managers to underwriters that may make Internet distributions on the same basis as other allocations.
Platinum Holdings has agreed to indemnify the several underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the 1933 Act.
The underwriters do not expect sales to discretionary accounts to exceed five percent of the total number of Common Shares offered.
Platinum Holdings estimates that its share of the total expenses for the Public Offering, excluding underwriting discounts and commissions, will be approximately $ .
Several of the underwriters and their affiliates have provided from time to time, and expect to provide in the future, investment and commercial banking and financial advisory services to St. Paul and its affiliates in the ordinary course of business, for which they have received and may continue to receive customary fees and commissions.
To a limited extent, St. Paul has agreed to pay certain indemnification obligations of Platinum to the underwriters if Platinum fails to pay in specified circumstances.
The validity of the Common Shares under Bermuda law will be passed upon for the Company by Conyers, Dill & Pearman, Hamilton, Bermuda. Certain legal matters in connection with the Public Offering will be passed upon for the Company by Sullivan & Cromwell, New York, New York, and the Underwriters are being advised as to certain matters by Fried, Frank, Harris, Shriver & Jacobson (a partnership including professional corporations), New York, New York, in each case in reliance on the opinions of Conyers, Dill & Pearman with respect to Bermuda law. Sullivan & Cromwell is also advising St. Paul, the sponsor of the Company, in connection with the Company's establishment. Furthermore, the Company is being advised as to certain matters in connection with its organization and the Public Offering by Sullivan & Cromwell.
The consolidated balance sheet of Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and the combined statements of identifiable underwriting assets and liabilities, underwriting results, identifiable underwriting cash flows and combined financial statement schedules of The St. Paul Companies, Inc. Reinsurance Underwriting Segment (Predecessor) included in the Registration Statement have been audited by KPMG LLP, independent auditors, as set forth in their reports appearing herein. The statements and combined financial statement schedules referred to above
141
are included in reliance upon such reports of KPMG LLP, given upon the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing. The audit report covering Predecessor's December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999 combined statements contains an explanatory paragraph that states that the combined statements are not intended to be a complete presentation of Predecessor's or St. Paul's financial position, results of operations, or cash flows.
142
Upon completion of the offering, we will file annual, quarterly and current reports, proxy statements and other information with the SEC. You may read and copy any documents filed by us at the SEC's public reference room at 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information on the public reference room. Our SEC filings will also be available over the internet at the SEC's website at http://www.sec.gov. We intend to list the Common Shares on the NYSE. Upon listing, periodic reports, proxy statements and other information concerning Platinum Holdings will be available for review at the New York Stock Exchange, Inc., 20 Broad Street, New York, New York 10005. After the completion of the Public Offering, we expect to provide annual reports to our shareholders that include financial information reported on by our independent public accountants and quarterly reports containing unaudited interim financial information for the first three fiscal quarters of each fiscal year.
We have filed a registration statement on Form S-1 with the SEC (File No. 333-86906). This prospectus is a part of the registration statement and does not contain all of the information in the registration statement. Whenever a reference is made in this prospectus to one of our contracts or other documents, please be aware that the reference is not necessarily complete and that you should refer to the exhibits that are a part of the registration statement for a copy of the contract or other document. You may review a copy of the registration statement at the SEC's public reference room in Washington, D.C. as well as through the SEC's internet site.
ENFORCEABILITY OF CIVIL LIABILITIES UNDER UNITED STATES FEDERAL SECURITIES LAWS AND OTHER MATTERS
Platinum Holdings is a Bermuda company, and certain of its officers and directors are or will be residents of various jurisdictions outside the United States. A substantial portion of the assets of Platinum Holdings and of such officers and directors, at any one time, are or may be located in jurisdictions outside the United States. In particular, Platinum Bermuda is also a Bermuda corporation. Therefore, it ordinarily could be difficult for investors to effect service of process within the United States on Platinum Holdings or any of these officers and directors who reside outside the United States or to recover against Platinum Holdings or any such individuals on judgments of courts in the United States, including judgments predicated upon civil liability under the U.S. federal securities laws. Notwithstanding the foregoing, Platinum Holdings has irrevocably agreed that it may be served with process with respect to actions against us arising out of violations of the U.S. federal securities laws in any federal or state court in the U.S. relating to the transactions covered by this prospectus by serving CT Corporation System, 1633 Broadway, 30th Fl., New York, New York 10019, telephone (800) 624-0909, its United States agent appointed for that purpose. Nevertheless, it may be difficult for you to effect service of process within the United States upon Platinum Holdings' directors, officers and experts who reside outside the United States or to enforce in the United States judgments of U.S. courts obtained in actions against Platinum Holdings or its directors and officers, as well as the experts named in this document, who reside outside the United States. Platinum Holdings has been advised by Conyers, Dill & Pearman, its Bermuda counsel, that there is doubt as to whether the courts of Bermuda would enforce (1) judgments of United States courts obtained in actions against such persons or Platinum Holdings predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the United States federal securities laws and (2) original actions brought in Bermuda against such persons or Platinum Holdings predicated solely upon United States federal securities laws. There is no treaty in effect between the United States and Bermuda providing for such enforcement, and there are grounds upon which Bermuda courts may not enforce judgments of United States courts. Certain remedies available under the laws of U.S. jurisdictions, including certain remedies available under the U.S. federal securities laws, would not be allowed in Bermuda courts as contrary to Bermuda's public policy.
143
We present below selected historical combined financial data of St. Paul Re. Our pro forma underwriting results presented under "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Pro Forma Financial Condition and Underwriting Results" in this prospectus show that our 2001 net premiums written, as adjusted for the business not transferred and the exclusion of the St. Paul corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance program, represent approximately 82% of St. Paul Re's net premiums written for the same period. Also, we are assuming no premium or loss development on business entered into prior to January 1, 2002. Accordingly, we caution that St. Paul Re's underwriting results and St. Paul Re's combined statements presented in this prospectus are not indicative of the actual results that we will achieve once we commence operations. For a detailed discussion of our pro forma combined statements of underwriting results, see "Pro Forma Financial Information".
In addition to the effect of the non-transfer of certain portions of St. Paul Re's business to us and the exclusion of the St. Paul corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance program, other factors may cause our actual results to differ materially from St. Paul Re's results. For example, although we continue to be afforded the benefits of St. Paul Re's retrocessional program for the remainder of 2002, we may enter into reinsurance contracts with significantly different terms and conditions from those that have been made available to St. Paul Re from St. Paul and which form the basis of St. Paul Re's results. Furthermore, the additional premiums recorded in 2001 by St. Paul Re's finite risk business primarily associated with the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack were exceedingly high and not necessarily indicative of the recurring premium volume we expect to write in that business segment. In addition, St. Paul Re's combined statements reflect the discounting of the liability for certain assumed reinsurance contracts using rates up to 7.5%, based on its return on invested assets or, in many cases, on yields contractually guaranteed to it on funds held by the ceding company, as permitted by the state of domicile of a company included in St. Paul Re. It is our current intention to make arrangements to permit such discounting to a similar extent as St. Paul Re, which may include the organization and licensing of a U.S. subsidiary in addition to Platinum U.S. If arrangements permitting us to discount reserves to the same extent as St. Paul Re are not made, reinsurance contracts of a similar type entered into in the future would be reported on an undiscounted basis.
As further discussed in the Notes under "Pro Forma Combined Statements of Underwriting Results for the Year Ended December 31, 2001 and the Three Months Ended March 31, 2002 and 2001", the following table illustrates the difference between Platinum's pro forma financial information and St. Paul Re's for the year ended December 31, 2001.
| Year Ended December 31, 2001 | ||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| Historical St. Paul Re | Pro Forma Platinum | |||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||
Net premiums earned | $ | 1,593 | $ | 1,302 | |||
Underwriting losses and expenses | |||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 1,922 | 1,440 | |||||
Underwriting expenses | 397 | 300 | |||||
Total underwriting losses and expenses | 2,319 | 1,740 | |||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | (726 | ) | $ | (438 | ) | |
144
Selected Combined Financial Data
Five-year Summary of St. Paul Re Selected Combined Financial Data
| March 31, | | | | | | |||||||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | 1998 | 1997 | ||||||||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 463 | $ | 421 | $ | 1,677 | $ | 1,073 | $ | 913 | $ | 1,017 | $ | 1,155 | |||||||||
Net premiums earned | 377 | 302 | 1,593 | 1,121 | 878 | 1,003 | 1,198 | ||||||||||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 247 | 205 | 1,922 | 811 | 500 | 658 | 819 | ||||||||||||||||
Underwriting expenses | 115 | 118 | 397 | 424 | 302 | 341 | 379 | ||||||||||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | 15 | $ | (21) | $ | (726 | ) | $ | (114 | ) | $ | 76 | $ | 4 | $ | — | |||||||
Statutory combined ratio: | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Loss and loss expense ratio | 65.1 | % | 67.9 | % | 120.6 | % | 72.3 | % | 57.0 | % | 65.6 | % | 68.4 | % | |||||||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 26.8 | % | 34.0 | % | 25.1 | % | 39.7 | % | 35.1 | % | 33.3 | % | 31.1 | % | |||||||||
Combined ratio | 91.9 | % | 101.9 | % | 145.7 | % | 112.0 | % | 92.1 | % | 98.9 | % | 99.5 | % | |||||||||
Adjusted combined ratio* | 90.9 | % | 107.7 | % | 117.6 | % | 120.4 | % | 109.2 | % | 98.9 | % | 99.5 | % | |||||||||
Impact of catastrophes on combined ratio** | (1.9) | % | (1.6) | % | 40.4 | % | 12.0 | % | 16.3 | % | 8.6 | % | 0.3 | % | |||||||||
- *
- For purposes of meaningful comparison, adjusted combined ratios in 1999 - 2001 exclude the impact of the reinsurance treaties described in Note 8 to the combined statements, and in 2001, the impact of the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack.
- **
- Excludes ceded losses under the St. Paul corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance program and St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss treaties.
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and
Underwriting Results of the Predecessor Business
The following discussion and analysis pertains to the operating results of the Reinsurance underwriting segment of St. Paul, for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999, and for the three-month periods ended March 31, 2002 and 2001. This discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with St. Paul Re's combined statements and related notes found on pages F-13 to F-28, because they contain important information that is helpful in evaluating St. Paul Re's operating results and financial condition.
St. Paul Re's operations include the underwriting results of certain insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries in St. Paul's group of companies, as well as the underwriting results of the reinsurance departments of St. Paul Fire and Marine Insurance Company, and United States Fidelity and Guaranty Company ("USF&G"), St. Paul's two largest U.S. insurance subsidiaries. The financial results reported herein for St. Paul Re reconcile to St. Paul's Reinsurance segment results reported in St. Paul's audited consolidated financial statements for each year in the three-year period ended December 31, 2001, which are included in St. Paul's 2001 Annual Report to Shareholders, and in St. Paul's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the three months ended March 31, 2002 (unaudited).
It is the practice of St. Paul to evaluate the performance of its property-casualty insurance underwriting segments on the basis of underwriting results. Therefore, this discussion focuses on each segment's performance based on underwriting results. St. Paul does not allocate assets or
145
investment income to its respective underwriting segments, and therefore, neither assets nor surplus are specifically identifiable for St. Paul Re. As a result, the following discussion and analysis focuses almost exclusively on those factors influencing underwriting performance for each of St. Paul Re's four business segments. Those segments, whose results are analyzed in more detail later in this discussion, are as follows: North American Casualty, North American Property, International, and Finite Risk.
In the years covered by this discussion, St. Paul Re generally underwrote traditional treaty and facultative reinsurance for property, casualty, ocean marine, surety, accident and health and certain specialty classes of coverage for leading property and casualty insurance companies worldwide. St. Paul Re also underwrote certain types of "non-traditional" reinsurance, which provides limited traditional underwriting risk combined with financial risk protection. In late 2001, St. Paul announced a series of actions designed to improve its profitability, including plans to narrow the product offering and geographic presence of its reinsurance operations. As a result, in January 2002, St. Paul Re began focusing almost exclusively on the following types of reinsurance coverages: property catastrophe, excess-of-loss casualty, marine and traditional finite.
Critical Accounting Policies
St. Paul Re's significant accounting policies are described in the notes to St. Paul's Reinsurance Underwriting Segment (Predecessor)'s Combined Statements. The following is a summary of the critical accounting policies that affected the components comprising St. Paul Re's underwriting performance: premiums, reserves and reinsurance.
Premiums
Premiums were recorded at the inception of each policy, based upon information received from ceding companies and their brokers. For excess-of-loss contracts, the amount of premium was usually contractually documented at inception, and no management judgment was necessary in accounting for this. Premiums were earned on a pro rata basis over the contract period. For proportional treaties, the amount of premium was normally estimated at inception by the ceding company. St. Paul Re accounted for such premium using the initial estimates, and then adjusted them once a sufficient period for actual premium reporting had elapsed, normally around three years. For the year ended December 31, 2001 the net amount of premium written resulting from estimate accruals was less than 25% of total premiums written. St. Paul Re also accrued for reinstatement premiums resulting from losses. Such accruals were based upon actual contractual terms, and the only element of management judgment involved was with respect to the amount of loss reserves, as described below.
Reserves
Under U.S. GAAP, St. Paul Re was not permitted to establish loss reserves until the occurrence of an event which may give rise to a loss. Once such an event occurred, St. Paul Re established reserves based upon estimates of total losses incurred by the ceding insurers as a result of the event and St. Paul Re's estimate of the portion of such loss it has reinsured. As a result, only loss reserves applicable to losses incurred up to the reporting date may be set aside, with no allowance for the provision of a contingency reserve to account for expected future losses. Losses arising from future events will be estimated and recognized at the time the loss is incurred and could be substantial.
Setting appropriate reserves is an inherently uncertain process. Loss reserves represent St. Paul Re's estimates, at a given point in time, of ultimate settlement and adjustment costs of losses incurred (including IBNR losses). St. Paul Re regularly reviewed and updated these estimates, using
146
the most current information available. Consequently, the ultimate liability for a loss was likely to differ from the original estimate. Whenever St. Paul Re determined that any existing loss reserves were inadequate, St. Paul Re was required to record such change in estimate; increasing the loss reserves with a corresponding negative impact, which could be material, in St. Paul Re's underwriting results in the period in which the deficiency was identified. The establishment of new reserves, or the adjustment of reserves for reported claims, could result in significant upward or downward changes to St. Paul Re's financial condition or results of underwriting in any particular period.
The reserve for losses and loss adjustment expenses was based upon reports, individual case estimates received from ceding companies, and management's estimates. St. Paul Re management's estimates were used mostly to estimate IBNR loss amounts. For certain catastrophic events, there was considerable uncertainty underlying the assumptions and associated estimated reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses. Reserves were reviewed regularly and, as experience developed and additional information became known, the reserves were adjusted as necessary. Such changes in estimate, if necessary, were reflected in results of operations in the current period.
Liabilities for unpaid losses and LAE related to certain assumed reinsurance contracts are discounted to the present value of estimated future payments. The liabilities related to these reinsurance contracts were discounted based on our return on invested assets, or in many cases, on yields contractually guaranteed to us on funds held by the ceding company, as permitted.
Reinsurance
Written premiums, earned premiums, and incurred losses and LAE reflected the net effects of assumed and ceded reinsurance transactions. Reinsurance accounting was followed for assumed and ceded transactions when risk transfer requirements had been met. These requirements involved significant assumptions being made related to the amount and timing of expected cash flows, as well as the interpretation of underlying contract terms. Assumed reinsurance contracts that did not transfer significant insurance risk were required to be accounted for as deposits. These deposits were accounted for as financing transactions, with interest expense credited to the contract deposit. Premiums received on retroactive reinsurance contracts are not reflected in the statement of operations, but rather are recorded in the combined statement of identifiable underwriting assets and liabilities as an increase to loss and loss adjustment expenses reserves for the liabilities assumed and as assets based on the consideration received. A deferred charge or credit is recorded for any difference between liabilities assumed and consideration received.
147
Consolidated Overview
The following table summarizes St. Paul Re's results for the periods presented.
| Three Months Ended March 31, | Year Ended December 31, | ||||||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | |||||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||||||||||
Net premiums earned | ||||||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 463 | $ | 421 | $ | 1,677 | $ | 1,073 | $ | 913 | ||||||||
Change in unearned premiums | (86 | ) | (119 | ) | (84 | ) | 48 | (35 | ) | |||||||||
Net premiums earned | 377 | 302 | 1,593 | 1,121 | 878 | |||||||||||||
Losses and underwriting expenses | ||||||||||||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 247 | 205 | 1,922 | 811 | 500 | |||||||||||||
Policy acquisition expenses | 100 | 97 | 315 | 336 | 220 | |||||||||||||
Other underwriting expenses | 15 | 21 | 82 | 88 | 82 | |||||||||||||
Total losses and underwriting expenses | 362 | 323 | 2,319 | 1,235 | 802 | |||||||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | 15 | $ | (21 | ) | $ | (726 | ) | $ | (114 | ) | $ | 76 | |||||
Three Months Ended March 31, 2002 vs. Three Months Ended March 31, 2001
The 10% increase in net written premiums in 2002 was primarily due to significant rate increases across all business segments. Reinsurance rate increases continued to accelerate in the first quarter of 2002, primarily in response to the terrorist attack in the United States in September 2001. Price increases on business renewed on January 1, 2002 averaged approximately 30% across all business segments. In addition, a large quota share contract and new business opportunities in the accident and health line of business contributed to premium growth in the first quarter of 2002. Premium growth from all of these factors was partially offset by reduced volume from the lines of business targeted for exit as part of St. Paul's strategic initiative to improve profitability. The exited lines accounted for $81 million, or 19%, of net written premiums in the first quarter of 2001.
The $36 million improvement in underwriting results reflected the impact of substantial price increases on 2002 renewals, as well as favorable prior year development on catastrophe losses and the North American casualty program line of business. In addition, first-quarter 2002 results benefited from the exit from unprofitable lines of business.
Year Ended December 31, 2001 vs. Year Ended December 31, 2000
The 56% increase in net written premiums in 2001 was principally driven by new business growth in the North American Casualty and North American Property segments, additional premiums recorded for prior underwriting years in the North American Casualty segment, and strong price increases in all segments. Price increases continued throughout 2001 in response to the growing demand for reinsurance coverages, and those increases accelerated during the fourth quarter in the aftermath of the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack. In 2000, net premium growth was driven by new business opportunities in the non-traditional reinsurance market and price increases across virtually all lines of traditional reinsurance coverage.
Underwriting results in 2001 were dominated by losses resulting from the terrorist attack, which totaled $556 million. Excluding those losses, underwriting results in 2001 were still significantly worse than in 2000, with deterioration centered in the North American Casualty and Finite Risk
148
segments. Catastrophe losses (excluding the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack) totaled $92 million in 2001, driven by losses from the explosion of a chemical plant in Toulouse, France and Tropical Storm Allison in the United States. Catastrophe losses in 2000 totaled $135 million and were primarily the result of additional loss development from European storms occurring near the end of 1999.
The deterioration in 2000 underwriting results compared with 1999 was due to significant adverse loss development from years prior to 2000, including development from the European storms at the end of 1999. Adverse prior-year loss development on retrocessional business written in St. Paul Re's London operations also played a significant role in 2000's underwriting loss. In addition, the North American treaty casualty business accounted for $131 million of underwriting losses in 2000.
Retrocessional Reinsurance
St. Paul Re's underwriting results for 2001, 2000 and 1999 reflect the benefits of its retrocessional reinsurance program. Under this program, St. Paul Re purchases reinsurance for its own benefit, to limit the effect on its financial condition and operating results of large and multiple losses. Under this program, St. Paul Re ceded the following amounts to reinsurers:
| Three Months Ended March 31, | Year Ended December 31, | ||||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | |||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 30 | $ | 36 | $ | 177 | $ | 254 | $ | 318 | ||||||
Net premiums earned | 19 | 28 | 172 | 260 | 314 | |||||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | (1 | ) | 51 | 396 | 386 | 377 | ||||||||||
Underwriting expenses | (1 | ) | 4 | 14 | 13 | 30 | ||||||||||
Net underwriting benefit | $ | (17 | ) | $ | 27 | $ | 238 | $ | 138 | $ | 93 | |||||
Included in the above totals were the impacts of the St. Paul corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance programs that were entered into effective on January 1 of each year except 2002 and St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss-treaty, a separate aggregate excess-of-loss treaty exclusive to St. Paul Re. St. Paul chose not to have a corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance program in place in 2002. Coverage under the St. Paul corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance programs was triggered when incurred insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses spanning all segments of St. Paul's business exceeded accident year attachment loss ratios specified in the treaty. In addition, St. Paul Re's results benefited from St. Paul Re's aggregate excess-of-loss-treaty in each year. These treaties are collectively referred to hereafter as the "reinsurance treaties".
149
The following table describes the combined impact of these cessions under the reinsurance treaties on St. Paul Re's results.
| Three Months Ended March 31, | Year Ended December 31, | |||||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | ||||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||||||||||||
St. Paul Corporate Aggregate Excess-of-Loss Reinsurance Program: | |||||||||||||||||
Ceded premiums written | $ | — | $ | 1 | $ | (67 | ) | $ | 80 | $ | 89 | ||||||
Ceded losses and loss adjustment expenses | — | (2 | ) | (126 | ) | 140 | 164 | ||||||||||
Ceded earned premiums | — | — | (67 | ) | 80 | 89 | |||||||||||
Net pretax benefit (detriment) | — | (2 | ) | (59 | ) | 60 | 75 | ||||||||||
St. Paul Re's Aggregate Excess-of-Loss Treaties: | |||||||||||||||||
Ceded premiums written | 4 | 7 | 119 | 55 | 62 | ||||||||||||
Ceded losses and adjustment expenses | — | 25 | 278 | 122 | 150 | ||||||||||||
Ceded earned premiums | 4 | 6 | 119 | 55 | 62 | ||||||||||||
Net pretax benefit | (4 | ) | 19 | 159 | 67 | 88 | |||||||||||
Combined Total: | |||||||||||||||||
Ceded premiums written | 4 | 8 | 52 | 135 | 151 | ||||||||||||
Ceded losses and loss adjustment expenses | — | 23 | 152 | 262 | 314 | ||||||||||||
Ceded earned premiums | 4 | 6 | 52 | 135 | 151 | ||||||||||||
Net pretax benefit | $ | (4 | ) | $ | 17 | $ | 100 | $ | 127 | $ | 163 | ||||||
St. Paul was not party to a corporate all-lines aggregate excess-of-loss treaty in 2002. In 2001, St. Paul did not cede any losses to the St. Paul corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance program, but did reallocate benefits from its 2000 and 1999 treaties among its business segments, resulting in a detriment to St. Paul Re's reported results for calendar year 2001. This reallocation was necessary to reflect the impact of differences between St. Paul's actual 2001 experience on losses ceded to the St. Paul corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance program in 2000 and 1999, by segment, and the anticipated experience on those losses in 2000 and 1999, when the initial segment allocation was made. The impact of the 2000 and 1999 St. Paul corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance program was allocated to St. Paul Re based on St. Paul Re's underwriting results relative to the underwriting results of St. Paul's other underwriting segments.
The combined net pretax benefit (detriment) of the reinsurance treaties was allocated to St. Paul Re's business segments as follows:
| Three Months Ended March 31, | Year Ended December 31, | |||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | ||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||||||||||
North American Casualty | $ | (1 | ) | $ | (4 | ) | $ | 13 | $ | 42 | $ | 28 | |||
North American Property | (1 | ) | 13 | 40 | 49 | 60 | |||||||||
International | — | 10 | 30 | 36 | 51 | ||||||||||
Finite Risk | (2 | ) | (2 | ) | 17 | 0 | 24 | ||||||||
Total | $ | (4 | ) | $ | 17 | $ | 100 | $ | 127 | $ | 163 | ||||
150
September 11, 2001 Terrorist Attack
On September 11, 2001, terrorists hijacked four commercial passenger jets in the United States. Two of the jets were flown into the World Trade Center towers in New York, N.Y., causing their collapse. The third jet was flown into the Pentagon building in Washington, D.C., causing severe damage, and the fourth jet crashed in rural Pennsylvania. This terrorist attack caused significant loss of life and resulted in unprecedented losses for the property and casualty insurance industry. St. Paul Re's estimated net pretax loss incurred as a result of the terrorist attack totaled $556 million in 2001, distributed among business segments as follows:
| Year Ended December 31, 2001 | |||
---|---|---|---|---|
| ($ in millions) | |||
North American Property | $ | 233 | ||
North American Casualty | 32 | |||
International | 162 | |||
Finite Risk | 129 | |||
Total | $ | 556 | ||
St. Paul Re continually evaluated the adequacy of the net loss provision recorded, based on claim experience, collections from its reinsurers, and other factors. In the first quarter of 2002, St. Paul Re did not record any additions or reductions to its original estimated loss provision recorded in 2001 for the terrorist attack. Through March 31, 2002, St. Paul Re had made net loss payments totaling $76 million related to the attack since it occurred, of which $74 million were made in the first quarter of 2002.
For further information related to the terrorist attack, refer to the Notes to The St. Paul Companies, Inc. Reinsurance Underwriting Segment (Predecessor) Combined Statements beginning on page F-12 of this prospectus.
Elimination of One-Quarter Reporting Lag
In the first quarter of 2000, St. Paul Re eliminated the one-quarter reporting lag for its reinsurance operations based in the United Kingdom ("St. Paul Re-U.K.") in order to report the results of those operations on a current basis. As a result, St. Paul Re's results for 2000 include St. Paul Re-U.K.'s results for the fourth quarter of 1999 and all of 2000. The incremental impact of eliminating the reporting lag, which consists of St. Paul Re-U.K.'s results for the three months ended December 31, 2000, was as follows.
| Year Ended December 31, 2000 | |||
---|---|---|---|---|
| ($ in millions) | |||
Net premiums written | $ | 7 | ||
Net premiums earned | 51 | |||
Underwriting loss | (10 | ) |
151
Underwriting Results By Segment
The following table summarizes written premiums, underwriting results, statutory combined ratios and adjusted combined ratios (as described in the footnote to the table) for each of St. Paul Re's business segments for the last three years. These segments are managed in a carefully coordinated fashion with strong elements of centralized control. As a result, management monitors and evaluates the financial performance of these segments principally based on their underwriting results. Following the table are detailed analyses of each segment's results.
| Three Months Ended March 31, | Year Ended December 31 | |||||||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | ||||||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||||||||||||||
North American Casualty | |||||||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 188 | $ | 152 | $ | 667 | $ | 340 | $ | 262 | |||||||||
Net premiums earned | 168 | 130 | 588 | 319 | 245 | ||||||||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 141 | 144 | 584 | 261 | 61 | ||||||||||||||
Underwriting expenses | 55 | 45 | 219 | 134 | 109 | ||||||||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | (28 | ) | $ | (59 | ) | $ | (215 | ) | $ | (76 | ) | $ | 75 | |||||
Combined ratio | 114.2 | % | 143.4 | % | 135.4 | % | 124.9 | % | 68.8 | % | |||||||||
Adjusted combined ratio* | 113.5 | % | 141.8 | % | 131.5 | % | 131.4 | % | 82.2 | % | |||||||||
North American Property | |||||||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 62 | $ | 46 | $ | 216 | $ | 170 | $ | 207 | |||||||||
Net premiums earned | 64 | 44 | 216 | 204 | 196 | ||||||||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 22 | 12 | 381 | 133 | 153 | ||||||||||||||
Underwriting expenses | 17 | 16 | 67 | 72 | 71 | ||||||||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | 25 | $ | 16 | $ | (232 | ) | $ | (1 | ) | $ | (28 | ) | ||||||
Combined ratio | 61.5 | % | 63.7 | % | 207.3 | % | 104.6 | % | 112.6 | % | |||||||||
Adjusted combined ratio* | 61.2 | % | 95.7 | % | 116.9 | % | 122.2 | % | 134.8 | % | |||||||||
International | |||||||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 117 | $ | 128 | $ | 248 | $ | 145 | $ | 160 | |||||||||
Net premiums earned | 57 | 48 | 242 | 188 | 160 | ||||||||||||||
Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses | 16 | 5 | 289 | 128 | 102 | ||||||||||||||
Underwriting expenses | 13 | 13 | 62 | 70 | 79 | ||||||||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | 28 | $ | 30 | $ | (109 | ) | $ | (10 | ) | $ | (21 | ) | ||||||
Combined ratio | 45.9 | % | 28.8 | % | 143.8 | % | 111.6 | % | 114.0 | % | |||||||||
Adjusted combined ratio* | 47.1 | % | 56.3 | % | 89.5 | % | 125.0 | % | 134.7 | % | |||||||||
Finite Risk | |||||||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 96 | $ | 95 | $ | 546 | $ | 418 | $ | 284 | |||||||||
Net premiums earned | 88 | 80 | 547 | 410 | 277 | ||||||||||||||
Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses | 68 | 44 | 668 | 289 | 184 | ||||||||||||||
Underwriting expenses | 30 | 44 | 49 | 148 | 43 | ||||||||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | (10 | ) | $ | (8 | ) | $ | (170 | ) | $ | (27 | ) | $ | 50 | |||||
Combined ratio | 105.9 | % | 109.7 | % | 131.6 | % | 106.2 | % | 85.8 | % | |||||||||
Adjusted combined ratio* | 103.9 | % | 107.4 | % | 114.2 | % | 106.2 | % | 94.9 | % |
152
Total | |||||||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 463 | $ | 421 | $ | 1,677 | $ | 1,073 | $ | 913 | |||||||||
Net premiums earned | 377 | 302 | 1,593 | 1,121 | 878 | ||||||||||||||
Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses | 247 | 205 | 1,922 | 811 | 500 | ||||||||||||||
Underwriting expenses | 115 | 118 | 397 | 424 | 302 | ||||||||||||||
Underwriting result | $ | 15 | $ | (21 | ) | $ | (726 | ) | $ | (114 | ) | $ | 76 | ||||||
Loss and loss expense ratio | 65.1 | % | 67.9 | % | 120.6 | % | 72.3 | % | 57.0 | % | |||||||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 26.8 | % | 34.0 | % | 25.1 | % | 39.7 | % | 35.1 | % | |||||||||
Combined ratio | 91.9 | % | 101.9 | % | 145.7 | % | 112.0 | % | 92.1 | % | |||||||||
Adjusted combined ratio* | 90.9 | % | 107.7 | % | 117.6 | % | 120.4 | % | 109.2 | % | |||||||||
- *
- For purposes of meaningful comparison, adjusted combined ratios in all periods presented exclude the impact of the reinsurance treaties described before the table and the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack.
Three Months Ended March 31, 2002 vs. Three Months Ended March 31, 2001
Loss Ratio
The loss ratio measures insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred as a percentage of earned premiums. St. Paul Re's reported loss ratio for the three months ended March 31, 2002 was 65.1%, compared with 67.9% in the same 2001 period. The 2.8 percentage point improvement in the loss ratio was primarily due to rate increases across all segments and improved prior-year loss experience in the casualty program line of business.
Expense Ratio
The expense ratio measures underwriting expenses as a percentage of net premiums written. St. Paul Re's reported expense ratio for the three months ended March 31, 2002 was 26.8%, compared with 34.0% in the same period of 2001. The significant improvement in the expense ratio reflected the combined impact of strong growth in written premium volume and a reduction in underwriting expenses incurred.
Year Ended December 31, 2001 vs. Years Ended December 31, 2000 and December 31, 1999
Loss Ratio
St. Paul Re's reported loss ratio in 2001 included a 42.6 percentage point detriment from losses incurred in the terrorist attack. The reported loss ratios in 2001, 2000 and 1999 also included benefits from the reinsurance treaties.
Catastrophe losses totaled $880 million in 2001, of which $788 million was due to the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack. Most of the other $92 million of catastrophe losses were the result of a variety of storms throughout the year in the U.S. and the explosion of a chemical manufacturing plant in Toulouse, France. In 2000 and 1999, catastrophe losses totaled $135 million
153
and $143 million, respectively. Additional loss development arising from severe windstorms that struck portions of Europe in late 1999 and severe flooding in the United Kingdom drove the 2000 total. Major events contributing to the 1999 total included Hurricane Floyd, earthquakes in Taiwan and Turkey, and European windstorms.
Expense Ratio
The expense ratio measures underwriting expenses as a percentage of premiums written. St. Paul Re's reported expense ratio in 2001 included an 8.2 point benefit resulting from a $91 million reduction in contingent commissions that had been accrued prior to September 11, 2001. The magnitude of losses from the terrorist attack resulted in the reversal of that accrual. The reported expense ratios in 2001, 2000 and 1999 included detriments from the reinsurance treaties. No underwriting expenses were ceded under the treaties; however, the expense ratios in all three years included the effects of written premiums ceded under the treaties.
During 2000, St. Paul Re reduced its estimate of ultimate losses on certain non-traditional reinsurance business by $56 million, and made a corresponding increase in its estimate of reserves for contingent commissions by $66 million. Although these changes in estimate did not have a significant impact on underwriting results for the year, they did distort the components of the combined ratio in 2000. Excluding these changes, the loss ratio would have been 89.8%, and the expense ratio would have been 29.8% (both excluding the benefits of the reinsurance treaties).
The following pages provide a more detailed discussion of results for the years ended December 2001, 2000 and 1999 and for the three month periods ended March 31, 2002 and 2001 produced by St. Paul Re's four business segments. To provide a more meaningful analysis of the underlying performance of St. Paul Re's business segments, the discussion of segment results excludes the impact of the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack in 2001 and the reinsurance treaties in all three years. The impact of the terrorist attack on individual segment results, and the impact of the reinsurance treaties was discussed earlier in this prospectus.
North American Casualty
The North American Casualty segment consisted of casualty reinsurance underwritten for customers with exposures in the United States and Canada. In 2001, the following types of casualty coverages were offered: general, workers' compensation, auto, medical professional, non-medical professional, directors and officers, employment practices, surplus lines, umbrella and environmental impairment. This segment also included accident and health reinsurance coverages. As discussed earlier in this prospectus, in 2002, St. Paul narrowed its reinsurance product focus in an effort to improve profitability. As a result, the North American Casualty segment offered the following coverages in the first quarter of 2002: general and automobile liability, professional liability, workers' compensation, accident and health coverages and casualty clash. The following table
154
summarizes results for this segment for the periods presented, and excludes the impact of the reinsurance treaties and the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack.
| Three Months Ended March 31, | Year Ended December 31 | ||||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | |||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 188 | $ | 145 | $ | 679 | $ | 400 | $ | 288 | ||||||
Percentage increase (decrease) over prior year | 30 | % | 70 | % | 39 | % | ||||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | (26 | ) | $ | (54 | ) | $ | (195 | ) | $ | (114 | ) | $ | 47 | ||
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio | 83.1 | % | 106.7 | % | 95.7 | % | 94.6 | % | 42.1 | % | ||||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 30.4 | % | 35.1 | % | 35.8 | % | 36.8 | % | 40.1 | % | ||||||
Combined ratio | 113.5 | % | 141.8 | % | 131.5 | % | 131.4 | % | 82.2 | % | ||||||
Three Months Ended March 31, 2002 vs. Three Months Ended March 31, 2001
The $43 million increase in net written premiums was primarily due to rate increases that averaged 26% in 2002, which served to offset a decline in premiums resulting from lines of business exited. In addition, premium increases generated by a large quota share contract and new opportunities in the accident and health reinsurance market contributed to premium growth in 2002.
The $28 million reduction in underwriting losses compared with the first quarter of 2001 is attributable to improved rate adequacy and risk selection, as well as less unfavorable development in casualty business written in prior years.
2001 vs. 2000
A significant portion of the 70% increase in net written premium volume over 2000 was due to additional premiums recorded on business from the underwriting years 2000 and 1999. St. Paul Re had been conservative in recording estimated premiums from ceding companies in a soft market environment, but as rate increases began to accelerate faster than anticipated, it was determined that estimated premiums to be received from cedents for the underwriting years 2000 and 1999 were under accrued. St. Paul Re recorded the increase in premium from those years in 2001 as the revenue materialized. In addition, new business from large quota share contracts accounted for approximately $65 million of premium growth in 2001, and accident and health new business contributed approximately $51 million to premium volume for the year.
The reported underwriting result in 2001 included losses from underwriting years prior to 2001. These losses were centered in surplus lines and first-dollar auto reinsurance coverages. The surplus lines losses primarily resulted from higher than expected frequency of losses associated with program business. In particular, the experience attributable to certain black car and tow truck programs was worse than expected. In addition, competitive market conditions in the earlier underwriting years contributed to a soft pricing environment for surplus lines reinsurance in those years. The first-dollar auto losses in 2001 were primarily the result of unfavorable emergence stemming from the binders and professional indemnity book.
2000 vs. 1999
The 39% increase in net premium volume in 2000 compared with 1999 was largely driven by new business. In 2000, St. Paul Re entered the accident and health market to take advantage of significant improvements in the medical stop loss market. This business accounted for $33 million of written premiums in 2000. In addition, a large quota share treaty also contributed $45 million in
155
new premium volume in 2000. North American surplus lines casualty business written by St. Paul Re's London operations increased by $23 million in 2000, due to price increases and the withdrawal of other surplus lines underwriters in London.
The reported underwriting loss for 2000 deteriorated significantly to $114 million, compared with an underwriting profit of $47 million in 1999. In 2000, St. Paul Re started to experience an increase in claims reported from underwriting years 1997 through 1999 which had not been evident in 1999.
North American Property
The North American Property segment consisted of property reinsurance business underwritten for customers with exposures in the United States and Canada. In 2001, coverages offered included proportional, per-risk, excess-of-loss reinsurance and excess and surplus lines insurance, and catastrophe treaties. This segment also included the results of retrocessional reinsurance business, and crop and agricultural reinsurance. As discussed earlier in this prospectus, in 2002, St. Paul narrowed its reinsurance product focus in an effort to improve profitability. As a result, the North American Property segment offered the following coverage in the first quarter of 2002: property catastrophe, property pro rata and property risk excess-of-loss. The following table summarizes results for this segment for the periods presented, and excludes the impact of the reinsurance treaties and the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack.
| Three Months Ended March 31, | Year Ended December 31 | ||||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | |||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 64 | $ | 54 | $ | 230 | $ | 218 | $ | 254 | ||||||
Percentage increase (decrease) over prior year | 19 | % | 6 | % | (14 | %) | ||||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | 25 | $ | 2 | $ | (39 | ) | $ | (51 | ) | $ | (87 | ) | |||
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio | 35.0 | % | 65.0 | % | 88.1 | % | 91.6 | % | 106.1 | % | ||||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 26.2 | % | 30.7 | % | 28.8 | % | 30.6 | % | 28.7 | % | ||||||
Combined ratio | 61.2 | % | 95.7 | % | 116.9 | % | 122.2 | % | 134.8 | % | ||||||
Three Months Ended March 31, 2002 vs. Three Months Ended March 31, 2001
The $10 million increase in net written premiums over the first quarter of 2001 was due to rate increases that averaged 30% in 2002, which more than offset the significant decline in business volume resulting from St. Paul Re's withdrawal from or reduction in several lines of business in this segment.
The significant improvement in underwriting results in 2002 reflected the impact of exiting unprofitable lines of business, rate increases and a lack of significant catastrophe losses.
2001 vs. 2000
The 6% increase in premium volume in 2001 over 2000 was primarily due to rate increases throughout this segment, the impact of which were substantially offset by a deliberate reduction in business volume for crop reinsurance and retrocessional reinsurance due to unfavorable treaty terms and conditions. Price increases for risk excess-of-loss reinsurance grew substantially as the year progressed, reflecting the impact of poor results on prior treaties. Proportional premium volume grew nearly 40% over 2000, primarily due to price increases.
156
The improvement in underwriting results compared with 2000 was primarily due to a reduction in retrocessional reinsurance losses. St. Paul Re began exiting unprofitable lines of the retrocessional market in 2000, and by the end of 2001, underwrote a minimal amount of that business. Proportional reinsurance coverages produced improved results over 2000, largely due to favorable loss development on 1999 and prior underwriting years. These improvements were partially offset by deterioration in North American reinsurance results from business underwritten in London. In addition, excess-of-loss reinsurance results in 2001 suffered from the effects of tropical storm Allison, which struck the southeastern United States in the spring. Crop reinsurance losses were significant in 2001, due to adverse loss development on both 2001 and 2000 underwriting year business. Several hailstorms in the U.S. played a major factor in the 2001 underwriting year losses. In addition, crop reinsurance results in 2001 reflected the negative impact of competitive market conditions in prior years that resulted in a soft pricing environment for this business.
2000 vs. 1999
The 14% decline in net premium volume in 2000 compared with 1999 reflected an intentional reduction in business volume due to concerns about underlying price levels, catastrophe exposures and unsatisfactory treaty terms. Retrocessional net premiums declined approximately 27%, and proportional volume was down 45% from 1999 levels. Near the end of 2000, some underlying price improvement emerged due to the continuing deterioration in results for reinsurers.
With the exception of catastrophe business, all lines of business recorded unprofitable results in 2000. Excess-of-loss business showed improvement over 1999, due to the lack of catastrophe losses and favorable prior-year development. Proportional business results deteriorated from 1999, due to loss development from the 1999 underwriting year. Per risk excess-of-loss results were also worse than 1999. Crop reinsurance results in 2000 deteriorated from 1999, and retrocessional business from the London market produced significant losses despite a declining book of business.
International
In 2001, St. Paul Re's International segment underwrote property and casualty reinsurance for customers domiciled outside of North America. This segment also included results from marine and aerospace business for customers located throughout the world, because of the global nature of those exposures. As discussed earlier in this prospectus, in 2002, St. Paul narrowed its reinsurance product focus in an effort to improve profitability. As a result, the International segment offered the following coverages in the first quarter of 2002: property catastrophe, property pro rata, property risk excess-of-loss and marine coverages. The following table summarizes results for this segment for the periods presented, and excludes the impact of the reinsurance treaties and the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack.
| Three Months Ended March 31, | Year Ended December 31 | ||||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | |||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 120 | $ | 134 | $ | 255 | $ | 176 | $ | 212 | ||||||
Percentage increase (decrease) over prior year | (10 | %) | 45 | % | (17 | %) | ||||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | 28 | 20 | $ | 24 | $ | (47 | ) | $ | (73 | ) | ||||||
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio | 29.9 | % | 38.1 | % | 65.8 | % | 88.9 | % | 96.5 | % | ||||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 17.2 | % | 18.2 | % | 23.7 | % | 36.1 | % | 38.2 | % | ||||||
Combined ratio | 47.1 | % | 56.3 | % | 89.5 | % | 125.0 | % | 134.7 | % | ||||||
157
Three Months Ended March 31, 2002 vs. Three Months Ended March 31, 2001
The $14 million decrease in net written premiums in 2002 was due to St. Paul Re's decision to exit the aviation market and close certain international offices. Rate increases averaging 49% in the International segment partially offset these declines.
The $8 million increase in underwriting gain is mainly attributable to favorable development on prior year reserves across all lines. Also contributing to the increase in underwriting gain is the absence of catastrophe losses in the quarter and significant rate increases achieved in 2002.
2001 vs. 2000
The 45% increase in net premiums over 2000 reflected improving market conditions in 2001, characterized by significant rate increases and increasingly favorable terms and conditions on new and renewal business during the year. The magnitude of year-over-year premium growth in 2001 was partially aided by St. Paul Re's deliberate actions in 2000 to reduce premium volume in certain underperforming lines of business, including proportional treaty business and low-level per risk excess-of-loss business. Net premium growth in 2001 was centered in property coverages, where rate increases averaged 33% for the year. For marine coverages, rate increases averaged 20% in 2001.
During 2001, St. Paul Re sought to take advantage of market conditions and realign its portfolio by further reducing underperforming business volume, and expanding new business in virtually all of its remaining operations. The significant improvement in the loss ratio compared with 2000 reflected the success of those efforts, and also reflected a significant decline in catastrophe losses. In 2001, the only major catastrophe affecting the International segment (excluding the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack) was the explosion of a chemical plant in Toulouse, France, which resulted in $13 million of incurred losses. By contrast, 2000 results included a cumulative total of $34 million of catastrophe losses, the majority of which resulted from additional loss development from severe windstorms that struck portions of Europe in late 1999.
2000 vs. 1999
The 17% decline in 2000 net premiums written compared with 1999 resulted from St. Paul Re's deliberate reduction in pro rata property business volume due to unacceptable underwriting conditions. In addition, St. Paul Re changed the method it used to estimate reinsurance premiums in the International segment for the 1999 underwriting year following St. Paul's merger with USF&G Corporation in 1998 and the subsequent integration of F&G Re, the reinsurance department of USF&G into St. Paul Re's operations. Throughout the majority of 2000, worldwide reinsurance market conditions remained unfavorable, and St. Paul Re maintained a cautious approach to premium growth in the International arena. However, the spate of large catastrophe losses which occurred in late 1999 and affected calendar year 2000 results proved to be the catalyst for an increase in property catastrophe reinsurance pricing. In the last quarter of 2000, the soft market conditions that had prevailed for several years began to improve, laying the groundwork for significantly improved operating conditions in 2001.
Although 2000 was relatively free from major natural catastrophes, adverse development from the aforementioned 1999 catastrophic events contributed significantly to St. Paul Re's reported results in 2000. Of the $34 million of catastrophe losses incurred in 2000, the only significant events that actually occurred in 2000 were a series of storm and flood losses in the United Kingdom, which resulted in losses of $13 million.
In 1999, market conditions were difficult due to excess capacity and severe competition in the reinsurance sector. Overall pricing continued to be inadequate as worldwide reinsurers competed
158
for market share in a stagnant worldwide non-life insurance market. St. Paul Re's International segment loss ratio in 1999 suffered from a total of $63 million of catastrophe losses resulting from earthquakes in Taiwan and Turkey, Typhoon Bart in Japan, Hurricane Floyd, and the severe windstorms in Northern Europe.
Finite Risk
In 2001, St. Paul Re's Finite Risk segment underwrote non-traditional reinsurance treaties for leading insurance and reinsurance companies worldwide. Non-traditional reinsurance combines limited traditional underwriting risk with financial risk protection and is generally utilized by sophisticated insurers who are willing to share in a portion of their insurance losses. Products include multi-year excess-of-loss treaties, aggregate stop loss treaties, finite quota share treaties, loss portfolio transfers, and adverse loss development covers. This segment also included bond and credit reinsurance coverages. As discussed earlier in this prospectus, in 2002, St. Paul narrowed its reinsurance product focus in an effort to improve profitability. As a result, the Finite Risk segment offered the following coverages in the first quarter of 2002: multi-year excess-of-loss, aggregate stop loss, finite quota share, loss portfolio transfer and adverse loss development contracts. The following table summarizes results for this segment for the periods presented, and excludes the impact of the reinsurance treaties and the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack.
| Three Months Ended March 31, | Year Ended December 31, | ||||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | |||||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 96 | $ | 96 | $ | 424 | $ | 418 | $ | 311 | ||||||
Percentage increase (decrease) over prior year | — | % | 1 | % | 34 | % | ||||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | (7 | ) | $ | (7 | ) | $ | (57 | ) | $ | (28 | ) | $ | 26 | ||
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio | 73.4 | % | 53.9 | % | 80.7 | % | 70.5 | % | 77.3 | % | ||||||
Underwriting expense ratio | 30.5 | % | 53.5 | % | 33.5 | % | 35.7 | % | 17.6 | % | ||||||
Combined ratio | 103.9 | % | 107.4 | % | 114.2 | % | 106.2 | % | 94.9 | % | ||||||
Three Months Ended March 31, 2002 vs. Three Months Ended March 31, 2001
Net written premiums for the quarter ended March 31, 2002 of $96 million were level with the same 2001 period. Premium volume decreased by approximately $22 million compared with the first quarter of 2001 due to St. Paul Re's decision to exit the bond and credit market; however, that decline was fully offset by a $25 million positive premium adjustment related to one finite quota share contract.
The $7 million underwriting loss in the first quarter of 2002 was impacted by adverse prior-year marine and aviation loss development, as well as adverse loss experience on the bond and credit business in runoff. The $7 million loss in the same period of 2001 was primarily due to an $11 million loss related to the Petrobras oil platform collapse in March 2001.
2001 vs. 2000
Net written premiums grew slightly in 2001 over an abnormally large premium base in 2000 that had resulted from three large new contracts and additional premiums related to a specific contract. Bond and credit reinsurance coverages accounted for $63 million of net written premium volume in 2001, compared with $62 million in 2000.
159
The deterioration in underwriting results in 2001 was primarily due to $31 million of losses generated by bond and credit reinsurance, of which $15 million resulted from surety bond losses related to Enron Corporation's bankruptcy filing in late 2001. Bond and credit losses in 2000 totaled $2 million. In addition, the Finite Risk segment incurred $39 million of losses from three major marine and aviation events: the collapse of the Petrobras oil platform; a terrorist group's ground attack on commercial airliners in Sri Lanka; and the chemical plant explosion in Toulouse, France.
2000 vs. 1999
Net written premiums in 2000 increased $107 million over 1999, of which $67 million collectively resulted from the origination of two new loss portfolio transfer contracts and one new finite quota share treaty. In addition, $47 million of additional written premiums were recognized on a specific aggregate stop-loss contract due to adverse loss development.
Additional loss development from the severe storms that struck portions of Europe in late 1999 accounted for $36 million of underwriting losses in 2000 in the Finite Risk segment. However, $52 million in underwriting profits were recognized in 2000 from five large treaties that were either commuted or experienced favorable loss development.
During 2000, the Finite Risk segment reduced its estimate of ultimate losses on certain non-traditional reinsurance business by $56 million, and correspondingly increased its estimate of profit commission reserves by $66 million. Excluding these changes, the loss ratio would have been 84.2%, and the expense ratio would have been 19.6%.
Capital Resources and Liquidity
St. Paul Re's primary sources of capital resources and liquidity were premium revenues received from its reinsurance business, and capital contributions, when necessary, from St. Paul. As a component of St. Paul's consolidated operations, St. Paul Re was dependent upon St. Paul to provide the necessary capital to adequately support the level of its business operations.
Market risk can be described as the risk of change in fair value of a financial instrument due to changes in interest rates, equity prices, creditworthiness, foreign exchange rates or other factors. As a component of St. Paul's consolidated operations with no invested assets of its own, St. Paul Re had no direct exposure to these various types of market risk, except for the potential impact of changes in foreign currency exchange rates on its insurance reserves. St. Paul actively managed its exposure to such foreign currency risks by purchasing investments denominated in foreign currencies to hedge insurance reserves denominated in the same currencies, which effectively reduced its foreign currency exchange rate exposure.
Reserves for Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses for Predecessor Business
General Information
Losses represent the amounts paid, or expected to be paid, to ceding companies for events that have occurred. The cost of investigating, resolving and processing these claims are known as loss adjusting expenses, or LAE. Reserves are established that reflect the estimated unpaid total cost of these two items. These reserves include estimates of the total cost of claims that were reported, but not yet paid, and the cost of claims incurred but not yet reported or IBNR. The reserves for unpaid losses, and LAE at December 31, 2001 cover claims that were incurred not only in 2001 but also in prior years. Loss reserves are reduced for estimates of salvage and subrogation.
160
Because many of the reinsurance coverages offered by St. Paul Re involve losses that may not ultimately be settled for many years after they are incurred, subjective adjustments as to ultimate exposure to losses are an integral and necessary component of the loss reserving process. The inherent uncertainties of estimating loss reserves are further exacerbated for reinsurers by the significant times that often elapse between the occurrence of an insured loss, the reporting of that loss to the primary insurer and, ultimately to the reinsurer, and the primary insurers payment of that loss and subsequent indemnification by the reinsurer. Reserves are recorded by considering a range of estimates bounded by a high point and a low point. Within that range, management's best estimate is recorded. Reserves are continually reviewed, using various statistical and actuarial techniques to analyze current claim costs, frequency and severity data, and prevailing economic, social and legal factors. Reserves established in prior years are adjusted as loss experience develops and new information becomes available. Adjustments to previously estimated reserves are reflected in financial results in periods in which they are made.
While the carried reserves make a reasonable provision for unpaid loss and LAE obligations, it should be noted that the process of estimating required reserves does, by its very nature, involve uncertainty. The level of uncertainty can be influenced by factors such as the existence of long-tail coverage (when loss payments may occur for several years) and changes in claims handling practices, as well as factors noted above, and actual claim payments and LAE could be significantly different than estimates.
Liabilities for unpaid losses and LAE related to certain assumed reinsurance contracts are discounted to the present value of estimated future payments. Prior to discounting, these liabilities totaled $306.4 million, $198.7 million, and $72.7 million at December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999 respectively. The total discounted liability reflected on our combined statements of identifiable underwriting assets and liabilities was $264.9 million, $146.7 million and $47.6 million at December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively. During 2001, $33 million of discount was amortized and $85 million of additional discount was accrued. The liabilities related to these reinsurance contracts were discounted using rates up to 7.5%, based on our return on invested assets or, in many cases, on yields contractually guaranteed to us on funds held by the ceding company, as permitted by the state of domicile, the Vermont Department of Banking, Insurance, Securities and Healthcare Administration.
Ten-year Development
The table below presents a development of net loss and LAE reserve liabilities and payments for the years 1992 through 2001. The top line on the table shows the estimated liability for unpaid losses and LAE, net of reinsurance recoverables, recorded at the balance sheet date for each of the years indicated.
In 1997, St. Paul changed the method by which it assigned loss activity to a particular year for assumed reinsurance written by our U.K.-based reinsurance operation, a component of St. Paul Re. Prior to 1997, that loss activity was assigned to the year in which the underlying reinsurance contract was written. In 1997, our analysis indicated that an excess amount of loss activity was being assigned to prior years because of this practice. As a result, we implemented an improved procedure in 1997 that more accurately assigns loss activity for this business to the year in which it occurred. This change had the impact of increasing favorable development on previously established reserves by approximately $110 million in 1997. There was no net impact on total incurred losses, however, because there was a corresponding increase in the provision for current year loss activity in 1997. Development data for individual years prior to 1997 in this table were not restated to reflect this new procedure because reliable data to do so was not available.
161
The upper portion of the table, which shows the re-estimated amounts relating to the previously recorded liabilities, is based upon experience as of the end of each succeeding year. These estimates are either increased or decreased as further information becomes known about individual claims and as changes in the trend of claim frequency and severity become apparent.
The "Cumulative redundancy (deficiency)" line on the table for any given year represents the aggregate change in the estimates for all years subsequent to the year the reserves were initially established. For example, the 1992 net reserve of $2,265 million developed to $2,231 million, or a $34 million redundancy, by the end of 1994. By the end of 2001, the 1992 reserve had developed a redundancy of $518 million. The changes in the estimate of 1992 loss reserves were reflected in operations during the past nine years. Likewise, the deficiency that developed with respect to year-end 2000 reserves was reflected in our results of operations for 2001.
In 1993, St. Paul Re adopted the provisions of SFAS No. 113, "Accounting and Reporting for Reinsurance of Short-Duration and Long-Duration Contracts". This statement required, among other things, that reinsurance recoverables on unpaid losses and LAE be shown as an asset, instead of the prior practice of netting this amount against insurance reserves for balance sheet reporting purposes.
The middle portion of the table, which includes data for only those periods impacted since the adoption of SFAS No. 113 (the years 1992 through 2001), represents a reconciliation between the net reserve liability as shown on the top line of the table and the gross reserve liability as shown in St. Paul Re's combined statements of identifiable underwriting assets and liabilities on page F-13 of this prospectus. This portion of the table also presents the gross re-estimated reserve liability as of the end of the latest re-estimation period (December 31, 2001) and the related re-estimated reinsurance recoverable.
The lower portion of the table presents the cumulative amounts paid with respect to the previously recorded liability as of the end of each succeeding year. For example, as of December 31, 2001, $1,573 million of the currently estimated $1,747 million of net losses and LAE that have been incurred for the years up to and including 1992 have been paid. Thus, as of December 31, 2001, it is estimated that $174 million of net incurred losses and LAE have yet to be paid for the years up to and including 1992.
Caution should be exercised in evaluating the information shown in this table. It should be noted that each amount includes the effects of all changes in amounts for prior periods. For example, the portion of the development shown for year-end 1996 reserves that relates to 1991 losses is included in the cumulative redundancy (deficiency) for the years 1991 through 1996.
In addition, the table presents calendar year data. It does not present accident or policy year development data, which some readers may be more accustomed to analyzing. The social, economic and legal conditions and other trends which have had an impact on the changes in the estimated liability in the past are not necessarily indicative of the future. Accordingly, readers are cautioned against extrapolating any conclusions about future results from the information presented in this table.
Note 4 to the combined statements, on page F-22 St. Paul Re's combined statements, includes a reconciliation of beginning and ending loss reserve liabilities for each of the last three years and is incorporated herein by reference. Additional information about our reserves is contained in Note 4 of St. Paul Re's combined statements on page F-22 of this prospectus.
162
Analysis of Loss and Loss Adjustment Expense (LAE) Development
| Year ended December 31 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 1992 | 1993 | 1994 | 1995 | 1996 | 1997 | 1998 | 1999 | 2000 | 2001 | |||||||||||||||||||||
| | | | | ($ in millions) | | | | | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Net liability for unpaid losses and LAE | $ | 2,265 | $ | 2,189 | $ | 2,241 | $ | 2,424 | $ | 2,695 | $ | 3,116 | $ | 3,226 | $ | 2,855 | $ | 2,666 | $ | 3,693 | |||||||||||
Liability re-estimated as of: | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
One year later | 2,225 | 2,179 | 2,218 | 2,431 | 2,758 | 3,040 | 3,058 | 2,730 | 2,761 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Two years later | 2,231 | 2,158 | 2,246 | 2,476 | 2,689 | 2,712 | 2,754 | 2,744 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Three years later | 2,211 | 2,179 | 2,272 | 2,423 | 2,239 | 2,447 | 2,739 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Four year later | 2,231 | 2,202 | 2,225 | 2,065 | 2,094 | 2,439 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Five years later | 2,262 | 2,168 | 1,874 | 1,853 | 2,073 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Six years later | 2,238 | 1,803 | 1,681 | 1,841 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Seven years later | 1,870 | 1,649 | 1,669 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Eight years later | 1,749 | 1,646 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Nine years later | 1,747 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Ten years later | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Gross cumulative redundancy (deficiency) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Cumulative redundancy (deficiency) | $ | 518 | $ | 542 | $ | 572 | $ | 583 | $ | 622 | $ | 677 | $ | 487 | $ | 111 | $ | (95 | ) | — | |||||||||||
Net liability for unpaid losses and LAE | $ | 2,265 | $ | 2,189 | $ | 2,241 | $ | 2,424 | $ | 2,695 | $ | 3,116 | $ | 3,226 | $ | 2,855 | $ | 2,666 | $ | 3,693 | |||||||||||
Reinsurance recoverable on unpaid losses | 714 | 687 | 694 | 674 | 669 | 613 | 251 | 596 | 902 | 1,256 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Gross Liability | 2,979 | 2,876 | 2,935 | 3,098 | 3,365 | 3,729 | 3,477 | 3,451 | 3,568 | 4,949 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Gross re-estimated liability | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
One year later | 2,931 | 2,865 | 2,909 | 3,113 | 3,436 | 3,208 | 3,356 | 3,325 | 3,664 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Two years later | 2,939 | 2,841 | 2,946 | 3,166 | 2,917 | 3,039 | 3,069 | 3,428 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Three years later | 2,916 | 2,871 | 2,979 | 2,715 | 2,714 | 2,784 | 3,123 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Four year later | 2,944 | 2,901 | 2,579 | 2,491 | 2,474 | 2,837 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Five years later | 2,984 | 2,553 | 2,352 | 2,279 | 2,505 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Six years later | 2,684 | 2,302 | 2,154 | 2,312 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Seven years later | 2,423 | 2,143 | 2,182 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Eight years later | 2,294 | 2,176 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Nine years later | 2,324 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Ten years later | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Gross cumulative redundancy (deficiency) | $ | 655 | $ | 700 | $ | 754 | $ | 786 | $ | 860 | $ | 893 | $ | 354 | $ | 23 | $ | (96 | ) | — | |||||||||||
163
Cumulative amount of net liability paid through: | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
One year later | $ | 492 | $ | 369 | $ | 339 | $ | 365 | $ | 357 | $ | 414 | $ | 696 | $ | 780 | $ | 663 | |||||||||||||
Two years later | 768 | 620 | 579 | 599 | 640 | 967 | 1,318 | 1,343 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Three years later | 951 | 792 | 736 | 780 | 1,071 | 1,425 | 1,650 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Four years later | 1,079 | 905 | 863 | 1,117 | 1,416 | 1,640 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Five years later | 1,154 | 998 | 1,134 | 1,375 | 1,544 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Six years later | 1,212 | 1,217 | 1,336 | 1,453 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Seven years later | 1,399 | 1,391 | 1,387 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Eight years later | 1,544 | 1,431 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Nine years later | 1,573 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Ten years later | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Cumulative amount of gross liability paid through: | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
One year later | $ | 551 | $ | 410 | $ | 376 | $ | 397 | $ | 381 | $ | 439 | $ | 746 | $ | 838 | $ | 706 | |||||||||||||
Two years later | 861 | 689 | 643 | 650 | 685 | 1,033 | 1,410 | 1,435 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Three years later | 1,068 | 882 | 817 | 847 | 1,152 | 1,523 | 1,760 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Four years later | 1,212 | 1,007 | 957 | 1,217 | 1,525 | 1,749 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Five years later | 1,297 | 1,110 | 1,258 | 1,500 | 1,661 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Six years later | 1,362 | 1,355 | 1,483 | 1,584 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Seven years later | 1,572 | 1,548 | 1,539 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Eight years later | 1,734 | 1,593 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Nine years later | 1,767 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Ten years later |
164
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND FINANCIAL INFORMATION
| Page | |
---|---|---|
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. | ||
Independent Auditors' Report | F-2 | |
Consolidated Balance Sheet | F-3 | |
Notes to Consolidated Balance Sheet | F-4 | |
The St. Paul Companies, Inc. Reinsurance Underwriting Segment (Predecessor) | ||
Independent Auditors' Report | F-12 | |
Combined Statements—As of December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999 | F-13 | |
Notes to Combined Statements—As of December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999 | F-16 | |
Combined Statements—As of March 31, 2002 and 2001 | F-29 | |
Notes to Combined Statements—As of March 31, 2002 and 2001 | F-32 |
F-1
The Board Of Directors And Shareholder
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd.:
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheet of Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and subsidiary (the Company) as of April 24, 2002 (date of inception). This financial statement is the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on this financial statement based on our audit.
We conducted our audit in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statement is free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statement. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
In our opinion, the financial statement referred to above presents fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and subsidiary as of April 24, 2002 (date of inception), in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.
/s/ KPMG LLP
Minneapolis, Minnesota
April 24, 2002, except
as to Note 11, which
is as of June 1, 2002
F-2
PLATINUM UNDERWRITERS HOLDINGS, LTD.
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
April 24, 2002 (date of inception)
ASSETS | |||
Cash held in trust | $ | 12,000 | |
SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY | |||
Common Shares—(par value $1.00; 12,000 shares; authorized, issued and outstanding) | 12,000 | ||
Additional paid-in capital | — | ||
Total shareholder's equity | $ | 12,000 | |
See accompanying notes to consolidated balance sheet.
F-3
PLATINUM UNDERWRITERS HOLDINGS, LTD.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
April 24, 2002 (date of inception)
1. Organization
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. ("Platinum Holdings") was incorporated on April 19, 2002 and was capitalized on April 24, 2002 under the laws of Bermuda, to hold subsidiaries that provide property, casualty and other reinsurance to insurers and reinsurers on a worldwide basis. Platinum Holdings will operate through wholly-owned subsidiaries established and to be established or acquired, including Platinum Underwriters Reinsurance, Inc. ("Platinum US"), Platinum Re (UK) Limited ("Platinum UK"), and Platinum Underwriters Bermuda, Ltd. ("Platinum Bermuda") (collectively referred to as the "Company"). Platinum Holdings will own Platinum Bermuda directly and will own Platinum US and Platinum UK through Platinum Regency Holdings ("Platinum Ireland"), a wholly owned intermediate Irish holding company to be formed.
Platinum Bermuda will be formed under the laws of Bermuda and will be licensed under the Bermuda Insurance Act of 1978, as amended (the "Bermuda Insurance Act") and related regulations.
Platinum US (currently named USF&G Family Insurance Company) was incorporated in 1995 under the laws of Maryland and is licensed under the Maryland insurance laws and related regulations. USF&G Family Insurance Company will change its name to Platinum Underwriters Reinsurance, Inc. and will be acquired by Platinum Holdings at the time of the consummation of Platinum Holdings' initial public offering (the "Public Offering").
Platinum UK was incorporated on April 10, 2002 under the laws of the United Kingdom and will be licensed under the Financial Services and Market Act 2000 ("FSMA") and related regulations.
The Company's initial capitalization of $12,000, as reflected in the consolidated balance sheet, was provided by an organizing trust.
Concurrent with the Public Offering, the Company has agreed to sell Common Shares to The St. Paul Companies, Inc. ("St. Paul") in a private placement in exchange for certain assets contributed by St. Paul. This private placement is discussed in more detail in Note 3.
2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
Accounting Principles
These financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America ("U.S. GAAP").
The Company's business will be written through various underwriting subsidiaries, which will be required to file statutory financial statements with state and foreign regulatory authorities. The accounting principles used to prepare these statutory financial statements may differ from U.S. GAAP.
Consolidation
The April 24, 2002 inception date balance sheet consolidates the balance sheets of Platinum Holdings and Platinum UK, with Platinum UK capitalized on a very nominal basis. Platinum US will be acquired by Platinum Holdings on the consummation of Platinum Holdings' Public Offering, at which time the balance sheet of Platinum US will be consolidated into the balance sheet of Platinum Holdings. At the date of inception of Platinum Holdings, Platinum Bermuda and Platinum
F-4
Ireland had not yet been formed. Subsequent to the Public Offering, the Company will combine its financial statements with those of its subsidiaries and will present them on a consolidated basis. Transactions between the Company and its subsidiaries or among its subsidiaries will be eliminated in consolidation.
Cash
Cash of $12,000 is held in trust at Conyers, Dill & Pearman on behalf of Platinum Holdings.
Organizational Costs
Costs incurred by the Company relating to its organization will be expensed as incurred.
As the Company becomes active in the underwriting of reinsurance, it intends to record transactions based on the following accounting policies, which are consistent with U.S. GAAP.
Use of Estimates
The Company's financial statements will include estimates and assumptions that have an effect on the amounts reported. The most significant estimates will be those relating to reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses. These estimates will be continually reviewed and adjustments made as necessary, but actual results could be significantly different than expected at the time such estimates are made. Results of changes in estimates will be reflected in results of operations in the period in which the change is made.
Premiums Earned
Assumed reinsurance premiums will be recognized as revenues proportionately over the coverage period. Premiums earned will be recorded in the statements of operations, net of our cost to purchase reinsurance. Premiums not yet recognized as revenue will be recorded in the balance sheet as unearned premiums, gross of any ceded unearned premiums. Written and earned premiums, and the related costs, which have not yet been reported to the Company will be estimated and accrued. Due to the time lag inherent in reporting of premiums by cedents, such estimated premiums written and earned, as well as related costs, may be significant. Differences between such estimates and actual amounts will be recorded in the period in which the actual amounts are determined.
Reinstatement and additional premiums will be accrued as provided for in the provisions of assumed reinsurance contracts and based on experience under such contracts. Reinstatement premiums are the premiums charged for the restoration of the reinsurance limit of a catastrophe contract to its full amount after payment by the reinsurer of losses as a result of an occurrence. These premiums relate to the future coverage obtained during the remainder of the initial policy term, and are earned over the remaining policy term. Additional premiums are premiums charged after coverage has expired, related to experience during the policy term, which are earned immediately. An allowance for uncollectible premiums will be established for possible non-payment of such amounts due, as deemed necessary.
F-5
Insurance Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
Losses represent the amounts paid, or expected to be paid, to ceding companies for events that have occurred. The costs of investigating, resolving and processing these claims are known as loss adjustment expenses ("LAE"). These items will be recorded on the Company's statements of operations, net of ceded reinsurance, meaning that gross losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred will be reduced by the amounts recovered or expected to be recovered under retrocessional contracts.
Reinsurance
Written premiums, earned premiums, and incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses will reflect the net effects of assumed and ceded reinsurance transactions. Reinsurance accounting will be followed for assumed and ceded transactions when risk transfer requirements have been met. These requirements involve significant assumptions being made related to the amount and timing of expected cash flows, as well as the interpretation of underlying contract terms. Assumed reinsurance contracts that do not transfer significant insurance risk are required to be accounted for as deposits. These contract deposits will be accounted for as financing transactions, with interest expense credited to the contract deposit.
Insurance Reserves
The reserves for losses and LAE will be estimated based on reports received from ceding companies, supplemented by the Company's estimates of reserves for which ceding company reports have not been received and by the Company's own historical experience. To the extent that the Company's own historical experience is inadequate for estimating reserves, such estimates may be based upon industry experience and management's judgment. These reserves will include estimates of the total cost of claims that were reported, but not yet paid, and the cost of claims incurred but not yet reported ("IBNR"). Loss reserves will be reduced for estimated amounts of salvage and subrogation recoveries. Estimated amounts recoverable from reinsurers on unpaid losses and LAE will be reflected as assets. We currently intend to make arrangements to permit us to discount the liability for certain assumed reinsurance contracts using rates based on our return on invested assets or, in many cases, on yields contractually guaranteed to us on funds held by the ceding company.
For reported losses, reserves will be established on a "case" basis within the parameters of coverage provided in the underlying insurance policy and reinsurance agreement. For IBNR losses, reserves will be estimated using established actuarial methods. Case and IBNR reserve estimates will consider such variables as past loss experience, changes in legislative conditions, changes in judicial interpretation of legal liability and policy coverages, and inflation.
Because many of the reinsurance coverages offered by the Company will likely involve claims that may not ultimately be settled for many years after they are incurred, subjective judgments as to ultimate exposure to losses will be an integral and necessary component of the loss reserving process. The inherent uncertainties of estimating loss reserves are further exacerbated for reinsurers by the significant amount of time that often elapses between the occurrence of an insured loss, the reporting of that loss to the primary insurer and, ultimately to the reinsurer, and the primary
F-6
insurer's payment of that loss and subsequent indemnification by the reinsurer. Reserves will be recorded considering a range of estimates bounded by a high and low point. Within that range, management's best estimate will be recorded. Reserves will be continually reviewed, using a variety of statistical and actuarial techniques to analyze current claim costs, frequency and severity data, and prevailing economic, social and legal factors. Reserves established in prior years will be adjusted as loss experience develops and new information becomes available. Adjustments to previously estimated reserves will be reflected in financial results in the periods in which they are made. It should be noted that the process of estimating required reserves does, by its very nature, involve uncertainty. The level of uncertainty can be influenced by factors such as the existence of long tail coverage (when loss payments may not occur for several years) and changes in claim handling practices, as well as the factors noted above, and actual claim payments and LAE could be significantly different from the estimates.
Policy Acquisition Expenses
The costs directly related to the acquisition of reinsurance contracts are referred to as policy acquisition expenses and consist of commissions and other direct underwriting expenses. Although these expenses are incurred when a reinsurance contract is written, such expenses will be deferred and amortized over the same period as the corresponding premiums are recorded as earned revenues.
On a regular basis, an analysis of the recoverability of the deferred policy acquisition expenses, in relation to the expected recognition of revenues, including anticipated investment income will be performed. Any adjustments will be reflected as period costs. Should the analysis indicate that the acquisition costs are unrecoverable, further analyses are completed to determine if a reserve is required to provide for losses which may exceed the related unearned premiums.
Foreign Currency Translation
The Company's functional currency will be the United States dollar. Foreign currency transactions will be remeasured to the functional currency, and the resulting foreign exchange gains or losses will be reflected in income. The remeasurement will be calculated using current exchange rates for the balance sheet amounts and average exchange rates for revenues and expenses.
Investments
The Company's entire fixed income portfolio will be classified as available-for-sale, and thus will be carried at estimated fair value, with the difference between amortized cost and fair value charged or credited directly to shareholders' equity. Fair values will be based on quoted market prices, where available, from a third-party pricing service. If quoted market prices are not available, fair values will be estimated using values obtained from independent pricing services or a cash flow estimate will be used. Short-term investments will be carried at cost, which the Company expects will approximate fair value.
If the Company invests in equity securities in the future, such securities will also be classified as available for sale and will be carried at estimated fair value, based on quoted market prices obtained from a third-party pricing service.
F-7
Realized gains and losses on disposal of investments will be determined based upon specific identification of the cost of investments sold and will be recorded in the Company's statements of operations.
The difference between the cost and estimated fair value of investments will be monitored. If any of the Company's investments experience a decline in value that is believed to be other than temporary, the investment will be written down and a realized loss will be recorded on the Company's statement of operations. For investments carried at estimated fair value, the difference between cost and fair value, net of any deferred taxes, will be recorded as a part of Shareholders' equity.
Cash equivalents will be carried at amortized cost, which the Company expects will approximate fair value, and will include all securities that, at their purchase date, have a maturity of less than ninety days.
Income Taxes
Income taxes will be recorded under the liability method. Deferred income tax assets or liabilities will be recorded based on differences between tax basis and financial statement amounts that will result in taxable or deductible amounts in future years. A valuation allowance will be established for deferred tax assets where it is more likely than not that future tax benefits will not be realized.
Earnings per Common Share
The calculation of earnings per Common Share will be based upon the weighted average number of Common Shares outstanding using the modified treasury stock method for Common Share options.
3. Formation and Separation Agreement and Initial Public Offering
Concurrent with the Public Offering, the Company will, pursuant to a Formation and Separation Agreement to be entered into with St. Paul, sell 13,262,300 Common Shares to St. Paul in a private placement in exchange for certain assets described in Note 4. The Company refers to this private placement as the "St. Paul Investment". The number of shares to be sold to St. Paul pursuant to the St. Paul Investment is designed to hold its ownership in the Company, following the Public Offering, at an ownership level of up to approximately 24.9%, but with the voting power limited to 9.9% of the outstanding Common Shares. The number of shares privately placed will be subject to increase proportionately, at a price to St. Paul equal to the initial public offering price less underwriting discounts, to the extent the underwriters exercise their over-allotment option to purchase additional Common Shares from Platinum Holdings. In order to maintain the approximate 24.9% ownership level, the total number of shares to be sold to St. Paul is also subject to adjustment if the number of Common Shares offered in the Public Offering is changed hereafter.
F-8
4. Acquisition of Assets from St. Paul
In exchange for the ownership interest discussed in Note 3, St. Paul will transfer to the Company certain tangible assets used in St. Paul's reinsurance operation, including the net assets of Platinum US as well as certain fixed assets such as furniture and equipment, systems and software. Intangible assets to be transferred include broker lists, contract renewal rights and licenses. These assets will be recorded at the values as reflected on St. Paul's books at the time of the transfer.
5. Related Party Transactions
In connection with the organization, initial financing and commencement of operations of the Company, the Company plans to enter into various agreements with St. Paul and its affiliates. These agreements will be put in place to support the operations of Platinum Holdings.
6. Taxation
Under current Bermuda law, the Company will not be required to pay any taxes in Bermuda on either income or capital gains. The Company has received from the Minister of Finance of Bermuda an assurance under The Exempted Undertakings Tax Protection Act, 1966 of Bermuda that in the event of any such taxes being imposed, the Company will be exempted until 2016. There will be no withholding taxes imposed on dividend distributions from Bermuda.
Under current United States law, Platinum US will be subject to the 35% statutory tax rate. A 5% withholding tax will apply to dividends distributed from Platinum US to Platinum Ireland provided Platinum Ireland is entitled to the benefits of the U.S.-Irish Tax Treaty and meets certain other requirements. Gross reinsurance premiums related to U.S. risks that are paid to Platinum Bermuda will be subject to a 1% U.S. excise tax. Platinum UK may file for exemption from this excise tax under the U.S.-U.K. Treaty if it satisfies the requirements of the Treaty. Dividend distributions from the Company to its U.S. shareholders will be subject to U.S. corporate income tax. Shareholders holding less than 10% of the voting power of the Company's shares are not entitled to a dividends-received deduction for earnings related to Platinum US and are not entitled to a U.S. foreign tax credit for foreign taxes paid on earnings related to Platinum UK or Platinum Ireland.
Under current United Kingdom law, Platinum UK will be taxed at the U.K. corporate tax rate (up to 30%). There will be no withholding tax on dividends distributed from Platinum UK to Platinum Ireland.
Under current Irish law, Platinum Ireland will be taxed at a 25% corporate tax rate on non-trading income and a 16% corporate tax rate on trading income (the latter to be reduced to 12.5% as of January 1, 2003). There will be no withholding tax on dividends distributed from Platinum Ireland to the Company.
7. Employee Benefit Plans and Stock Option Plans
The Company intends to offer benefit plans and stock option plans to its employees as a form of compensation.
F-9
8. Reinsurance
The Company's ceded reinsurance program will be structured to protect its operations from potential losses in excess of acceptable levels. Reinsurers will be expected to honor their obligations under ceded reinsurance contracts. In the event these companies are unable to honor their obligations, the Company will pay these amounts. Allowances for uncollectible reinsurance will be established for possible nonpayment of such amounts due, as deemed necessary.
Upon the commencement of the Company's operations, it will enter into Quota Share Retrocession Agreements with St. Paul to transfer to the Company, St. Paul's rights and obligations, under specified reinsurance contracts.
9. Segment Information
Platinum Holdings will have three reportable segments, which will consist of Global Property and Marine, Global Casualty and Finite Risk. These segments are consistent with the global manner in which Platinum Holdings' leadership intends to manage the business.
The Global Property and Marine segment will include principally property and marine reinsurance coverages that will be written by Platinum Holdings, both in the United States and foreign markets. The majority of the property business will consist of catastrophe excess-of-loss reinsurance treaties. The segment will also include property per-risk excess-of-loss treaties and North American property surplus lines treaties. Marine reinsurance will include coverages for hull and cargo, primarily under excess-of-loss treaties.
The Global Casualty segment will include principally general casualty, automotive casualty, workers compensation, and environmental coverages. This segment will also include professional liability coverages, including directors and officers, and errors and omissions reinsurance. Also included will be accident and health reinsurance in the United States, in the form of self-insured medical stop loss coverages. Reinsurance coverages throughout the global casualty segment will generally be in the form of excess-of-loss treaties, including umbrella coverages.
The Finite Risk segment will include principally non-traditional reinsurance treaties for leading insurance companies worldwide. Products will include multi-year funded excess-of-loss treaties, aggregate stop loss treaties, finite quota share treaties, loss portfolio transfers and adverse loss development covers. The classes of risks written through finite products will generally be consistent with the classes covered by Platinum Holdings' traditional reinsurance products.
The accounting policies of the segments will be the same as those described in the summary of significant accounting policies.
10. Statutory Requirements and Dividend Restrictions
Platinum Holdings' insurance subsidiaries will be subject to certain limitations on dividends that may be paid to Platinum Holdings based on solvency or other regulatory requirements in each jurisdiction. Such limitations generally require that dividends be paid from surplus and may require regulatory approval prior to payment.
F-10
11. Subsequent Events
Platinum Bermuda was incorporated on May 9, 2002 under the laws of Bermuda and will be licensed under the Bermuda Insurance Act and related regulations. Platinum Holdings' initial capitalization of $12,000 and subsequent contribution of $108,000 was provided by St. Paul Fire and Marine Insurance Company ("Fire and Marine") to an organizing trust in the form of a limited recourse, non-interest bearing loan. Fire and Marine is a subsidiary of St. Paul. St. Paul is sponsoring the formation of Platinum Holdings.
Platinum Ireland was incorporated on May 3, 2002 under the laws of Ireland.
On May 29, 2002, Platinum Holdings declared a 100-for-1 stock split, whereby the number of common shares authorized, issued and outstanding increased from 12,000 to 1.2 million, and concurrently, the par value changed from $1.00 to $0.01 per common share. Furthermore, Platinum Holdings increased the number of authorized shares from 1.2 million to 135 million.
F-11
The Board Of Directors and Shareholders
The St. Paul Companies, Inc.:
We have audited the accompanying combined statements of identifiable underwriting assets and liabilities of The St. Paul Companies, Inc. Reinsurance Underwriting Segment (Predecessor) as of December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999, and the related combined statements of underwriting results and identifiable underwriting cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2001. The combined statements are the responsibility of the Predecessor's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these combined statements based on our audits.
We conducted our audits in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the combined statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the combined statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall combined statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
The accompanying combined statements were prepared to present the historical underwriting results and identifiable cash flows of the Predecessor and the asset and liability balances specifically attributable to reinsurance underwriting operations of The St. Paul Companies, Inc. (St. Paul) as described in Note 1. The combined statements do not contain an allocation of St. Paul's equity structure, investment portfolio assets, investment income, or cash flows from investing and financing activities. Accordingly, the combined statements are not intended to be a complete presentation of Predecessor's or St. Paul's financial position, results of operations, or cash flows.
In our opinion, the combined statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the identifiable underwriting assets and liabilities of The St. Paul Companies, Inc. Reinsurance Underwriting Segment (Predecessor) as of December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999, and its underwriting results and its identifiable underwriting cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2001 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.
In connection with our audits of the combined statements, we also have audited the related combined financial statement schedules III through V, as listed in the index in Item 16(b) of Form S-1. These financial statement schedules are the responsibility of the Predecessor's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statement schedules based on our audits.
In our opinion, based on our audits such combined financial statement schedules III through V, when considered in relation to the combined statements taken as a whole, present fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein.
/s/ KPMG LLP
Minneapolis, Minnesota
April 23, 2002
F-12
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC.
REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR)
COMBINED STATEMENTS OF UNDERWRITING RESULTS
| Year Ended December 31, | ||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | ||||||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||||||
Net premiums earned | |||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 1,677 | $ | 1,073 | $ | 913 | |||||
Change in unearned premiums | (84 | ) | 48 | (35 | ) | ||||||
Net premiums earned | 1,593 | 1,121 | 878 | ||||||||
Underwriting deductions | |||||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 1,922 | 811 | 500 | ||||||||
Policy acquisition expenses | 315 | 336 | 220 | ||||||||
Other underwriting expenses | 82 | 88 | 82 | ||||||||
Total underwriting deductions | 2,319 | 1,235 | 802 | ||||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | (726 | ) | $ | (114 | ) | $ | 76 | |||
See notes to combined statements.
F-13
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC.
REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR)
COMBINED STATEMENTS OF IDENTIFIABLE UNDERWRITING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
| As of December 31, | |||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | |||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||||
Identifiable Assets | ||||||||||||
Reinsurance recoverables: | ||||||||||||
Unpaid losses | $ | 1,256 | $ | 902 | $ | 596 | ||||||
Paid losses | 38 | 37 | 47 | |||||||||
Premium receivable | 720 | 528 | 530 | |||||||||
Reserve for uncollectible premiums receivable | (13 | ) | (11 | ) | (10 | ) | ||||||
Funds held by reinsureds | 495 | 386 | 246 | |||||||||
Deferred acquisition costs | 107 | 86 | 87 | |||||||||
Ceded unearned premiums | 25 | 20 | 25 | |||||||||
Total identifiable assets | $ | 2,628 | $ | 1,948 | $ | 1,521 | ||||||
Identifiable Liabilities | ||||||||||||
Loss and loss adjustment expense reserves | $ | 4,949 | $ | 3,568 | $ | 3,451 | ||||||
Assumed paid losses payable | 78 | 87 | 52 | |||||||||
Unearned premium reserves | 401 | 315 | 376 | |||||||||
Reinsurance premiums payable | 215 | 208 | 243 | |||||||||
Underwriting expenses payable | 181 | 262 | 200 | |||||||||
Funds held under reinsurance treaties | 169 | 71 | 52 | |||||||||
Profit commission reserves | 110 | 196 | 140 | |||||||||
Financial reinsurance Liability | 67 | 27 | 0 | |||||||||
Total identifiable liabilities | $ | 6,170 | $ | 4,734 | $ | 4,514 | ||||||
See notes to combined statements.
F-14
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC.
REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR)
COMBINED STATEMENTS OF IDENTIFIABLE UNDERWRITING CASH FLOWS
| Year Ended December 31, | |||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | |||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||
Premiums collected, net | $ | 1,536 | $ | 1,252 | $ | 979 | ||||
Loss and loss adjustment expenses paid | (952 | ) | (1,013 | ) | (905 | ) | ||||
Policy acquisition expenses paid | (398 | ) | (411 | ) | (298 | ) | ||||
Other underwriting expenses paid | (124 | ) | (42 | ) | 58 | |||||
Cash provided by (used by) underwriting | $ | 62 | $ | (214 | ) | $ | (166 | ) | ||
See notes to combined statements.
F-15
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC.
REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR)
NOTES TO COMBINED STATEMENTS
1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
Basis of Presentation
The accompanying combined statements pertain to the Reinsurance underwriting segment of The St. Paul Companies, Inc. ("St. Paul"), for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999. The Reinsurance underwriting segment of St. Paul is the predecessor to Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and is hereinafter referred to as "Predecessor." Predecessor statements are presented on a combined basis, including certain insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries within the St. Paul group, as well as the underwriting results of the reinsurance departments of St. Paul Fire and Marine Insurance Company ("Fire and Marine") and United States Fidelity and Guarantee Company ("USF&G"), St. Paul's two largest U.S. insurance subsidiaries.
The statements of underwriting results reconcile to the Reinsurance underwriting segment results as reported in St. Paul's audited consolidated financial statements for each year in the three-year period ended December 31, 2001, which are included in St. Paul's Annual Report to Shareholders. It is the practice of St. Paul to evaluate the performance of its property-liability insurance underwriting segments on the basis of underwriting results.
The statements of identifiable underwriting assets and liabilities represent those balances that are specifically attributable to the reinsurance underwriting operations of St. Paul. St. Paul manages its property-liability investment portfolio in the aggregate, as part of a separate segment and does not allocate assets, or investment income, to its respective underwriting segments. There is also no equity structure allocated to Predecessor. For these reasons, a complete Predecessor balance sheet is not maintained.
Similarly, the statement of identifiable underwriting cash flows includes only cash flow activity that is specifically attributable to the underwriting operations of Predecessor, and does not include any cash flows from investing and financing activities.
Accounting Principles
The accompanying combined statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America ("U.S. GAAP").
Predecessor's business is written by several of St. Paul's underwriting subsidiaries, which are required to file financial statements with state and foreign regulatory authorities. The accounting principles used to prepare these statutory financial statements follow prescribed or permitted accounting principles, which differ from U.S. GAAP. Prescribed statutory accounting practices include state laws, regulations and general administrative rules issued by the state of domicile as well as a variety of publications and manuals of the National Association of Insurance Commissioners ("NAIC"). Permitted statutory accounting practices encompass all accounting practices not so prescribed, but allowed by the state of domicile.
Elimination of One-Quarter Reporting Lag
In the first quarter of 2000, Predecessor eliminated the one-quarter reporting lag for its reinsurance operations based in the United Kingdom ("St. Paul Re U.K.") in order to report the results of those operations on a current basis. As a result, Predecessor's results for 2000 include St. Paul Re U.K.'s results for the fourth quarter of 1999 and all quarters of 2000. The incremental
F-16
impact of eliminating the reporting lag, which consists of St. Paul Re-U.K.'s results for the three months ended December 31, 2000, was as follows.
| Year Ended December 31, 2000 | |||
---|---|---|---|---|
| ($ in millions) | |||
Net premiums written | $ | 7 | ||
Net premiums earned | 51 | |||
Underwriting loss | (10 | ) |
Use of Estimates
These combined statements include estimates and assumptions that have an effect on the amounts reported. The most significant estimates are those relating to reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses. These estimates are continually reviewed and adjustments are made as necessary, but actual results could be significantly different than expected when estimates were made.
Net Premiums Earned
Assumed reinsurance premiums are recognized as revenues proportionately over the coverage period. Net premiums earned are recorded in the statement of underwriting results, net of our cost to purchase reinsurance. Net premiums not yet recognized as revenue are recorded in the balance sheet as unearned premiums, gross of any ceded unearned premiums. Written and earned premiums, and the related costs, which have not yet been reported to Predecessor are estimated and accrued. Due to the time lag inherent in reporting of premiums by cedents, such estimated premiums written and earned, as well as related costs, may be significant. Differences between such estimates and actual amounts are recorded in the period in which the actual amounts are determined.
Reinstatement and additional premiums will be accrued as provided for in the provisions of assumed reinsurance contracts and based on experience under such contracts. Reinstatement premiums are the premiums charged for the restoration of the reinsurance limit of a catastrophe contract to its full amount after payment by the reinsurer of losses as a result of an occurrence. These premiums relate to the future coverage obtained during the remainder of the initial policy term, and are earned over the remaining policy term. Additional premiums are premiums charged after coverage has expired, related to experience during the policy term, which are earned immediately. An allowance for uncollectible premiums will be established for possible non-payment of such amounts due, as deemed necessary.
Insurance Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
Losses represent the amounts paid, or expected to be paid, to ceding companies for events that have occurred. The costs of investigating, resolving and processing these claims are known as loss adjustment expenses ("LAE"). These items are recorded on the statement of underwriting
F-17
results net of ceded reinsurance, meaning that gross losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred are reduced by the amounts recovered or expected to be recovered under retrocessional contracts.
Reinsurance
Written premiums, earned premiums, and incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses reflect the net effects of assumed and ceded reinsurance transactions. Reinsurance accounting is followed for assumed and ceded transactions when risk transfer requirements have been met. These requirements involve significant assumptions being made related to the amount and timing of expected cash flows, as well as the interpretation of underlying contract terms. Assumed reinsurance contracts that do not transfer significant insurance risk are required to be accounted for as deposits. These contract deposits are accounted for as financing transactions, with interest expense credited to the contract deposit.
Insurance Reserves
The reserves for losses and LAE are estimated based on reports received from ceding companies, supplemented with analysis by the claims department and actuaries of Predecessor. These reserves include estimates of the total cost of claims that were reported, but not yet paid, and the cost of claims incurred but not yet reported ("IBNR"). Loss reserves are reduced for estimated amounts of salvage and subrogation recoveries. Estimated amounts recoverable from reinsurers on unpaid losses and LAE are reflected as assets.
For reported losses, reserves are established on a "case" basis within the parameters of coverage provided in the underlying insurance policy or reinsurance agreement. For IBNR losses, reserves are estimated using established actuarial methods. Case and IBNR reserve estimates consider such variables as past loss experience, changes in legislative conditions, changes in judicial interpretation of legal liability and policy coverages, and inflation.
Because many of the reinsurance coverages offered by Predecessor involve claims that may not ultimately be settled for many years after they are incurred, subjective judgments as to ultimate exposure to losses are an integral and necessary component of the loss reserving process. The inherent uncertainties of estimating loss reserves are further exacerbated for reinsurers by the significant amount of time that often elapses between the occurrence of an insured loss, the reporting of that loss to the primary insurer and, ultimately to the reinsurer, and the primary insurer's payment of that loss and subsequent indemnification by the reinsurer. Reserves are recorded by considering a range of estimates bounded by a high and low point. Within that range, management's best estimate is recorded. Reserves are continually reviewed, using a variety of statistical and actuarial techniques to analyze current claim costs, frequency and severity data, and prevailing economic, social and legal factors. Reserves established in prior years are adjusted as loss experience develops and new information becomes available. Adjustments to previously estimated reserves are reflected in financial results in the periods in which they are made.
While we believe the carried reserves make a reasonable provision for unpaid loss and LAE obligations, it should be noted that the process of estimating required reserves does, by its very nature, involve uncertainty. The level of uncertainty can be influenced by factors such as the
F-18
existence of long tail coverage (when loss payments may not occur for several years) and changes in claim handling practices, as well as the factors noted above, and actual claim payments and LAE could be significantly different from the estimates.
Liabilities for unpaid losses and LAE related to certain assumed reinsurance contracts are discounted to the present value of estimated future payments. Prior to discounting, these liabilities totaled $306.4 million, $198.7 million, and $72.7 million at December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999 respectively. The total discounted liability reflected on our combined statements of identifiable underwriting assets and liabilities was $264.9 million, $146.7 million and $47.6 million at December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively. The liabilities related to these reinsurance contracts were discounted using rates up to 7.5%, based on our return on invested assets or, in many cases, on yields contractually guaranteed to us on funds held by the ceding company, as permitted by the Vermont Department of Banking, Insurance, Securities and Healthcare Administration.
Policy Acquisition Expenses
The costs directly related to the acquisition of reinsurance contracts are referred to as policy acquisition expenses and consist of commissions and other direct underwriting expenses. Although these expenses are incurred when a reinsurance contract is written, such expenses are deferred and amortized over the same period as the corresponding premiums are recorded as earned revenues.
On a regular basis, an analysis of the recoverability of the deferred policy acquisition expenses, in relation to the expected recognition of revenues, including anticipated investment income is performed. Any adjustments are reflected as period costs. Should the analysis indicate that the acquisition costs are unrecoverable, further analyses are completed to determine if a reserve is required to provide for losses that may exceed the related unearned premiums.
Foreign Currency Translation
Functional currencies are assigned to foreign operations, which are generally the currencies of the local operating environment. Foreign currency amounts are remeasured to the functional currency, and the resulting foreign exchange gains or losses are reflected in income, outside of underwriting results. Functional currency amounts are then translated into U.S. dollars. The unrealized gain or loss from this translation is recorded in St. Paul's equity. Both the remeasurement and translation are calculated using current exchange rates for the balance sheet amounts and average exchange rates for revenues and expenses.
2. Related Party Transactions
The following summarizes Predecessor's related party transactions:
Reinsurance Transactions with Affiliates
Predecessor cedes certain business to two affiliated special purpose entities ("SPE") which were established by St. Paul for the purpose of increasing Predecessor's capacity to write certain
F-19
excess-of-loss reinsurance, principally property, marine, and aviation. The most significant of these agreements is with George Town Re. George Town Re was established by St. Paul in 1996 for the purpose of entering into a single reinsurance treaty with Predecessor, providing an additional $45.1 million of underwriting capacity over a 10-year period. Premiums ceded under these agreements were $5.2 million in 2001, $4.3 million in 2000, and $11.1 million in 1999. Losses ceded under these agreements totaled $9.8 million in 2001, $5.4 million in 2000, and $12.4 million in 1999.
Predecessor assumes certain primary business from other business segments of St. Paul. Premiums assumed under these agreements were $25.8 million in 2001, $6.2 million in 2000, and $7.6 million in 1999. Losses assumed under these agreements were $18.6 million in 2001, $7.7 million in 2000, and $1.6 million in 1999. Predecessor paid commissions of $9.5 million in 2001, $2.3 million in 2000, and $2.7 million in 1999, related to business assumed under these agreements.
Management Agreements with Affiliates
St. Paul management has entered into various agreements with affiliated parties, under arm's length terms. Under these agreements, the affiliated parties have agreed to perform investment management services for St. Paul Re-U.K., guarantee the performance of St. Paul obligations, make funds available under a revolving loan agreement, and provide certain reinsurance coverage. Included in underwriting expenses are certain expenses allocated to Predecessor from St. Paul, including costs such as corporate communications and marketing, corporate finance, corporate actuarial, corporate tax, corporate audit, legal services, corporate executives, corporate human resources, and employee benefit costs. These allocated costs totaled $3.2 million, $6.3 million and $1.8 million in 2001, 2000, and 1999, respectively.
Other Transactions with Affiliates
Mountain Ridge Insurance Company ("Mountain Ridge"), one of the insurance legal entities included in Predecessor, holds notes receivable from St. Paul. Amounts due under these notes receivable totaled $59 million, $37 million and $17 million as of December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively. Principal and all accrued interest on these notes are payable on demand. These demand notes are reflected as an asset and as additional paid-in capital, as permitted by the State of Vermont Department of Banking, Insurance, Securities and Healthcare Administration.
3. September 11, 2001 Terrorist Attack
On September 11, 2001, terrorists hijacked four commercial passenger jets in the United States. Two of the jets were flown into the World Trade Center towers in New York, NY, causing their collapse. The third jet was flown into the Pentagon building in Washington, DC, causing severe damage, and the fourth jet crashed in rural Pennsylvania. This terrorist attack caused significant loss of life and resulted in unprecedented losses for the property-casualty insurance industry.
Estimated gross losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred as a result of the terrorist attack totaled $931 million. The estimated net underwriting loss of $556 million from that event included an estimated benefit of $143 million from cessions made under various reinsurance agreements, a net
F-20
$141 million benefit from additional and reinstatement premiums, and a $91 million reduction in contingent commission expenses.
The estimated losses were based on a variety of actuarial techniques, coverage interpretation and claims estimation methodologies, and included an estimate of losses incurred but not reported, as well as estimated costs related to the settlement of claims. The estimate of losses is also based on the belief that property and casualty insurance losses from the terrorist attack will total between $30 billion and $35 billion for the insurance industry. This estimate of industry losses is subject to significant uncertainties and may change over time as additional information becomes available. A material increase in the estimate of industry losses would likely cause a corresponding material increase to Predecessor's provision for losses related to the attack.
The estimated underwriting loss of $556 million is recorded in the accompanying 2001 combined statement of underwriting results in the following line items:
| ($ in millions) | ||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|
Net premiums earned | $ | 141 | |||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | (788 | ) | |||
Other underwriting expenses | 91 | ||||
Total underwriting loss | $ | (556 | ) | ||
The estimated underwriting loss of $556 million was distributed among Predecessor's segments as follows:
| ($ in millions) | |||
---|---|---|---|---|
North American Property | $ | 233 | ||
North American Casualty | 32 | |||
International | 162 | |||
Finite Risk | 129 | |||
Total underwriting loss | $ | 556 | ||
F-21
4. Reserves for Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
Reconciliation of Loss Reserves
The following table represents a reconciliation of beginning and ending loss and loss adjustment expense ("LAE") reserves for each of the last three years.
| Year Ended December 31, | |||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | |||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||||
Loss and LAE reserves at beginning of year, as reported | $ | 3,568 | $ | 3,451 | $ | 3,477 | ||||||
Less reinsurance recoverables on unpaid losses at beginning of year | (902 | ) | (596 | ) | (251 | ) | ||||||
Net loss and LAE reserves at beginning of year | 2,666 | 2,855 | 3,226 | |||||||||
Provision for losses and LAE for claims incurred: | ||||||||||||
Current year | 1,827 | 936 | 668 | |||||||||
Prior years | 95 | (125 | ) | (168 | ) | |||||||
Total incurred | 1,922 | 811 | 500 | |||||||||
Losses and LAE payment for claims incurred: | ||||||||||||
Current year | (232 | ) | (220 | ) | (175 | ) | ||||||
Prior years | (663 | ) | (780 | ) | (696 | ) | ||||||
Total paid | (895 | ) | (1,000 | ) | (871 | ) | ||||||
Net loss and LAE reserves at end of year | 3,693 | 2,666 | 2,855 | |||||||||
Plus reinsurance recoverables on unpaid Losses at end of year | 1,256 | 902 | 596 | |||||||||
Loss and LAE reserves at end of year, as reported | $ | 4,949 | $ | 3,568 | $ | 3,451 | ||||||
In 2001, prior year development was attributable to several lines of business. The North American Property segment continued to have worse than expected loss emergence, largely driven by certain property business underwritten through Predecessor's London office. Also included in this emergence was an increase in the reserve position of the surplus lines business which exhibited poor loss development in the 1999 and 2000 accident years.
A reduction in prior year losses was recorded for both 2000 and 1999. In both years, favorable prior year loss development was primarily attributable to better than expected loss emergence on the Casualty Excess book of business. As older underwriting years are maturing, they continue to display favorable emergence and current indications are significantly better than the initial ultimate loss estimates.
Environmental and Asbestos Reserves
Predecessor continues to have exposure, through its reinsurance of primary insurance contracts written many years ago, to claims alleging injury or damage from environmental pollution or seeking payment for the cost to clean up polluted sights. In addition, Predecessor has received asbestos injury claims tendered under general casualty policies that it reinsures.
F-22
The following table summarizes Predecessor's combined environmental and asbestos reserves balance at December 31, 2001 and 2000. Amounts in the "net" column are reduced by retrocessions.
| December 31, | |||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2001 | 2000 | ||||||||||
| Gross | Net | Gross | Net | ||||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||||
Environmental | $ | 18 | $ | 8 | $ | 25 | $ | 11 | ||||
Asbestos | 13 | 4 | 17 | 5 | ||||||||
Total environmental and asbestos reserves | $ | 31 | $ | 12 | $ | 42 | $ | 16 | ||||
5. Employee Benefit Plans
Employees of Predecessor participate in various employee benefit, stock incentive, and retirement plans administered by St. Paul. Predecessor reimburses St. Paul for costs associated with these plans. The following summarizes underwriting expenses recorded by Predecessor in connection with each of these plans.
| Year Ended December 31, | |||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | |||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||
Retirement Plans | $ | 6.2 | $ | 3.8 | $ | 1.8 | ||||
Post Retirement Plans | 0.3 | 0.3 | 0.3 | |||||||
Variable Stock Option Plan | 0.1 | 0.6 | 0.8 | |||||||
Total | $ | 6.6 | $ | 4.7 | $ | 2.9 | ||||
In addition, St. Paul sponsors a stock based incentive program, the Long-Term Incentive Plan ("LTIP"), which is exclusive to certain employees of Predecessor. Underwriting expenses (benefits) recorded by Predecessor in connection with the LTIP totaled ($2.3) million in 2001, ($4.0) million in 2000, and $2.0 million in 1999.
6. Commitments and Contingencies
Financial Guarantees
We are contingently liable for a financial guarantee in the form of a credit enhancement, with total exposure of approximately $15 million as of December 31, 2001.
Lease Commitments
A portion of Predecessor's business activities is conducted in rented premises. Predecessor also enters into leases for equipment, such as office machines and computers. Total rental expense was $5.8 million in 2001, $9.3 million in 2000 and $9.2 million in 1999.
F-23
Certain leases are non-cancelable, and Predecessor would remain responsible for payment even if the space or equipment was no longer utilized. On December 31, 2001, the minimum rents for which Predecessor would be liable under these types of leases are as follows: $6.9 million in 2002, $3.4 million in 2003, $1.7 million in 2004, $.8 million in 2005, $.8 million in 2006, and $2.8 million thereafter.
Legal Matters
In the ordinary course of conducting business, we have been named as defendants in various lawsuits. Some of these lawsuits attempt to establish liability under reinsurance contracts issued by our underwriting operations. Plaintiffs in these lawsuits are asking for money damages or to have the court direct the activities of our operations in certain ways. It is possible that the settlement of these lawsuits may be material to our results of operations and liquidity in the period in which they occur. However, we believe the total amounts that we, and our subsidiaries, will ultimately have to pay in these matters will have no material effect on our overall financial position.
7. Fourth Quarter 2001 Strategic Review
In December 2001, St. Paul announced the results of a strategic review of all of its operations, which included a decision to exit a number of businesses and countries. These decisions included the narrowing of product offerings and geographic presence relative to Predecessor's businesses. As part of that review, it was determined that Predecessor would no longer underwrite aviation or bond and credit reinsurance, or offer certain financial risk and capital markets reinsurance products. Predecessor would also substantially reduce the North American business underwritten in London. Predecessor would focus on several areas, including property catastrophe reinsurance, excess-of-loss casualty reinsurance, marine and traditional finite reinsurance.
The following table presents the net premiums earned and underwriting results for 2001, 2000 and 1999 for the businesses to be exited under these actions, including the allocation of St. Paul's corporate excess-of-loss reinsurance programs.
| Year Ended December 31, | |||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | |||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||
Net premiums earned | $ | 362 | $ | 307 | $ | 116 | ||||
Underwriting results | (303 | ) | (84 | ) | (153 | ) |
8. Reinsurance
The primary purpose of Predecessor's ceded reinsurance program, including the aggregate excess-of-loss coverages discussed below, is to protect its operations from potential losses in excess of acceptable levels. Reinsurers are expected to honor their obligations under ceded reinsurance contracts. In the event these companies are unable to honor their obligations, Predecessor will pay these amounts. Allowances have been established for possible nonpayment of such amounts due.
F-24
The largest concentrations of total reinsurance recoverables and ceded unearned premiums at December 31, 2001 were with Underwriters Re-Bermuda ("Underwriters Re") and with General Reinsurance Corporation ("Gen Re"). Gen Re, accounting for approximately 11.6% of Predecessor's recoverables, is rated "A++" by A.M. Best, "Aaa" by Moody's and "AAA" by Standard and Poor's for its financial strength. Although Underwriters Re (accounting for approximately 20.4% of Predecessor's recoverables) is not rated by the major rating agencies, these recoverables are fully collateralized with funds held and letters of credit.
Predecessor's underwriting results in 2001, 2000 and 1999 were impacted by the St. Paul corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance program that were entered into effective January 1 of each year (hereinafter referred to as the "St. Paul corporate program"). Coverage under the St. Paul corporate program treaties was triggered when St. Paul's incurred insurance losses and LAE across all lines of business exceeded accident year attachment loss ratios specified in the treaty. Predecessor results also benefited from a separate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance treaty, exclusive to Predecessor in each year that were unrelated to the St. Paul corporate program. The combined impact of these treaties (together the "reinsurance treaties") is included in the table that follows.
| Year Ended December 31, | |||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | |||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||
St. Paul Corporate Aggregate Excess-of-Loss Reinsurance Program | ||||||||||
Ceded premiums written | $ | (67 | ) | $ | 80 | $ | 89 | |||
Ceded losses and loss adjustment expenses | (126 | ) | 140 | 164 | ||||||
Ceded premiums earned | (67 | ) | 80 | 89 | ||||||
Net underwriting benefit (detriment) | $ | (59 | ) | $ | 60 | $ | 75 | |||
Predecessor Aggregate Treaty | ||||||||||
Ceded premiums written | $ | 119 | $ | 55 | $ | 62 | ||||
Ceded losses and loss adjustment expenses | 278 | 122 | 150 | |||||||
Ceded premiums earned | 119 | 55 | 62 | |||||||
Net underwriting benefit | $ | 159 | $ | 67 | $ | 88 | ||||
Combined total: | ||||||||||
Ceded premiums written | $ | 52 | $ | 135 | $ | 151 | ||||
Ceded losses and loss adjustment expenses | 152 | 262 | 314 | |||||||
Ceded premiums earned | 52 | 135 | 151 | |||||||
Net underwriting benefit | $ | 100 | $ | 127 | $ | 163 | ||||
The impact of the 2000 and 1999 St. Paul corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance program treaties was allocated to Predecessor, based on its incurred losses and LAE, relative to both the incurred losses and LAE of St. Paul's other underwriting segments, and the loss ratio attachment point as prescribed in the contracts. The 2001 amounts shown above include the
F-25
impact of a reallocation of premiums and losses ceded in 2000 and 1999. This reallocation was necessary to reflect the impact of differences between St. Paul's actual 2001 experience on losses ceded to the corporate program in 2000 and 1999, by segment, and the anticipated experience on those losses in 2000 and 1999 when the initial segment allocation was made.
During 2001, St. Paul did not cede losses to its corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance program. Ceded written and earned premiums in 2001 included $2 million representing the allocation to Predecessor of the initial deposit premiums under the 2001 corporate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance program treaty.
The effect of assumed and ceded reinsurance on premiums written, premiums earned and insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses is as follows (including the impact of the reinsurance treaties):
| Year Ended December 31 | |||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | |||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||
Premiums Written | ||||||||||
Assumed | $ | 1,854 | $ | 1,327 | $ | 1,231 | ||||
Ceded | 177 | 254 | 318 | |||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 1,677 | $ | 1,073 | $ | 913 | ||||
Premiums Earned | ||||||||||
Assumed | $ | 1,765 | $ | 1,381 | $ | 1,192 | ||||
Ceded | 172 | 260 | 314 | |||||||
Total premiums earned | $ | 1,593 | $ | 1,121 | $ | 878 | ||||
Insurance Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses | ||||||||||
Assumed | $ | 2,318 | $ | 1,197 | $ | 877 | ||||
Ceded | 396 | 386 | 377 | |||||||
Total insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses | $ | 1,922 | $ | 811 | $ | 500 | ||||
9. Segment Information
Predecessor has four reportable segments, which consist of North American Property, North American Casualty, International, and Finite Risk. These segments are consistent with the manner in which Predecessor's business has been managed.
The North American Property segment consists of property reinsurance business underwritten for customers domiciled in the United States and Canada. Coverages offered included proportional, per-risk, excess-of-loss and surplus lines reinsurance, and catastrophe treaties. This segment also includes retrocessional reinsurance business and crop and agricultural reinsurance. The North American surplus lines business center has been aggregated with the North American Property segment as the aggregation is consistent with Predecessor's management structure and the business center meets the aggregation criteria required for external segment reporting.
F-26
The North American Casualty segment consists of casualty reinsurance underwritten for customers domiciled in the United States and Canada. Casualty coverages offered include general workers' compensation, medical professional, non-medical professional, directors and officers, employment practices, umbrella and environmental impairment. The Accident and Health business center, which consists predominantly of North American Risks, is aggregated with the North American Casualty segment as the aggregation is consistent with Predecessor's management structure and the business center meets the aggregation criteria required for external reporting. In addition, Predecessor has one significant account which includes both property and casualty business, but is managed as a business center within the North American Casualty segment. For this reason, this business center, which meets the aggregation criteria for external segment reporting, has been aggregated with the North American Casualty segment.
The International segment underwrites property and casualty reinsurance for customers domiciled outside of North America. This segment also includes the results from marine and aerospace business due to the global nature of those exposures.
The Finite Risk segment underwrites non-traditional reinsurance treaties for leading insurance companies worldwide. Non-traditional reinsurance combines limited traditional underwriting risk with financial risk protection and is generally utilized by large commercial customers who are willing to share in a portion of their insurance losses. Due to Predecessor's management structure, the Bond and Credit business center has been aggregated with the Finite Risk segment. This business center meets the aggregation criteria required for external segment reporting.
Predecessor monitors and evaluates the performance of its segments based principally on their underwriting results. Assets are not specifically identifiable for these segments. The accounting policies of the segments are the same as those described in the summary of significant accounting policies.
Geographic Areas
The following summary presents financial data of Predecessor's operations based on their location.
| Year Ended December 31, | |||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | |||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||||
Net Premiums Earned | ||||||||||
U.S. | $ | 1,097 | $ | 810 | $ | 656 | ||||
Non-U.S. | 496 | 311 | 222 | |||||||
Total net premiums earned | $ | 1,593 | $ | 1,121 | $ | 878 | ||||
F-27
Segment Information
The summary below presents net premiums earned and underwriting results for Predecessor's reportable segments.
| Year Ended December 31, | ||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2001 | 2000 | 1999 | ||||||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||||||
Net Premiums Earned | |||||||||||
North American Property | $ | 216 | $ | 204 | $ | 196 | |||||
North American Casualty | 588 | 319 | 245 | ||||||||
International | 242 | 188 | 160 | ||||||||
Finite Risk | 547 | 410 | 277 | ||||||||
Total net premiums earned | $ | 1,593 | $ | 1,121 | $ | 878 | |||||
Underwriting Gain/(Loss) | |||||||||||
North American Property | $ | (232 | ) | $ | (1 | ) | $ | (28 | ) | ||
North American Casualty | (215 | ) | (76 | ) | 75 | ||||||
International | (109 | ) | (10 | ) | (21 | ) | |||||
Finite Risk | (170 | ) | (27 | ) | 50 | ||||||
Total underwriting gain/(loss) | $ | (726 | ) | $ | (114 | ) | $ | 76 | |||
Each of Predecessor's segments generates a significant volume of reinsurance premiums through two reinsurance brokers. Total premiums written through these two brokers totaled $587 million, $518 million, and $512 million for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively.
10. Quarterly Results of Operations (Unaudited)
The following is an unaudited summary of Predecessor's quarterly results for the last two years.
| First Quarter | Second Quarter | Third Quarter | Fourth Quarter | |||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| ($ in millions) | ||||||||||||
2001 | |||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 421 | $ | 280 | $ | 584 | $ | 392 | |||||
Net premiums earned | 303 | 297 | 533 | 460 | |||||||||
Underwriting loss | (22 | ) | (35 | ) | (512 | ) | (157 | ) |
| First Quarter | Second Quarter | Third Quarter | Fourth Quarter | |||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| ($ in millions) | ||||||||||||
2000 | |||||||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 384 | $ | 192 | $ | 248 | $ | 249 | |||||
Net premiums earned | 311 | 219 | 262 | 329 | |||||||||
Underwriting loss | (71 | ) | (30 | ) | (13 | ) | (0 | ) |
The fourth quarter of 2001 included the impact of a $56 million increase in Predecessor's estimate of losses incurred as a result of the September 11, 2001 terrorist attack.
F-28
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC.
REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR)
COMBINED STATEMENTS OF UNDERWRITING RESULTS
(Unaudited)
| Three Months Ended March 31 | |||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | ||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||
Net premiums earned | ||||||||
Net premiums written | $ | 463 | $ | 421 | ||||
Change in unearned premiums | (86 | ) | (119 | ) | ||||
Net premiums earned | 377 | 302 | ||||||
Underwriting deductions | ||||||||
Losses and loss adjustment expenses | 247 | 205 | ||||||
Policy acquisition expenses | 100 | 97 | ||||||
Other underwriting expenses | 15 | 21 | ||||||
Total underwriting deductions | 362 | 323 | ||||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | $ | 15 | $ | (21 | ) | |||
See notes to combined statements.
F-29
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC.
REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR)
COMBINED STATEMENTS OF IDENTIFIABLE ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
(Unaudited)
| As of March 31 | ||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | |||||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||||
Identifiable assets | |||||||||
Reinsurance recoverables: | |||||||||
Unpaid losses | $ | 1,227 | $ | 932 | |||||
Paid losses | 48 | 75 | |||||||
Premium Receivable | 807 | 624 | |||||||
Reserve for uncollectible premiums receivable | (13 | ) | (11 | ) | |||||
Funds held by reinsureds | 529 | 423 | |||||||
Deferred policy acquisition costs | 116 | 108 | |||||||
Ceded unearned premiums | 35 | 28 | |||||||
Total identifiable assets | $ | 2,749 | $ | 2,179 | |||||
Identifiable liabilities | |||||||||
Loss and loss adjustment expense reserves | $ | 4,892 | $ | 3,606 | |||||
Assumed paid losses payable | 89 | 67 | |||||||
Unearned premium reserves | 496 | 441 | |||||||
Reinsurance premiums payable | 313 | 307 | |||||||
Underwriting expenses payable | 168 | 262 | |||||||
Funds held under reinsurance treaties | 153 | 55 | |||||||
Profit commission reserves | 118 | 203 | |||||||
Financial reinsurance liability | 97 | 41 | |||||||
Total identifiable liabilities | $ | 6,326 | $ | 4,982 | |||||
See notes to combined statements.
F-30
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC.
REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR)
COMBINED STATEMENTS OF IDENTIFIABLE CASH FLOWS
(Unaudited)
| Three Months Ended March 31, | ||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | |||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||
Premiums collected, net | $ | 470 | $ | 369 | |||
Loss and loss adjustment expenses paid | (284 | ) | (231 | ) | |||
Policy acquisition expenses paid | (104 | ) | (111 | ) | |||
Other underwriting expenses paid | (35 | ) | (40 | ) | |||
Cash provided by (used by) underwriting | $ | 47 | $ | (13 | ) | ||
See notes to combined statements.
F-31
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC.
REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR)
NOTES TO COMBINED STATEMENTS
(Unaudited)
1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
Basis of Presentation
The accompanying combined financial statements pertain to the Reinsurance underwriting segment of The St. Paul Companies, Inc. ("St. Paul"), for the three months ended March 31, 2002 and 2001. The Reinsurance underwriting segment of St. Paul is the predecessor to Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and is hereinafter referred to as "Predecessor". Predecessor financial statements are presented on a combined basis, including certain insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries within the St. Paul group, as well as the underwriting results of the reinsurance departments of St. Paul Fire and Marine Insurance Company ("Fire and Marine") and United States Fidelity and Guarantee Company ("USF&G"), St. Paul's two largest U.S. insurance subsidiaries.
The statements of underwriting results reconcile to the Reinsurance underwriting segment results as reported in St. Paul's March 31, 2002 Form 10-Q as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission. It is the practice of St. Paul to evaluate the performance of its property-liability insurance underwriting segments on the basis of underwriting results.
The statements of identifiable assets and liabilities represent those balances that are specifically attributable to the underwriting operations of Predecessor. St. Paul manages its property-liability investment portfolio in the aggregate, as part of a separate segment and does not allocate assets, or investment income, to its respective underwriting segments. There is also no equity structure allocated to Predecessor. For these reasons, a complete Predecessor balance sheet is not maintained.
Similarly, the statement of identifiable cash flows includes only cash flow activity that is specifically attributable to the underwriting operations of Predecessor, and does not include any cash flows from investment and financing activities.
Reference should be made to the Notes to Combined Statements on pages F-16 to F-28 of this document. The amounts in those notes have not changed materially except as in the ordinary course of business or as otherwise disclosed in these notes.
2. Reinsurance
The primary purpose of Predecessor's ceded reinsurance program is to protect its operations from potential losses in excess of acceptable levels. Reinsurers are expected to honor their obligations under ceded reinsurance contracts. In the event these companies are unable to honor their obligations, Predecessor will pay these amounts. Allowances have been established for possible nonpayment of such amounts due.
In the first quarter of 2002, St. Paul was not party to an all-lines, corporate excess-of-loss reinsurance treaty. In the three preceding years, cessions made under such treaties had a significant impact on Predecessor's reported financial results. In 2001, St. Paul was party to such an agreement that incepted on January 1 of that year. Coverage under that treaty was not triggered in the first quarter of 2001. However, Predecessor recorded ceded written premiums of $2 million and ceded earned premiums of $1 million in that quarter, representing Predecessor's share of the initial premium paid for this treaty.
F-32
Predecessor was party to a separate aggregate excess-of-loss reinsurance treaty, unrelated to the corporate treaty, in both 2002 and 2001. Coverage was not triggered under that treaty in the first quarter of 2002; however, Predecessor did record ceded written and earned premiums of $4 million, representing the initial premium for this treaty. In the first quarter of 2001, Predecessor ceded $7 million of written and $6 million of earned premiums and $25 million of losses and loss adjustment expenses, for a net benefit of $19 million as a result of this treaty.
The effect of assumed and ceded reinsurance on premiums written, premiums earned and insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses was as follows:
| Three Months Ended March 31 | ||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | |||||
| ($ in millions) | ||||||
Premiums Written | |||||||
Assumed | $ | 493 | $ | 457 | |||
Ceded | 30 | 36 | |||||
Net premiums written | $ | 463 | $ | 421 | |||
Premiums Earned | |||||||
Assumed | $ | 396 | $ | 330 | |||
Ceded | 19 | 28 | |||||
Total premiums earned | $ | 377 | $ | 302 | |||
Insurance Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses | |||||||
Assumed | $ | 246 | $ | 256 | |||
Ceded | (1 | ) | 51 | ||||
Total net insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses | $ | 247 | $ | 205 | |||
3. Segment Information
Predecessor has four reportable segments: North American Property, North American Casualty, International, and Finite Reinsurance. These segments are consistent with the manner in which Predecessor's business has been managed.
Predecessor monitors and evaluates the performance of its segments based principally on their underwriting results. Assets are not specifically identifiable for these segments.
F-33
The summary below presents premiums earned and underwriting results for Predecessor's reportable segments.
| Three Months Ended March 31 | |||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 2002 | 2001 | ||||||
| ($ in millions) | |||||||
Premiums earned | ||||||||
North American Property | $ | 64 | $ | 44 | ||||
North American Casualty | 168 | 130 | ||||||
International | 57 | 48 | ||||||
Finite Reinsurance | 88 | 80 | ||||||
Total premiums earned | $ | 377 | $ | 302 | ||||
Underwriting gain (loss) | ||||||||
North American Property | $ | 25 | $ | 16 | ||||
North American Casualty | (28 | ) | (59 | ) | ||||
International | 28 | 30 | ||||||
Finite Reinsurance | (10 | ) | (8 | ) | ||||
Total underwriting gain/(loss) | $ | 15 | $ | (21 | ) | |||
F-34
No dealer, salesperson or other person is authorized to give any information or to represent anything not contained in this prospectus. You must not rely on any unauthorized information or representations. This prospectus is an offer to sell only the shares offered hereby, but only under circumstances and in jurisdictions where it is lawful to do so. The information contained in this prospectus is current only as of its date.
| Page | |
---|---|---|
Prospectus Summary | 1 | |
Risk Factors | 15 | |
Dilution | 33 | |
Use of Proceeds | 34 | |
Dividend Policy | 34 | |
Capitalization | 35 | |
Pro Forma Financial Information | 36 | |
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Pro Forma Financial Condition and Underwriting Results | 41 | |
Business | 66 | |
Management | 99 | |
St. Paul Investment and Principal Shareholders | 108 | |
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions | 110 | |
Description of our Common Shares | 121 | |
Shares Eligible for Future Sale | 127 | |
Certain Tax Considerations | 127 | |
Underwriting | 139 | |
Validity of Common Shares | 141 | |
Experts | 141 | |
Available Information | 143 | |
Enforceability of Civil Liabilities Under United States Federal Securities Laws and Other Matters | 143 | |
The Predecessor Business | 144 | |
Index to Consolidated Financial Statements and Financial Information | F-1 |
Through and including , 2002 (the 25th day after the date of this prospectus), all dealers effecting transactions in these securities, whether or not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This is in addition to a dealer's obligation to deliver a prospectus when acting as an underwriter and with respect to an unsold allotment or subscription.
40,000,000 Shares
Platinum Underwriters
Holdings, Ltd.
Common Shares
PROSPECTUS
Goldman, Sachs & Co.
Merrill Lynch & Co.
Salomon Smith Barney
Banc of America Securities LLC
Credit Suisse First Boston
JPMorgan
Representatives of the Underwriters
PART II
INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
Item 13. Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution
The following table sets forth expenses and costs payable by Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. (the "Company") expected to be incurred in connection with the issuance and distribution of the securities described in this Registration Statement. All amounts are estimated except for the Securities and Exchange Commisson's registration fee and the National Associates of Securities Dealers Inc.'s filing fee.
| Amount to be paid | ||
---|---|---|---|
Securities and Exchange Commission registration fee | $ | 114,264 | |
NASD filing fee | 30,500 | ||
Legal fees and expenses | * | ||
Fees and expenses of qualification under state securities laws (including legal fees) | * | ||
NYSE listing fees and expenses | 250,000 | ||
Accounting fees and expenses | * | ||
Printing and engraving fees | * | ||
Registrar and transfer agent's fees | * | ||
Miscellaneous | 10,000 | ||
Total | $ | * |
- *
- To be filed by amendment.
Item 14. Indemnification of Directors and Officers
Section 98 of the Companies Act 1981 provides generally that a Bermuda company may indemnify its directors, officers and auditors against any liability which by virtue of Bermuda law otherwise would be imposed on them, except in cases where such liability arises from the willful negligence, willful default, fraud or dishonesty of which such director, officer or auditor may be guilty in relation to the company. Section 98 further provides that a Bermuda company may indemnify its directors, officers and auditors against any liability incurred by them in defending any proceeding, whether civil or criminal, in which judgment is awarded in their favor or in which they are acquitted if granted relief by the Supreme Court of Bermuda in certain proceedings arising under Section 281 of the Companies Act.
The Company has adopted provisions in its bye-laws that provide that the Company shall indemnify its officers and directors to the maximum extent permitted under the Companies Act.
In addition, the Underwriting Agreement filed as Exhibit 1.1 to the Registration Statement provides for indemnification of the Company, its officers and its directors by the Underwriters under certain circumstances.
Item 15. Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities
The Company was incorporated in April 19, 2002 under the laws of Bermuda. The Company expects to enter into a Formation and Separation Agreement pursuant to which, among other things, the Company will sell between and 13,262,300 Common Shares in a private placement to The St. Paul Companies, Inc. (the number of shares being subject to adjustment as provided therein), contingent upon completion of the offering registered by this Registration Statement. The St. Paul Companies, Inc. is the sole purchaser in the private placement and is a
II-1
"qualified institutional buyer" as such term is defined in Rule 144A under the Securities Act of 1933. Accordingly, the private placement will be made in reliance upon the exemptions from registration provided in such circumstance by the no-action letters regarding Black Box Incorporated (publicly available June 26, 1990) and Squadron, Ellenoff, Pleasant & Lehrer (publicly available February 28, 1992). The Formation and Separation Agreement is filed as Exhibit 1.2 to this Registration Statement.
Item 16. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules
(a) Exhibits
1 | Form of Underwriting Agreement.* | |
2 | Form of Formation and Separation Agreement. | |
3.1 | Memorandum of Association of Platinum Holdings. | |
3.2 | Form of Restated Bye-Laws of Platinum Holdings. | |
4.1 | Form of Certificate of the Common Shares, par value $0.01 per share, of Platinum Holdings.* | |
5.1 | Opinion of Conyers, Dill & Pearman. | |
8.1 | Opinion of Sullivan & Cromwell as to certain tax matters.** | |
8.2 | Form of Opinion of Conyers, Dill & Pearman as to certain tax matters.** | |
8.3 | Form of Opinion of Slaughter and May as to certain tax matters. | |
8.4 | Form of Opinion of A. & L. Goodbody as to certain tax matters.** | |
10.1 | Employment Agreement between Jerome T. Fadden and The St. Paul Companies, Inc.** | |
10.2 | Letter Agreement between Steven H. Newman and The St. Paul Companies, Inc.** | |
10.3 | Letter Agreement between Steven H. Newman and The St. Paul Companies, Inc.** | |
10.4 | Employment Agreement between Michael D. Price and St. Paul Re.** | |
10.5 | Form of Employee Benefits and Compensation Matters Agreement. | |
10.6 | Form of Master Services Agreement. | |
10.7 | Form of U.K. Transitional Services Agreement.* | |
10.8 | Form of Runoff Services Agreement. | |
10.9 | Form of U.K. Runoff Services Agreement.* | |
10.10 | Form of Transitional Trademark License Agreement. | |
10.11 | Form of Registration Rights Agreement. | |
10.12 | Form of Underwriting Management Agreement. | |
10.13 | Form of U.K. Underwriting Agency and Underwriting Management Agreement.* | |
10.14 | Form of Assignment and Assumption Agreement. | |
10.15 | Form of Sub Lease Agreement. | |
10.16 | Form of Option Agreement. | |
10.17 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Traditional). | |
10.18 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - D-1). | |
10.19 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - A). | |
10.20 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - B-1). | |
10.21 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - B-2) | |
10.22 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - C). | |
10.23 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - D-2). | |
10.24 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - D Stop Loss). | |
10.25 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - D Spread Loss). | |
10.26 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - D-3). | |
10.27 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - D-4). | |
10.28 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - E). | |
10.29 | Form of U.K. Business Transfer Agreement.* | |
21 | Subsidiaries of Platinum Holdings.** | |
23.1 | Consent of KPMG LLP. | |
23.2 | Consent of Conyers, Dill & Pearman (included in Exhibit 5.1). | |
23.3 | Consent of Sullivan & Cromwell (included in Exhibit 8.1).** |
II-2
23.4 | Consent of Conyers, Dill & Pearman (included in Exhibit 8.2).** | |
23.5 | Consent of Slaughter and May (included in Exhibit 8.3). | |
23.6 | Consent of A. & L. Goodbody (included in Exhibit 8.4).** | |
24 | Power of Attorney.** | |
99.1 | Consent of Jay S. Fishman.** | |
99.2 | Consent of Steven H. Newman.** | |
99.3 | Consent of H. Furlong Baldwin.** | |
99.4 | Consent of Peter T. Pruitt.** | |
99.5 | Consent of Jonathan F. Bank.** | |
99.6 | Consent of Dan R. Carmichael. |
- *
- To be filed by amendment.
- **
- Filed previously.
(b) Financial Statement Schedules of Predecessor
Schedule III | Supplementary Insurance Information | |
Schedule IV | Reinsurance | |
Schedule V | Valuation and Qualifying Accounts |
Item 17. Undertakings
The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes:
(a) To provide to the underwriters at the closing specified in the underwriting agreements, certificates in such denominations and registered in such names as required by the underwriters to permit prompt delivery to each purchaser.
(b) Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the Registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions described under "Item 14. Indemnification of Directors and Officers" above, or otherwise, the Registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment to the Registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the Registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the Registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act of 1933 and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.
(c)(1) For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus filed by the Registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act of 1933 shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective.
(2) For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.
II-3
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the Registrant has duly caused this Registration Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in Hamilton, Bermuda on the 3d day of June, 2002.
PLATINUM UNDERWRITERS HOLDINGS, LTD. | |||
By: | /s/ CHARLES G.R. COLLIS | ||
Name: Charles G.R. Collis Title: Director |
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities indicated on June 3, 2002:
Name | Title | | ||
---|---|---|---|---|
JEROME T. FADDEN* Jerome T. Fadden | Principal Executive Officer, Principal Financial Officer, Principal Accounting Officer and Director | |||
CHARLES G.R. COLLIS* Charles G.R. Collis | Director | |||
DAVID J. DOYLE* David J. Doyle | Director | |||
DONALD PUGLISI* Donald Puglisi | Authorized Representative in the United States |
*By: | /s/ CHARLES G.R. COLLIS | |||||
Charles G.R. Collis Attorney-in-fact |
II-4
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC.
REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESOR)
SCHEDULE III—SUPPLEMENTARY INSURANCE INFORMATION
($ in millions)
| Deferred policy acquisition expenses | Gross loss and loss adjustment expense reserves | Gross unearned premiums | |||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
At December 31, | ||||||||||||
2001 | ||||||||||||
North American Property | $ | 14 | $ | 694 | $ | 54 | ||||||
North American Casualty | 73 | 2,286 | 242 | |||||||||
International | 9 | 902 | 59 | |||||||||
Finite Risk | 11 | 1,067 | 46 | |||||||||
Total | $ | 107 | $ | 4,949 | $ | 401 | ||||||
2000 | ||||||||||||
North American Property | $ | 14 | $ | 439 | $ | 53 | ||||||
North American Casualty | 51 | 1,903 | 162 | |||||||||
International | 10 | 669 | 51 | |||||||||
Finite Risk | 11 | 557 | 49 | |||||||||
Total | $ | 86 | $ | 3,568 | $ | 315 | ||||||
1999 | ||||||||||||
North American Property | $ | 20 | $ | 414 | $ | 95 | ||||||
North American Casualty | 38 | 1,821 | 140 | |||||||||
International | 18 | 711 | 102 | |||||||||
Finite Risk | 11 | 505 | 39 | |||||||||
Total | $ | 87 | $ | 3,451 | $ | 376 | ||||||
II-5
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC.
REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR)
SCHEDULE III—SUPPLEMENTARY INSURANCE INFORMATION
($ in millions)
| Premiums earned | Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses | Amortization of policy acquisition expenses | Other operating expenses | Premiums written | ||||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
2001 | |||||||||||||||||
North American Property | $ | 216 | $ | 381 | $ | 53 | $ | 14 | $ | 216 | |||||||
North American Casualty | 588 | 584 | 190 | 29 | 667 | ||||||||||||
International | 242 | 289 | 39 | 23 | 248 | ||||||||||||
Finite Risk | 547 | 668 | 33 | 16 | 546 | ||||||||||||
Total | $ | 1,593 | $ | 1,922 | $ | 315 | $ | 82 | $ | 1,677 | |||||||
2000 | |||||||||||||||||
North American Property | $ | 204 | $ | 133 | $ | 55 | $ | 17 | $ | 170 | |||||||
North American Casualty | 319 | 261 | 110 | 24 | 340 | ||||||||||||
International | 188 | 128 | 38 | 32 | 145 | ||||||||||||
Finite Risk | 410 | 289 | 133 | 15 | 418 | ||||||||||||
Total | $ | 1,121 | $ | 811 | $ | 336 | $ | 88 | $ | 1,073 | |||||||
1999 | |||||||||||||||||
North American Property | $ | 196 | $ | 153 | $ | 58 | $ | 13 | $ | 207 | |||||||
North American Casualty | 245 | 61 | 85 | 24 | 262 | ||||||||||||
International | 160 | 102 | 47 | 32 | 160 | ||||||||||||
Finite Risk | 277 | 184 | 30 | 13 | 284 | ||||||||||||
Total | $ | 878 | $ | 500 | $ | 220 | $ | 82 | $ | 913 | |||||||
II-6
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC.
REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR)
SCHEDULE IV—REINSURANCE
Years Ended December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999
($ in millions)
| Gross amount | Ceded to other companies | Assumed from other companies | Net amount | Percentage of amount assumed to net | |||||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
Insurance premiums earned: | ||||||||||||||||
2001 | $ | — | $ | 172 | $ | 1,765 | $ | 1,593 | 110.8 | % | ||||||
2000 | $ | — | $ | 260 | $ | 1,381 | $ | 1,121 | 123.2 | % | ||||||
1999 | $ | — | $ | 314 | $ | 1,192 | $ | 878 | 135.8 | % |
II-7
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC.
REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR)
SCHEDULE V—VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS
Years Ended December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999
($ in millions)
Description | Balance at beginning of year | Charged to costs and expenses | Additions Charged to other accounts | Deductions(1) | Balance at end of year | ||||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
2001 | |||||||||||||
Premiums receivable from underwriting activities | $ | 11.0 | 2.6 | — | 0.5 | $ | 13.1 | ||||||
Reinsurance | $ | 11.5 | 6.9 | — | — | $ | 18.4 | ||||||
2000 | |||||||||||||
Premiums receivable from underwriting activities | $ | 9.6 | 2.2 | — | 0.8 | $ | 11.0 | ||||||
Reinsurance | $ | 11.2 | 0.3 | — | — | $ | 11.5 | ||||||
1999 | |||||||||||||
Premiums receivable from underwriting activities | $ | 9.9 | 0.8 | — | 1.1 | $ | 9.6 | ||||||
Reinsurance | $ | 12.7 | — | — | 1.5 | $ | 11.2 |
- (1)
- Deductions include write-offs of amounts determined to be uncollectible and unrealized foreign exchange gains and losses.
II-8
Exhibit No. | Description | |
---|---|---|
1 | Form of Underwriting Agreement.* | |
2 | Form of Formation and Separation Agreement. | |
3.1 | Memorandum of Association of Platinum Holdings. | |
3.2 | Form of Restated Bye-Laws of Platinum Holdings. | |
4.1 | Form of Certificate of the Common Shares, par value $0.01 per share, of Platinum Holdings.* | |
5.1 | Opinion of Conyers, Dill & Pearman. | |
8.1 | Opinion of Sullivan & Cromwell as to certain tax matters.** | |
8.2 | Form of Opinion of Conyers, Dill & Pearman as to certain tax matters.** | |
8.3 | Form of Opinion of Slaughter and May as to certain tax matters. | |
8.4 | Form of Opinion of A. & L. Goodbody as to certain tax matters.** | |
10.1 | Employment Agreement between Jerome T. Fadden and The St. Paul Companies, Inc.** | |
10.2 | Letter Agreement between Steven H. Newman and The St. Paul Companies, Inc.** | |
10.3 | Letter Agreement between Steven H. Newman and The St. Paul Companies, Inc.** | |
10.4 | Employment Agreement between Michael D. Price and St. Paul Re.** | |
10.5 | Form of Employee Benefits and Compensation Matters Agreement. | |
10.6 | Form of Master Services Agreement. | |
10.7 | Form of U.K. Transitional Services Agreement.* | |
10.8 | Form of Runoff Services Agreement. | |
10.9 | Form of U.K. Runoff Services Agreement.* | |
10.10 | Form of Transitional Trademark License Agreement. | |
10.11 | Form of Registration Rights Agreement. | |
10.12 | Form of Underwriting Management Agreement. | |
10.13 | Form of U.K. Underwriting Agency and Underwriting Management Agreement.* | |
10.14 | Form of Assignment and Assumption Agreement. | |
10.15 | Form of Sub Lease Agreement. | |
10.16 | Form of Option Agreement. | |
10.17 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Traditional). | |
10.18 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - D-1). | |
10.19 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - A). | |
10.20 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - B-1). | |
10.21 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - B-2). | |
10.22 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - C). | |
10.23 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - D-2). | |
10.24 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - D Stop Loss). | |
10.25 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - D Spread Loss). | |
10.26 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - D-3). | |
10.27 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - D-4). | |
10.28 | Form of 100% Quota Share Retrocession Agreement (Non-Traditional - E). | |
10.29 | Form of U.K. Business Transfer Agreement.* | |
21 | Subsidiaries of Platinum Holdings.** | |
23.1 | Consent of KPMG LLP. | |
23.2 | Consent of Conyers, Dill & Pearman (included in Exhibit 5.1). | |
23.3 | Consent of Sullivan & Cromwell (included in Exhibit 8.1).** | |
23.4 | Consent of Conyers, Dill & Pearman (included in Exhibit 8.2).** | |
23.5 | Consent of Slaughter and May (included in Exhibit 8.3). | |
23.6 | Consent of A. & L. Goodbody (included in Exhibit 8.4).** | |
24 | Power of Attorney.** | |
99.1 | Consent of Jay S. Fishman.** | |
99.2 | Consent of Steven H. Newman.** | |
99.3 | Consent of H. Furlong Baldwin.** | |
99.4 | Consent of Peter T. Pruitt.** | |
99.5 | Consent of Jonathan F. Bank.** | |
99.6 | Consent of Dan R. Carmichael. |
- *
- To be filed by amendment.
- **
- Filed previously.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
The Company
The Public Offering and the St. Paul Investment
Selected Pro Forma Financial Information and Operating Data
Pro Forma Consolidated Balance Sheet Data
Pro Forma Combined Underwriting Results
Pro Forma Underwriting Results by Operating Segment
RISK FACTORS
DILUTION
USE OF PROCEEDS
DIVIDEND POLICY
CAPITALIZATION
PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION
Three Months Ended March 31, 2002
Three Months Ended March 31, 2001
Year Ended December 31, 2001
MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF PRO FORMA FINANCIAL CONDITION AND UNDERWRITING RESULTS
Formation of Platinum Holdings and Presentation of Pro Forma Financial Information and Historical St. Paul Re Combined Financial Information
BUSINESS Industry Overview
Our Business
MANAGEMENT
ST. PAUL INVESTMENT AND PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS
CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS
DESCRIPTION OF OUR COMMON SHARES
SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
CERTAIN TAX CONSIDERATIONS
Taxation of the Company, Platinum US, Platinum UK, Platinum Bermuda and Platinum Ireland
Taxation of Shareholders
UNDERWRITING
VALIDITY OF COMMON SHARES
EXPERTS
AVAILABLE INFORMATION
ENFORCEABILITY OF CIVIL LIABILITIES UNDER UNITED STATES FEDERAL SECURITIES LAWS AND OTHER MATTERS
THE PREDECESSOR BUSINESS
Selected Combined Financial Data
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Underwriting Results of the Predecessor Business
Capital Resources and Liquidity
Exposures to Market Risk
Reserves for Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses for Predecessor Business
Analysis of Loss and Loss Adjustment Expense (LAE) Development
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND FINANCIAL INFORMATION
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
PLATINUM UNDERWRITERS HOLDINGS, LTD. CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET April 24, 2002 (date of inception)
PLATINUM UNDERWRITERS HOLDINGS, LTD. NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET April 24, 2002 (date of inception)
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC. REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR) COMBINED STATEMENTS OF UNDERWRITING RESULTS
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC. REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR) COMBINED STATEMENTS OF IDENTIFIABLE UNDERWRITING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC. REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR) COMBINED STATEMENTS OF IDENTIFIABLE UNDERWRITING CASH FLOWS
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC. REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR) NOTES TO COMBINED STATEMENTS
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC. REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR) COMBINED STATEMENTS OF UNDERWRITING RESULTS (Unaudited)
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC. REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR) COMBINED STATEMENTS OF IDENTIFIABLE ASSETS AND LIABILITIES (Unaudited)
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC. REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR) COMBINED STATEMENTS OF IDENTIFIABLE CASH FLOWS (Unaudited)
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC. REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR) NOTES TO COMBINED STATEMENTS (Unaudited)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
PART II INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
SIGNATURES
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC. REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESOR) SCHEDULE III—SUPPLEMENTARY INSURANCE INFORMATION ($ in millions)
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC. REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR) SCHEDULE III—SUPPLEMENTARY INSURANCE INFORMATION ($ in millions)
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC. REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR) SCHEDULE IV—REINSURANCE Years Ended December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999 ($ in millions)
THE ST. PAUL COMPANIES, INC. REINSURANCE UNDERWRITING SEGMENT (PREDECESSOR) SCHEDULE V—VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS Years Ended December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999 ($ in millions)
Index to Exhibits